U.S.  DEPARTMENT OF COMMERCE
                                     National Technical Information Service

                                             PB-247 115
PRELIMINARY  ECONOMIC IMPACT ASSESSMENT OF POSSIBLE
REGULATORY ACTION TO CONTROL ATMOSPHERIC EMISSIONS
OF SELECTED  HALOCARBONS
ARTHUR D,  LITTLE,  INCORPORATED
PREPARED  FOR
ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY
SEPTEMBER 1975

-------
                         KEEP  UP  TO  DATE
  Between the time you ordered this report—
which is only  one of the hundreds of thou-
sands in the NTIS information collection avail-
able to  you—and the time  you are reading
this message, several new reports relevant to
your interests probably have entered the col-
lection.

  Subscribe  to the  Weekly  Government
Abstracts  series that will  bring you  sum-
maries of new reports as soon as they  are
received by NTIS from the originators of the
research.  The  WGA's are  an NTIS weekly
newsletter service covering  the most recent
research findings in  25 areas of industrial,
technological,  and  sociological  interest—
invaluable  information for  executives  and
professionals who must keep up to date.

  The  executive and professional  informa-
tion service provided by NTIS in the Weekly
Government Abstracts newsletters will  give
you thorough  and  comprehensive coverage
of government-conducted or sponsored re-
search activities. And you'll get this impor-
tant information within two weeks of the time
it's released by originating agencies.

  WGA  newsletters are computer  produced
and electronically photocomposed  to  slash
the time gap between the  release of a report
and  its availability.  You can learn  about
technical innovations immediately—and use
them in the most meaningful and productive
ways possible  for your organization. Please
request NTIS-PR-205/PCW for  more  infor-
mation.

  The weekly newsletter series will keep you
current. But learn what you have missed in
the past by ordering  a computer NTISearch
of all the  research reports in your area of
interest, dating as far back as 1964,  if you
wish.  Please  request  NTIS-PR-186/PCN for
more information.
        WRITE:  Managing Editor
                 5285 Port Royal Road
                 Springfield,  VA 22161
                   Keep Up  To Date With  SRIM
SRIM  (Selected  Research  in  Microfiche)
provides you with  regular, automatic distri-
bution of the complete texts of NTIS research
reports only in the subject areas you select.
SRIM  covers  almost all  Government  re-
search reports  by  subject area and/or the
originating   Federal  or   local  government
agency. You may subscribe by any category
or subcategory of our WGA (Weekly Govern-
ment  Abstracts)  or Government Reports
Announcements and  Index categories,  or to
the reports  issued by a particular agency
such as the  Department  of Defense, Federal
Energy  Administration,   or   Environmental
Protection Agency. Other options  that will
give you greater selectivity are available on
request.

  The  cost  of  SRIM service is  only 45$
domestic (60£  foreign)  for each  complete
microfiched report. Your SRIM service begins
as soon as your order is received and  proc-
essed and you will receive biweekly  ship-
ments thereafter.  If you wish,  your service
will be backdated to furnish you microfiche
of reports issued, earlier.

  Because of contractual arrangements with
several Special Technology Groups, not all
NTIS  reports  are distributed in the  SRIM
program. You  will receive a notice in  your
microfiche shipments identifying  the excep-
tionally priced reports not available through
SRIM.

  A deposit account with NTIS is  required
before this service  can be initiated.  If you
have specific questions concerning this serv-
ice, please call (703) 451-1558, or write  NTIS,
attention  SRIM  Product Manager.
This information product distributed  by

                U.S. DEPARTMENT OF COMMERCE
                National Technical Information Service
                5285 Port Royal Road
                Springfield, Virginia 22161

-------
EPA-450/3-75-073
September 1975
                   PRELIMINARY
ECONOMIC IMPACT ASSESSMENT
                    OF POSSIBLE
           REGULATORY ACTION
                    PB 247 115
                    TO CONTROL
       ATMOSPHERIC EMISSIONS
   OF SELECTED HALOCARBONS
          NATIONAL TECHNICAL
          INFORMATION SERVICE
           US Department of Commerce
            Springfield, VA. 22151
       U.S. ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY
         OffiVe of Air and Wasle Management
       Office of Air Quality Planning and Standards
       Research Triangle Park, North Carolina 27711

-------
                                   TECHNICAL REPORT DATA
                            (Please read Instructions on the reverse before completing)
 1. REPORT NO.
  EPA 450/3-75-073
                              2.
                                                           3. R
 4. TITLE ANDSUBTITLE
   Preliminary Economic Impact Assessment of Possible
   Regulatory Action  to Control Atmospheric Emissions
   of  Selected Halocarboas	        	
                                                           5. RETORT DATE
                                                             September  1975
                                  6. PERFORMING ORGANIZATION CODE
 7. AUTHOR(S)
     R.E.  Shamel, R. Williams, J.K.  O'Neill,
     R.  Ellerr R. Green. K.D.  Hallock.  R.P. Tschirch
                                  8. PERFORMING ORGANIZATION REPORT NO.


                                          76072-80
 9. PERFORMING ORGANIZATION NAME AND ADDRESS

     Arthur D.  Little, Inc.
     Acorn Park
     Cambridge, Massachusetts   02140
                                                           10. PROGRAM ELEMENT NO.
                                  11. CONTRACT/GRANT NO.
                                                              68-02-1349  Task 8
 12. SPONSORING AGENCY NAME AND ADDRESS
  Environmental Protection Agency
  Office  of  Air Quality Planning and  Standards
  Research Triangle Park, North Carolina    27711
                                                           13. TYPE OF REPORT AND PERIOD COVERED
                                                                  Final
                                  14. SPONSORING AGENCY CODE
 15. SUPPLEMENTARY NOTES
 16. ABSTRACT
    The report  identifies relative economic  impacts,  on affected industries,  of
    possible  regulatory action to control atmospheric emissions of selected halo-
    carbons.  Emphasis is placed on five halocarbons:  chlorofluorocarbons 11, 12
    and 22, and chlorocarbons, carbon tetrachloride and methyl chloroform.  .As
    background  the report provides information on  U.S.  and world production,  use
    and atmospheric emissions of fifteen halocarbons.  The report also examines
    alternatives for emission abatement and  the  conversion timetables required
    for abatement.   Finally, a description of industry  structure, including
    approximate sales and employment levels  for  affected sectors, is presented..
 7.
                                KEY WORDS AND DOCUMENT ANALYSIS
                  DESCRIPTORS
                                              b.lDENTIFIERS/OPEN ENDED TERMS
                                               c. COSATI Field/Group
Aerosol generators
Air  conditioning
Air  Pollution
Blowing agents
 hlorohydrocarbons
Chloromethanes
Dry  cleaning
Earth atmosphere
Fluorohydrocarbons
Freons ®
Halohydrocarbons
Ozone
Refrigerants
Solvents
Aerosol propellants
Atmospheric emissions
Economic impact
Stratospheric  ozone
          PRICES SUBJEJ TO CHARGE
 8. DISTRIBUTION STATEMENT
    Release Unlimited
                                              19. SECURITY CLASS (ThisReport)
                                                Unclassified
                                                                        21. NO. OF PAGES
                    20. SECURITY CLASS (Thispage)
                       Unclassified
EPA Form 2220-1 (9-73)

-------
                                  EPA-450/3-75-073
               PRELIMINARY

   ECONOMIC IMPACT ASSESSMENT
        .(•-•-..•  .   • • , .     .•••.,'.-
  OF POSSIBLE REGULATORY ACTION,

TO CONTROL ATMOSPHERIC EMISSIONS

      OF SELECTED HALOCARBONS
 EPA-RTF LIBRARY
                     by

         R. E. Shamel, J. K. O'Neill, and R. Williams

                Arthur D. Little, Inc.
                   Acorn Park
             Cambridge, Massachusetts 02140

             Contract No. 68-02-1349, Task 8
           EPA Project Officer: Kenneth H. Lloyd
                  Prepared for

           ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY
            Office of Air and Waste Management
          Office of Air Quality Planning and Standards
         Research Triangle Park, North Carolina 27711
                  September 1975.

                      /0/

-------
This report is  issued by the Environmental Protection Agency to report
technical data of interest to a limited number of readers.   Copies are
available free of charge to Federal employees, current contractors  and
grantees,  and nonprofit organizations  - as supplies permit - from the
Air Pollution Technical Information Center, Environmental Protection
Agency, Research Triangle Park, North Carolina 27711; or,  for a
fee,  from  the National Technical Information Service,  5285  Port Royal
Road, Springfield,  Virginia 22161.
This report was furnished to the Environmental Protection Agency by
Arthur D.  Little, Inc., Cambridge,  Massachusetts  02140,  in fulfillment
of Contract No.68-02-1349.   The contents of this report are reproduced
herein as received from Arthur D. Little, Inc.  The opinions,  findings,
and conclusions expressed are those of the author and not necessarily
those  of  the Environmental Protection Agency.  Mention of company
or product names  is not to be considered as  an endorsement by the
Environmental Protection Agency.
                Publication No.  EPA-450/3-75-073
                                 11

-------
                                 PREFACE

     This report is a preliminary economic impact assessment.  It is not a
detailed quantitative analysis of the economic consequences of Jialocarbon
regulation.  The purpose of the report was to identify those industries
which would. Tbe adversely affected by such regulation—should it become
necessary—and to prioritize them for purposes of further analysis.  The
                                                             • ' • o
report provides background information for such further analysis.
Although the limited number of interviews was insufficient to establish
statistically valid responses, the information presented is believed to be
reasonably accurate and complete.
     The scope of this stu4y did not include an assessment of the ozone
depletion hypothesis and no judgment on this question should be inferred
anywhere in the report.              ,    ..t       •
     Statements in the report that alternatives are available to current
uses of halocarbons dornot imply,that such substitutes should occur without
strong justification.  Furthermore, conducting a preliminary economic impact
assessment does not imply that substantial benefits would or would not
result from restrictions on the chemicals being considered.  Further
analysis of both the costs and benefits of such restriction should be
undertaken.
 Such analyses are currently underway under other contracts administered for
 example by the Environmental Protection Agency and the National Science
 Foundation.
                                    iii

-------
                            TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                                                  Page

  Preface                                                         Hi-
  List of Tables                                                  vii
  List of Figures                                                xiii

  I.  SUMMARY

      A.  Introduction                                            1-1

      B.  Purpose and Scope                                       1-2

          1.  Purpose                                             1-2
          2.  Scope                                               1-3

      C.  Approach                                                1-4

      D.  Major Findings                                          1-5

      E.  Chapter Summaries

          1.  Chapter II-Halocarbon Production and Use            1-11
          2.  Chapter III-Halocarbon Emissions to the Atmosphere  1-12
          3.  Chapter IV-Analysis of Major U.S. Emission Source?
              and Alternatives for Emission Abatement             1-12
          4.  Chapter V-Conversion Timetables                     1-17
          5.  Chapter VI-Definition of Primary Affected Industry
              Sectors                                             1-17
          6.  Chapter VII-Initial Economic Impact Assessment      I-r23

 II.  HALOCARBON PRODUCTION AND USE

      A.   Introduction                                           II-l

      B.   Fluorocarbon Production and Use                        IL-2

          1.  United States                                      II-2
       x  2.  World                                              II-8
        *"«=.t^

      C.   Chlorocarbon Production and Use                        11-12

          1.  United States                                      II-}2
          2.  World                                              11-26

III.  HALOCARBON EMISSIONS TO THE ATMOSPHERE

      A.   Introduction                                          III-l

      B.   Discussion of Emission Estimates and Environmental    IJI-2
          Fate

                                     iv

-------
                              TABLE OF CONTENTS
         1.  Atmospheric Emissions from Chemical Manufacturing
             Processes, Transportation and Storage                III-2
         2.  Environmental Fate of Fluorocarbons and
             Chlorocarbons                                        III-6

     C.  Fluorocarbon Emissons to the Atmosphere                  III-ll

         1:, , United-.States;-  ,                                     III-ll
         2.  World                                                111-12

   :,o.  Chlorocarbon Emissions to the Atmosphere                 111-16

         1.  United States                                        111-16
         2.  World                                                111-28

IV. :.ANALYSIS OF MAJOR U.S. EMISSION SOURCES AND ALTERNATIVES
   - .FOR EMISSION ABATEMENT
      t ";
     A.  Introduction                                              TV~i

     B.  Production, Transport, and Storage Emissions              IV-1

     C.  End Use and Disposal Emissions                            IV-2

         1.  Aerosol Propellants                                   IV-2
         2.  Refrigerants                                          IV-21
        , 3.  Solvents and Drycleaning                              IV-47
         4.  Foam Blowing Agents                                   IV-67

 V.  CONVERSION TIMETABLES

     A.  Introduction                                               V-l

     B.  Sector Timetables                                          V-4

        s1.  Raw Materials                                          V-4
         2.  Basic Chemicals                                        V-6
         3.  Chemical Intermediate Applications                     V-7
         4.  Propellant Applications                                V-10
        '5.  Refrigerant Applications                               V-16
         6.  Blowing Agent Applications                             V-22
         7.  Solvent Applications                                   V-24

     C.  Phasing of Conversion Times                                V-27

-------
                              TABLE OF CONTENTS

                                                                         Page

  VI.  DEFINITION OF PRIMARY AFFECTED INDUSTRY SECTORS

       A.  Introduction                                                   VI-1

       B.  Industry Structure                                             VI-2

           I.  Sector Relationships                                       VI-2
           2.  Chlorocarbon and Fluprocarbon Product and Material Flows   VI-10
           3.  Related Business Activities                                VI-17

       C.  Primary Industry Sector Definition                             VI-21

           1.  Raw Materials                                              VI-22
           2.  Basic Chemicals                                            VI-31
           3.  Chemical Intermediates                                     VI-58
           4.  Propellants                                                VI-61
           5.  Air Conditioning and Refrigeration                         VI-74
           6.  Foam Blowing Agents                                        VI-79
           7.  Solvents                                                   VI-82

 VII.  INITIAL ECONOMIC IMPACT ASSESSMENT

       A.  Introduction                                                  VII-1

       B.  Regulatory Options                                            VII-5

           1.  Introduction                                              VII-5
           2.  Chemicals Considered                                      VII-5
           3.  Definition of Regulatory Options.                          VII-7

       C.  Review of Production and Emission Statistics                  VII-12

       D.  Assessment of Economic Impacts                                VII-21

           1.  Introduction                                              VII-21
           2.  Discussion of Regulatory Options                          VII-27

       E.  Potential Emission Reductions                                 VII-49

VIII.  ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS                                                 VIII-1
                                        vi

-------
                             LIST OF TABLES
Table                                                                Page

 1-1     ESTIMATED WORLD AND U.S. PRODUCTION AND ATMOSPHERIC          1-6
         EMISSIONS OF FIVE PRINCIPAL HALOCARBONS - 1973

 1-2     ESTIMATED U.S. ATMOSPHERIC EMISSIONS FROM POTENTIALLY     -   1-7
         CONTROLLED CHEMICALS - 1973        .  ,   .

 1-3     SUMMARY OF ESTIMATED ECONOMIC IMPACT. ASSESSMENT RESULT-      I-9
         ING FROM RESTRICTION ON U.S. USE OF F-ll, F-12 AND
         CARBON TETRACHLORIDE

 ;I-4     SUBSTITUTION ALTERNATIVES AND EMISSION REDUCTION             1-13
         POSSIBILITIES FOR FIVE PRIMARY CHEMICALS

 1-5     CONSUMING INDUSTRY RESPONSE TIMES TO CHEMICAL USE            1-18
         RESTRICTIONS

 1-6     ESTIMATED EMPLOYMENT AND PRODUCTION VALUE RELATED TO         1-19
         FLUOROCARBON AND CHLOROCARBON PRODUCTION AND CONSUMP-
         TION - 1973

II-l     UNITED STATES FLUOROCARBON PRODUCTION DATA                  H-3

II-2     UNITED STATES FLUOROCARBON PRODUCTION CAPACITY BY           H-4
         PRODUCER-1973      r

II-3     UNITED STATES FLUOROCARBON CONSUMPTION BY END USE           II-6

II-4     WORLD FLUOROCARBON PRODUCTION AND PRODUCTION                II-9
         CAPACITYr-1973

II-5     WORLD FLUOROCARBON CONSUMPTION BY END USE-1973              11-10

II-6     UNITED STATES CHLOROCARBON PRODUCTION DATA                  11-13

II-7     UNITED STATES TRADE IN SELECTED CHLOROCARBONS               11-16

H-8     CARBON TETRACHLORIDE END-rUSE PATTERN                        11-17

II-9 .    CHLOROFORM END-USE PATTERN     .                             11-18

II-10    ETHYL CHLORIDE:END-USE PATTERN                              11-18

II-ll    ETHYLENE DICHLORIDE, END-USE PATTERN                         11-19

11-12    METHYL CHLORIDE END-USE PATTERN                             11-20
                                 vii

-------
                             LIST OF TABLES




 Table                                                               Page

 11-13   METHYL CHLOROFORM END^USE PATTERN                           11-21


 11-14   METHYLENE CHLORIDE END-USE PATTERN                          H-22


 11-15   PERCHLOROETHYLENE END-USE PATTERN                           11-23


 11-16   TRICHLOROETHYLENE END-USE PATTERN                           11-24


 11-17   VINYL CHLORIDE END-USE PATTERN                              11-25


 11-18   ESTIMATED WORLD CHLOROCARBON PRODUCTION - 1973              11-27


III-l    HYDROCARBON EMISSIONS FROM CHEMICAL MANUFACTURE            I11"3


III-2    HYDROCARBON EMISSIONS FROM CHEMICAL MANUFACTURING
         PROCESSES INVOLVING CHLORINATION                           III-4


III-3    SOME PROPERTIES OF FLUOROCARBONS AND CHLOROCARBONS         III-7

III-4    RELATIVE STABILITY OF THE HALOCARBONS                 .     IH-9

III-5    ESTIMATED U.S. FLUOROCARBON EMISSIONS-1973                 111-13


III-6    WORLD EMISSIONS OF FLUOROCARBON AEROSOL
         PROPELLANTS - 1973                                         111-15


III-7    WORLD EMISSIONS OF FLUOROCARBON REFRIGERANTS - 1973        111-15


III-8    ESTIMATED U.S. CARBON TETRACHLORIDE EMISSIONS-1973         111-17

III-9    ESTIMATED U.S. CHLOROFORM EMISSIONS-1973                   111-18


III-10   ESTIMATED U.S. ETHYL CHLORIDE EMISSIONS-1973               III-d9

III-ll   ESTIMATED U.S. ETHYLENE DICHLORIDE EMISSIONS-1973          III-2*0

111-12   ESTIMATED U.S. METHYL CHLORIDE EMISSIONS-1973     .         IIJ-21


111-13   ESTIMATED U.S. METHYL CHLOROFORM EMISSIONS-1973            111-22

111-14   ESTIMATED U.S. METHYLENE CHLORIDE EMISSIONS-1973            111-23


111-15   ESTIMATED U.S. PERCHLOROETHYLENE EMISSIONS-1973             III-24
                                  viii

-------
                             LIST OF TABLES



 Table                                                               Page

111-16   ESTIMATED J-S.  TRICHLOROETHYLENE  EMISSIONS-1973             111-25

111-17   ESTIMATED U.S.  VINYL CHLORIDE MONOMER EMISSIONS-1973       111-26

III-18   ESTIMATED U.S.  CHLOROCARBON EMISSIONS - 1973               111-27

111-19   ESTIMATED WORLD CHLOROCARBON EMISSIONS-1973                111-29

 IV-1    PHYSICAL PROPERTIES OF AEROSOL PROPELLANTS                  IV-5

 IV-2    ESTIMATED U.S.  FLUOROCARBON EMISSIONS AS AEROSOL            IV-7
         PROPELLANT BY PRODUCT TYPE - 1973

 IV-3    APPROXIMATE SELLING PRICE OF MAJOR AEROSOL   .               IV-17
         PROPELLANTS - 1975

 IV-4    END USE OF FLUOROCARBON REFRIGERANTS  BY TYPE                IV-22

 IV-5    ESTIMATED U.S.  FLUOROCARBON EMISSIONS AND USE AS            IV-23
         REFRIGERANT - 1973

 IV-6    CHARACTERISTICS OF DRYCLEANING SOLVENTS                     IV-60

 IV-7    SOLVENT LOSSES  IN PERCHLOROETHYLENE PLANTS                  IV-65

 IV-8    DESCRIPTION OF USE OF HALOCARBONS IN PLASTIC FOAM           IV-68
         MANUFACTURE

 IV-9    ESTIMATED U.S.  USE OF HALOCARBONS IN PLASTIC FOAM           IV-79
         MANUFACTURE - 1973

 IV-10   ESTIMATED U.S.  FLUOROCARBON AND CHLOROCARBON                IV-81
         EMISSIONS FROM FOAM BLOWING

  V-l    NEW RAW MATERIAL SUPPLY TIMES                                V-5

  V-2    DEVELOPMENT TIMES FOR SUBSTITUTE  CHEMICALS                   V-7

  V-3    DEVELOPMENT TIMES FOR PRODUCTION  FACILITIES FOR              V-9
         INTERMEDIATE CHEMICAL APPLICATIONS

  V-4    TIME REQUIRED FOR INTRODUCING PRODUCTS TO PERSONAL           V-15.
         CARE MARKET
                                 ix

-------
                            LIST OF TABLES
Table                                                               Page
 V-5    AVAILABILITY OF NON-FLUOROCARBON REFRIGERATION AND           V-18
        AIR CONDITIONING PRODUCTS

 V-6    TRANSITION TIMES OF REFRIGERANT APPLICATIONS                 V-21

 V-7    CONVERSION TIMES FOR BLOWING AGENT APPLICATIONS              V-23

 V-8    CONVERSION TIMES FOR SOLVENT APPLICATIONS                    V-26

 V-9    CONSUMING INDUSTRY RESPONSE TIME TO AN IMMEDIATE             V-29
        CHEMICAL BAN

 V-10   CONSUMING INDUSTRY CONVERSION TIMES TO USING                 V-38
        SUBSTITUTE CHEMICALS

 V-ll   TIMES REQUIRED FOR EQUIPMENT UPGRADING TO REDUCE             V-38
        ATMOSPHERIC LOSSES

VI-1    U.S. CHLORINE PRODUCTION AND MAJOR END USES - 1973          VI-4

VI-2    U.S. PRODUCTION AND END USES OF HALOCARBON PRIMARY          VI-7
        INTERMEDIATES - 1973

VI-3    U.S. ETHYLENE DICHLORIDE END USE - 1973                     VI-9

VI-4    U.S. PRODUCTION/RAW MATERIALS FOR C1 CHLORINATED            VI-11
        HYDROCARBONS - 1973

VI-5    U.S. PRODUCTION/RAW MATERIALS FOR C. CHLORINATED            VI-12
        HYDROCARBONS-1973

VI-6    U.S. PRODUCTION/RAW MATERIALS FOR CARBON TETRA-             VI-15
        CHLORIDE, CHLOROFORM, PERCHLOROETHYLENE-1973

VI-7    U.S. FLUOROCARBON CONSUMPTION OF RAW MATERIALS - 1973       VI-16

VI-8    PRODUCTION/RAW MATERIALS FOR FLUOROCARBONS-1973             VI-18

VI-9    RELATED BUSINESS ACTIVITIES - FLUOROCARBONS                 VI-19

VI-10   SELECTED CHLORINE DEMAND CATEGORIES - 1973                  VI-23

VI-11   U.S. CHLORINE PRODUCERS - 1973                              VI-24

-------
                            LIST OF TABLES



Table                                                               Page

VI-12   U.S. HYDROFLUORIC ACID PRODUCERS - 1973                     VI-28

VI-13   EMPLOYMENT IN HYDROFLUORIC ACID PRODUCTION                  VI-30

VI-14   U.S. FLUOROCARBON MANUFACTURERS - 1973                      VI-32

VI-15   DEPENDENCE OF MANUFACTURERS ON FLUOROCARBON SALES           VI-33

VI-16   U.S. CARBON TETRACHLORIDE MANUFACTURERS - 1973              VI-36

VI-17   U.S. CHLOROFORM MANUFACTURERS - 1973                        VI-38

VI-18   U.S. ETHYL CHLORIDE MANUFACTURERS - 1973                    VI-40

VI-19   U.S. ETHYLENE DICHLORIDE MANUFACTURERS - 1973               VI-41

VI-20   U.S. METHYL CHLORIDE AND METHYLENE CHLORIDE                 VI-43
        MANUFACTURERS - 1973

VI-21   U.S. METHYL CHLOROFORM MANUFACTURERS - 1973                 VI-45

VI-22   U.S. TRICHLOROETHYLENE AND PERCHLOROETHYLENE                VI-47
        MANUFACTURERS - 1973

VI-23   U.S. CHLOROCARBON INDUSTRY - 1973                           VI-49

VI-24   PRODUCING COMPANIES, PLANT LOCATION, AND CAPACITIES-        VI-51
        PVC HOMOPOLYMER RESINS

VI-25   ESTIMATED DEPENDENCE OF MANUFACTURERS ON PVC SALES          VI-54

VI-26   U.S. TETRAETHYL AND TETRAMETHYL LEAD MANUFACTURERS-1973     VI-59

VI-27   U.S. METAL CAN SHIPMENTS - 1973                             VI-62

VI-28   U.S. AEROSOL CONTAINER SHIPMENTS - 1973                     VI-64

VI-29   1974 AEROSOL FILLING INDUSTRY SALIENT STATISTICS            VI-69

VI-30   U.S. REFRIGERATION INDUSTRY - 1973                          VI-76

VI-31   AIR CONDITIONING/REFRIGERATION EQUIPMENT                    VI-77
        MANUFACTURERS - 1973
                               xl

-------
                             LIST OF TABLES



 Table                                                               Page

 VI-32   U.S. CONSUMPTION OF POLYURETHANE FOAM - 1973                VI-81

VII-1    ESTIMATED ANNUAL U.S. USES OF POTENTIALLY CONTROLLED       VII-13
         CHEMICALS - 1973

VII-2    ESTIMATED U.S. ATMOSPHERIC EMISSIONS FROM POTENTIALLY      VII-14
         CONTROLLED CHEMICALS - 1973

VII-3    DEFINITION OF USES OF POTENTIALLY CONTROLLED               VII-15
         CHEMICALS - 1973

VII-4    DEPENDENCE OF USE CATEGORIES ON POTENTIALLY                VII-17
         CONTROLLED CHEMICALS - 1973

VII-5    CONSUMING INDUSTRY RESPONSE TIMES TO CHEMICAL USE          VII-18
         RESTRICTIONS

VII-6    VALUE OF CHLOROCARBONS AND FLUOROCARBONS RELATED           VII-20
         TO PRICES OF END USE PRODUCTS - 1973

VII-7    SUMMARY OF ECONOMIC IMPACT FROM REGULATORY OPTIONS         VII-22

VII-8    U.S. EMISSION REDUCTION FOR F-ll AND F-12 ACHIEVED         VII-50
         THROUGH 1995 WITH SELECTED REGULATORY SCENARIOS

VII-9    SUMMARY OF U.S. ANNUAL FLUOROCARBON EMISSIONS WITH         VII-51
         AND WITHOUT CONTROL
                                  xil

-------
                             LIST OF FIGURES



Figure                                                               Page

 IV-1    Types of Aerosol Containers                                 IV-3

 IV-2    Equipment Diagram for Basic Vapor Compression Cycle         IV-25

 IV-3    Basic Absorption Refrigeration Cycle                        IV-38

 IV-4    Basic Vapor Degreaser                                       IV-51

 IV-5    Enclosed Conveyorized Vapor Degreaser                       IV-52

 IV-6    Transfer-Type Drycleaning System                            IV-61

 IV-7    Solvent Mileage                                             IV-63

 IV-8    Schematic Diagram of System Used for Injecting              IV-74
         Blowing Agent into Extruder for Production of
         Foamed Polystyrene Sheet

  V-l    Flow Diagram of Aerosol Product Introduction Schedule        V-14

  V-2    "Optimistic" Time Sequence for Producing Substitute          V-31
         Chemical

  V-3    "Pessimistic" Time Sequence for Producing Substitute         V-32
         Chemical

  V-4    "Optimistic" and "Pessimistic" Time Schedules for            V-35
         Converting to a New Liquified Gas Propellant

  V-5    "Optimistic" and "Pessimistic" Time Schedules for            V-36
         Converting to New Chemical Refrigerant

 VI-1    Materials Flow Chart - Chlorocarbons - 1973                  VI-3

 VI-2    Materials Flow Chart - Fluorocarbons - 1973                  VI-13

 VI-3    Aerosol Filling Industry Capacity as a Function of          VI-71
         Number of Fillers

VII-1    Cumulative U.S. Atmospheric Emissions of F-ll and F-12     VII-54
         Fluorocarbons Without Restriction and Under Regulatory
         Options IA-IVA

VII-2    Cumulative U.S. Atmospheric Emissions of F-ll and F-12     VII-55
         Fluorocarbons Without Restriction and Under Regulatory
         Options VA-IXA

                                    xiii

-------
                               I.   SUMMARY



A.  INTRODUCTION

     After a four-month review of available information, the Federal

Task Force on Inadvertent Modification of the Stratosphere (IMOS) has

concluded that "fluorocarbons released to the environment are a legiti-
                        3.
mate cause for concern."   The fluorocarbons are a class of commercially

important chemicals — used chiefly as aerosol propellants and refrige-

rants.  They are also used as specialty solvents, in the manufacture of

plastic foam, and in a variety of other minor ways.  In June 1974, two

scientists reported  their contention that human health and welfare may

be seriously threatened by the accumulation of certain stable halogen-

containing organic chemicals in the atmosphere.  According to their

theory, these chemicals may undergo photochemical decomposition in the

upper atmosphere which, in turn, may lead to depletion of the Earth's

ozone layer and a concomitant increase in the intensity of solar ultra-

violet radiation reaching the Earth's surface.  A possible threat may
3
 "Fluorocarbons and the Environment," sponsored by the Council on Environ-
mental Quality and the Federal Council for Science and Technology, June 1975.


 Molina, M.J. and F.S. Rowland, "Stratospheric Sink for Chlorofluoro-
methanes:  Chlorine Atom Catalyzed Destruction of Ozone," Nature, 249:
810, 1974.
                                  1-1

-------
lie in the biological and climatological effects of this increased

radiation.  In any event, most scientists agree that there are important

uncertainties in the current theory and that further research and

analysis is required before conclusions may be drawn.

     The Strategies and Air Standards Division of the U.S. Environmental

Protection Agency (EPA) asked Arthur D. Little, Inc. (ADL) to develop

estimates of U.S. and world production of fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons

and estimates of their emissions to the atmosphere, and to make a pre-

liminary assessment of the economic impact resulting from restricting

the use of five primary chemicals in the United States.  The results of

the analysis are reported herein.

B.  PURPOSE AND SCOPE

1.  Purpose

     The ADL project had four primary purposes:

     1.  Develop background information relating to 24  halocarbons

         (15 of which are commercially important), including U.S. and

         world production, use, and emissions to the atmosphere.

     2.  Identify and evaluate emission control strategies for five halo-

         carbons identified by EPA as those most importantly involved in

         the ozone depletion theory at this time.  For the uses of the
 See Table III-3 for a complete listing of these chemicals.


 "Halocarbons" are halogen-containing hydrocarbons.  The chlorofluoro-
carbons ("fluorocarbons") and the chlorocarbons are classes of halocarbons.
Throughout this report, "F" is used as an abbreviation for "fluorocarbon."
The industry numbering code (C-l, H+l, F) is used to designate specific
fluorocarbons.
                                  1-2

-------
         chemicals as aerosol propellants, refrigerants, plastic foam




         blowing agents and solvents, the potential was examined for




         substituting other chemicals, substituting products not using




         the chemicals, and reducing the emissions by upgrading equip-




         ment components and maintenance.procedures and by installing




         vapor-recovery equipment.




     3.  Identify industry sectors which could be affected by control of




         production, or use of the five halocarbons.




     4.  Categorize the economic impact expected to be experienced by




         each industry sector under a range of regulatory scenarios.




2.  Scope




     Although two fluorocarbons (F-ll and F-12) have been the subjects of




greatest concern in the published discussions of potential effects on the




ozone layer, other halogen-containing compounds may also be a cause for




concern.  For this reason, the current uses of 15 halogen-containing com-




pounds were defined.




     This report identifies industry sectors which would be affected by




possible regulatory action levied to control atmospheric emissions of




selected halocarbons.  Although a detailed economic impact assessment has




not. been attempted, potentially impacted sectors have been identified and




the level of economic impact likely to be experienced by the sectors has




been categorized.  The analysis was preliminary in the sense that a




relative, rather than an absolute, economic impact assessment was




undertaken.




     The evidence of  a possible threat to atmospheric ozone has been dis-




cussed extensively in the literature.  However, the scope of this report






                               .  1-3

-------
does not include an assessment of this evidence.  The possible economic



benefits, if any, in reducing halocarbon emissions to the atmosphere have



not been considered.  Statements in the report that alternatives are



available to current uses of halocarbons do not imply that substitutions



should occur without strong justification, since some compromise in terms



of performance or safety may be involved — as well as some level of



economic disruption.



     This report focuses on five compounds which , if the ozone depletion



theory is correct, are among those which could pose a threat to the



Earth's ozone layer.  Studies currently underway may disprove the ozone



depletion theory or may add other compounds to the list of those con-



sidered as potentially contributing to ozone depletion.  The five compounds



suggested by EPA were fluorocarbons 11, 12, and 22 (which, according to



one theory, may prove to be an environmentally preferred alternative to



F-ll and F-12), and two chlorocarbons — carbon tetrachloride and methyl



chloroform.  The other 19 chemicals are produced in relatively small



amounts, or are believed by stratospheric scientists either to decompose



in the lower atmosphere or to be produced naturally in amounts greatly


                              3,
exceeding man-made production.



C.  APPROACH



     The approach used in preparing this report involved the collection of



publicly available statistical information supplemented by interviews with



representatives of some 28 companies and associations.  While information
a

 Carbon tetrachloride and methyl chloroform may also be produced naturally

in the environment, according to some scientists.
                                   1-4

-------
in this report derived from these interviews is believed to be accurate,

no inference should be made that related statements in the report are based

on a statistically valid survey.

     In order to make a preliminary assessment of potential economic

impact, ADL and EPA personnel developed nine hypothetical regulatory

options divided into three implementation time frames:  six months,

three years; and six years.  The options further differentiated among

controls on production, emissions, and sales.

     Based upon current estimated emission levels and estimated atmos-

pheric stability, two groups of chemicals were identified to which the

regulatory restrictions were applied.  The first group, which represents

those chemicals having the longer atmospheric residence times, consisted

of F-ll, F-12, and carbon tetrachloride.  The second group consisted of

the chemicals in the first group plus F-22 and methyl chloroform.  The

application of the nine regulations to two groups of chemicals produced

18 different regulatory options.  The hypothetical regulations and the

inclusion of the particular chemicals in the analysis have no official

standing as proposed regulations.

D.  MAJOR FINDINGS3

     Table 1-1 summarizes the estimates of production, atmsopheric emis-

sions, and stability of the five primary compounds.  Table 1-2 lists the

emissions from the chemicals'  primary uses.  The categorization of
3This summary of findings is not.represented as presenting a sufficient
 data base upon which to base important long-term decisions.
                                 1-5

-------
                Table  1-1.  ESTIMATED WORLD AND U.S. PRODUCTION AND ATMOSPHERIC EMISSIONS
                            OF FIVE PRINCIPAL HALOCARBONS - 1973
Halocarbons
Fluorocarbons
F-ll
F-12
F-22
Subtotal
Chlorocarbons
Carbon tetrachloride
Methyl chloroform
Subtotal
Total


World production,
(thousands of
metric tons)
( 930
120
1,050
950
420
1,370
2,420


U.S. production,
(thousands of
metric tons)
150
220
60
430
470
250
720
1,150


World emissions,
(thousands of
metric tons)
[ 700
60
760
40
320
360
1,120


U.S. emissions,
(thousands of
metric tons)
140
170
28
340
20
200
220
560


Lifetime
in the
atmosphere
) greater than
f 10 years
1 to 10 years.

greater than
10 years
1 to 10 years




 a.   Production of F-ll,  F-12,  and  F-22  accounts  for approximately  90 percent of  total  fluorocarbon production.

 b.   Production of carbon tetrachloride  and methyl chloroform accounts  for  8 percent  of total  U.S.  production of
     commercially important  chlorocarbons.  Vinyl chloride  represents 28  percent.   Emissions of  the other  chloro-
     carbons are not presented here because of their  shorter atmospheric  life.
 c.   Values may not add due  to rounding.
'Sources:   Arthur D.  Little,  Inc.,  production  and emission  estimates.   Atmospheric  lifetime estimates  by
           Cicerone,  et al.,  "Stratospheric Ozone Destruction by Man-Made Chlorofluoromethanes," Science,  Vol.  185
           (27  September 1974), p.  1165  and references contained therein, and A.P.  Altshuller, EPA  (personal
           communication).              .           "                                  •

-------
                           Table 1-2.   ESTIMATED U.S.  ATMOSPHERIC EMISSIONS FROM POTENTIALLY CONTROLLED CHEMICALS - 1973
                                                            (thousands of metric tons)
Chemical
Chemical Group 1
F-ll
F-12
Carbon tetra-
chloride
Subtotal
Chemical Group 2
F-22
Methyl chloro-
form
Subtotal
Totalb
Production

150
220
470

840

60
250

310
1.150_

Production,
transport
and storage
losses

1.5
2.2
7.1

11

0.6
2.5

3.1
14

^ Estimated annual emissions from use and disposal . „_
Propellant
.
107
113
_

220

small
_

small
220
Refrigerant

5
59
_

64

27
^

27
91
Solvent

small
-
ioa

10

-
195

195
205

Blowing
agent

13
3.4
_

16

• -
• _

-
16
Use as inter-
med . chemical

-
-
3.8

3.8

small
small

small
3.8
Total

125
180
20

325

28
200

225
550
M
         a.  Predominantly from use in pesticides.
         b.  Values may not add due to rounding.
         Source:   Arthur D.  Little, Inc., estimates.

-------
potential economic Impacts resulting from the application of nine alter-

nate regulations for reducing emissions of the three most stable compounds

 (F-ll, F-12, and carbon  tetrachloride) is shown in Table 1-3.  The major

 findings of  the report are listed below:

•  Total world production of the three primary fluorocarbons and chloro-

carbons with estimated atmospheric lifetimes of more than ten years was

1.9 million metric tons  in 1973.  World production of the two primary

chemicals with lifetimes of one to ten years was 540,000 metric tons.

     The United States accounted for approximately 45 percent of the world

production of fluorocarbons 11 and 12 and carbon tetrachloride.  The U.S.

production of fluorocarbon 22 and methyl chloroform was about 55 percent

of world production.  European production of the two chemical groups was

approximately 40 percent and 30 percent respectively of world production.

World emissions of carbon tetrachloride were only about 5 percent of

world F-ll and F-12 emissions.

• Total world emissions  to the atmosphere of F-ll, F-12. and carbon tetra-

chloride were about 740,000 metric tons in 1973 (40 percent of production).

World emissions of F-22  and methyl chloroform were 380,000 metric tons

 (75 percent of production).

     The geographical distribution of emissions approximately equals the

production distribution.   Propellant uses of the chemicals with atmos-

pheric lives greater than ten years resulted in 70 percent of their

atmospheric emissions, and refrigerant uses accounted for 20 percent.

Eighty-six percent of total F-22 and methyl chloroform emissions were

produced by solvent uses of the methyl chloroform.  Refrigerant uses of

F-22 resulted in 13 percent of total atmospheric emissions for these two

chemicals.
                                 1-8

-------
                                                 Table 1-3.   SUMMARY OF ESTIMATED  ECONOMIC  IMPACT ASSESSMENT
                                       RESULTING FROM RESTRICTION ON U.S.  USE OF F-ll,  F-12 AND CARBON TETRACHLORIDE
H

V0


Sector size related
to controlled
chemicals 1972/1973
Approximate
production value
($millions)
Employment .
(thousands)
Regulatory
options

ID
5
|
>o


CD
M
a
0) ,
CO

1.
2.
3.

4.
, 5.

6.

7.
8.
CO
i
X
9.
emission
reduction
92Z
82Z
70Z

80Z
83Z

74Z

63Z
69Z

54Z
< i . 'Tmpnrr Sectors _ ^

Basic
chemical
producers


$360

3


2-3
3
3

3
3

3

3
3

5
- Propellant applications .^
~~ Aerosol industry *""
Independent
fillers


$130

7


1
1
1

1
2-3

2-3

2-3
2-3

3-5
Can manu-
factures


$300

2.5


3
3
3

3
5

5

5
5

5
Valve manu-
factures


$60

2


1
1
1

1
2-3

2-3

2-3
2-3

3-5
Aerosol
marketers


$1,000

7.5


2
2
2

2
3

3

3
3

5
j*. Non-prooellant applications "^
~Air conditioning and
refrigeration
manufacturers


$7,000

150


1
4
5

4
1-2

4

5
5

5
Plastic *"
foam
producers


$600

35


2
3
4

3-4
3

3

4
4

4
              REGULATORY OPTIONS

              1.
              2.
              3.
              4.
              5.
              6.
              7.
              8.
Ban all but replacement uses of controlled chemicals after six months
Regulation of non-propellant uses and ban of propellent uses after six months
No regulation of non-propellant uses and ban of propellent uses after six months
Government control of total chemical production after six months
Ban all but replacement uses of controlled chemicals after three years
Regulation of non-propellant uses and ban of propellant uses after three years
No regulation of non-propellant uses and a ban of propellant uses after three years
Government control of total chemical production after three years
IMPACT CODE
1 - severe
2 - substantial
3 - moderate
4 - limited
5 - essentially none

*See Chapter VII of report
 for definition of terms.
              9.  No regulation of non-propellant applications 'and ban of propellant.uses  after  six years

              a.  Percent reduction in U.S.  F-ll, F-12,  and carbon tetrachloride emissions to  the atmosphere over a 20 year period beginning In
                  1976.   A 5 percent demand  growth is assumed in the absence of  controls;  no restriction on critical propellant uses  (5 percent
                  of total), a 5 year half-life for refrigerants and 50 percent  control  of emissions  from plastic foams are assumed.
              Source:  Arthur D.  Little, Inc.,  estimates.

-------
e  If the majority of the longer lived emissions are to be ended, the




use of F-ll and F-12 as propellants must be greatly reduced.  Significant




emission level reductions may be achieved from the other use cate-




gories of the fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons by upgrading equipment




components and by improved maintenance practices.




     The total projected emissions of F-ll, F-12, and carbon tetrachloride




over a 20-year period could be reduced by 75 percent should propellant




uses of F-ll and F-12 be banned after three years and the equipment using




them as refrigerants and blowing agents be modified to reduce or recover




losses to the atmosphere.  An immediate end of emissions is not possible




due to leakage from previous charges of refrigeration and air conditioning




equipment with F-ll and F-12.




•  Identifiable alternatives exist for the fluorocarbons and chlorocar-




bons or for the major products in which they are now used.




     For many important uses of the chemicals, a conversion time of one




to five years would be necessary before alternative products could be




produced in adequate quantities.  In some cases, conversion times of up




to ten years may be required.  While the substitute products will perform




the primary functions of the chemicals or products using the chemicals,




the substitution may result in different (often less desirable) cost or




performance characteristics.




•  A ban of propellant uses of F-ll and F-12 after three years would most




strongly impact certain components of the aerosol industry, such as con-




tract can fillers and aerosol valve manufacturers.  A ban of other uses




of F-ll and F-12 after three years would seriously affect major segments




of the refrigeration industry.





                                  1-10

-------
     A ban of all uses of F-ll and F-12 after six months would severely




impact the refrigeration industry and segments of the aerosol industry




and the foam products industry.  Requirements for improved vapor recovery




from non-propellant uses of the chemicals would, in almost all instances,




have only slight economic impact.




E.  CHAPTER SUMMARIES




     In addition to the major findings of this study summarized above,




the following is a synopsis of Chapters II-VII.  It is important to recog-




nize that in preparing the chapter summaries, generalizations have been




made in the interest of greater ease of understanding; thus, statements




in  the summaries do not fully explain the complexities of the study on a




given point.




1.  Chapter II-Halocarbon Production and Use



     A summary of U.S. and world production of the five primary compounds




(F-ll, F-12, F-22, carbon tetrachloride, and methyl chloroform) is pre-




sented in Table 1-1.  Similar information for the remaining commercially




important halocarbpns is discussed in Chapter II.  Estimated world pro-




duction of fluorocarbons 11 and 12 exceeded 900,000 metric tons in 1973.




U.S. production of these two fluorocarbons represents approximately 40




percent of the world total.  Of the five principal compounds, carbon




tetrachloride is the single most important in terms of production volume;




however,  nearly all of this production is used in the manufacture of




fluorocarbons 11 and, 12.  Applications of the three fluorocarbons (F-ll,




F-12, and F-22) as prppellants and refrigerants are by far the most




important, accounting for approximately 80 percent of total demand for




these compounds.  The primary use of methyl chloroform is as an industrial
                                  1-11

-------
cleaning solvent.  The major applications for the other commercially

important halocarbons are as solvents and as chemical intermediates for

the production of plastics and a variety of other materials.

2.  Chapter III-Halocarbon Emissions to the Atmosphere

     A summary of estimated U.S. and world emissions to the atmosphere of

the five key compounds of interest is presented in Table 1-1.   Estimated
                                                                    >
world emissions of fluorocarbons 11 and 12 were 700,000 metric tons in

1973.  Estimated U.S. emissions of these two fluorocarbons in 1973 amounted

to 310,000 metric tons, or approximately 45 percent of the total world

emissions.  Worldwide emissions of fluorocarbon 22 are small by compari-

son — about 60,000 metric tons.  The major source of U.S. and world

fluorocarbon emissions to the atmosphere is the use of the chemicals as
                        Q
propellants in aerosols.   This emission source accounts for an estimated

60 percent of total world emissions.  Fluorocarbon emissions from refri-

geration and air conditioning equipment are second in importance to those

from aerosols, accounting for approximately 25 percent of total world

emissions.  Within these two fluorocarbon emission categories, the largest

subcategories are personal care aerosols (mainly hairsprays and anti-

perspirants) and air conditioners (chiefly mobile and large commercial

units) respectively.

3.  Chapter IV-Analysis of Major U.S. Emission Sources and Alternatives
for Emmision Abatement


     The opportunities for substituting other chemicals or products for

the five principal chemicals are presented in Table 1-4.  The table also
 F-22 use in aerosols is negligible.
                                  1-12

-------
                   Table 1-4   SUBSTITUTION ALTERNATIVES  AND  EMISSION  REDUCTION POSSIBILITIES
                               FOR FIVE PRIMARY CHEMICALS
      Chemical
Major
chemical
uses
      Fluorocarbons
      (F-ll,  F-12, &  F-22)
i
!-•
OJ
      Chlorocarbons
      Carbon  tetrachloride
     Methyl chloroform
Aerosol propellant
                               Refrigerant
Blowing agent, other
(predominently used in
 the production of F-ll
 and F12)
Cleaning solvent
                                                                  Emission control opportunities
Substitute chemical or
 product alternatives
Emission  reduction
    alternatives
 Substitute propellants
   or products

 F-ll & F-12 to  F-22,  or
 F-ll, F-12 &-F-22 to  other1
 refrigerants or systems

 Substitute blowing agents
Other  solvents
      None


Upgrade components
Improve maintenance


Install vapor
  recovery equipment
Install vapor
  recovery equipment
   Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates based on industry contacts.

-------
shows where emission reductions can be achieved as an alternative to

banning the use of the chemicals.

     In all of the end use categories reviewed above, with the exception

of aerosol propellant applications, emission control and recovery appears

to be an effective means of significantly reducing emissions of fluoro-

carbons F-ll, F-12, F-22, and methyl chloroform.  Carbon tetrachloride
                                                                    \
emissions are already relatively small and are derived mainly from manu-

facture of F-ll and F-12.  Carbon tetrachloride emissions should therefore

be reduced in proportion to the reduced demand for F-ll and F-12 which

would accompany reduced emissions of these compounds.

     By the very nature of their use as aerosol propellants, emissions

of F-ll and F-12 from this application can only be achieved through sub-

stitution of other propellants or other delivery systems.  While no widely

accepted propellant substitutes having similar cost/performance charac-

teristics are now available (note discussion below), it appears that

alternative products are available should it be required that the use

of fluorocarbon aerosols be restricted or banned.

a.  Aerosol Propellants - The greatest volume of fluorocarbon use (mainly

F-ll and F-12) is in aerosol propellant and vapor depressant applications —

predominantly personal care products such as hairsprays and deodorants.

The fluorocarbons' combination of appropriate vapor pressure, low toxicity,

and non-flammability results in safe aerosol products with good consumer

acceptance.  Other lower cost propellants, such as compressed gases and

hydrocarbons, are available and in use.  However, these substitutes have

not yet been widely accepted since they have different performance charac-

teristics.
                                1-14

-------
     Non-aerosol products intended to serve markets now dominated by




aerosol products have been available to consumers for some time.   In the




event of a ban of the fluorocarbon aerosols, the production of the non-




aerosol products can be increased.  However, since consumers have seen




a difference between the non-aerosol and aerosol products, they may not




completely convert to the non-aerosol products if the aerosol products




are banned, and a net loss of industry sales may result.




b.  Refrigerants - Large quantities of fluorocarbons (mainly F-12 and




F-22) are also used as refrigerants in both small and large air condi-




tioning, refrigeration and freezing systems.  Most systems now manufactured




using F-ll or F-12 could probably be redesigned (at a cost) to use F-22,




if its emissions are shown to be acceptable.  However, previous attempts




to produce refrigeration equipment and automobile air conditioners using




F-22 have not been successful.  Other equally safe refrigerants are not




available for use in the common vapor-compression systems now used in the




majority of applications.  However, other refrigerants may be more environ-




mentally acceptable than the fluorocarbons if the ozone depletion theory




is validated.  Absorption refrigeration systems represent a possible long-




term substitute to the fluorocarbon-based vapor-compression designs, and




these systems may be good alternatives for some applications if the use




of all fluorocarbons as refrigerants must be curtailed.  On balance, the




alternatives available for complete elimination of F-ll and F-12 emissions




from refrigerant applications appear  to be  unattractive at this  time.




     If limited fluorocarbon emissions are acceptable, it appears that




significant reductions in emissions to the atmosphere can be achieved by




establishing new maintenance and repair procedures, redesigning certain






                                  1-15

-------
equipment components such as tubing connectors and hoses on mobile systems,




and recovering the refrigerant from discarded equipment.  The economic




impact on the producers and on product prices would be much less than that




of a forced conversion to refrigeration systems not using fluorocarbons.




c.  Foam-Blowing Agents - It appears that atmospheric emissions of fluoro-




carbons  (mainly F-ll) in plastic foam manufacturing may be eliminated by




converting to use of methylene chloride as a blowing agent in flexible




foams  (which represent about 60 percent of F-ll foam use).  While use of




other blowing agents such as carbon dioxide and water in rigid foams is




possible, the foams lose much of their insulating properties and thus




their technical and economic competitive advantage.




     The fluorocarbon vapors produced in making foam products are now




vented to the atmosphere.  It is possible that vapor-recovery equipment




could be developed for recapturing the F-ll, but such equipment is not




now in existence.




d.  Solvent Applications - Of the five primary chemicals examined in this




study, only methyl chloroform has important solvent uses.  It is used




primarily as a metal cleaning solvent in both cold cleaning and vapor




degreasing.  There are several possible substitute solvents available;




the major ones are:  perchloroethylene, trichloroethylene, methylene




chloride, and various fluorocarbon solvents.  However, changing to any




of these solvents can present some serious technical problems with equip-




ment designed to use methyl chloroform.  Other cleaning systems not using




halocarbons are available, but are often more hazardous, less effective,




or require more expensive operating equipment.  Emissions may be greatly




reduced in many cases by close adherence to recommended operating procedures.






                               1-16

-------
Emission control is also possible using well-established solvent recovery




systems or other control technology which can often pay for itself in




several years by lowering make-up solvent costs.




4.   Chapter V-Conversion Timetables



     Whichever alternatives are chosen, there is a finite response time




for upgrading equipment using the chemicals or for developing and intro-




ducing alternative chemicals and products.  Table 1-5 lists the estimated




response time of the consuming industries to restrictions on the use of




the fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons.  The magnitude of economic disruption




resulting from implementation of the alternative regulatory strategies




is critically dependent on when the regulation is imposed and thus the




response time available to chemical producers, substitute product pro-




ducers, and the consumers of the chemicals.  The conversion response




times, which approximate the minimum time periods required for rapid yet




minimally disruptive conversion to alternatives, may be of two types:




conversion to a substitute chemical or conversion to an alternative pro-




duct for satisfying the demand for products currently using the controlled




chemicals.  These response times could range from as short as one year




for expanding production of existing products currently competing with




products using the controlled chemicals to as long as ten years for the




development, testing, and construction of manufacturing facilities for a




totally new aerosol propellant.




5.  Chapter VI-Definition of Primary Affected Industry Sectors




     Ten .primary industry sectors were examined in the ADL study.  They




ranged from the raw material producers to the sectors consuming the




fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons.  Table 1-6 provides a summary






                                 1-17

-------
                        Table 1-5   CONSUMING INDUSTRY RESPONSE TIMES TO CHEMICAL USE RESTRICTIONS
Consumine Industry

Intermediate chemical applications
Propellant applications
Refrigerant applications
Appliances
Mobile air conditioners
Home air conditioners
Commercial refrigeration
Commercial air conditioners
- reciprocating
- centrifugal
Blowing agent applications
Flexible foams
Rigid foams
Solvent applications
Emission reduction by
^equipment upgrading
(years)
Not an option
Not an option

2-3
3-4
2-3
2-3

2-3
2-3

2-3
2-3
1
Primary response
to ban of chemical use
(years)
2-7
1-2
to absorption to F-22
4-6 3-4
Indefinite Indefinite
3-5 zero
4-6 3-4

3-5 2-3
2-3 1-3

six months
3
1-2
Conversion to
substitute chemicals
(years)
5-10
4-10

5-11
5-11
5-11
5-11

5-11
5-11

six months
4-9
4-9
I
(-•
OO
           a.  The primary response times are the elapsed times required for the consuming industries to
               introduce substitute products to meet the demand now satisfied by the controlled chemicals
               or products using the chemicals.
           b.  The conversion to substitute chemicals times are those required to develop new chemicals
               with properties similar to the banned compounds and to modify the products using the banned
               chemicals.
           c.  In the event of a ban of F-ll and F-12, most refrigerant applications could be converted to
               F-22.  If F-22 is also banned, other refrigerants could be used or some products could be
               converted to absorption systems.
           Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates based on industry contacts.

-------
    Table 1-6.  ESTIMATED EMPLOYMENT AND PRODUCTION VALUE RELATED
                TO FLUOROCARBON AND CHLOROCARBON PRODUCTION AND
                CONSUMPTION - 1973

Raw materials:
Chlorine
Hydrofluoric acid
Basic chemical production:
Fluorocarbons
Chlorocarbons
Aerosols:
a
Containers
Valves, caps & related
materials
Concentrate ingredients
Aerosol fillers^ .
Aerosol marketers (total)
Production
support (R&D, marketing,
etc.)
Refrigeration: (1972)
Refrigeration equipment
. Household refrigerators
ft freezers
Blowing agent applications:
Foam and derived products
Raw materials
Solvent Applications
Chemical intermediate
Total
industry
employment

10,300
800

2,700
6,600

68,200
NAb
NA
14,000
15,000
6,000
9,000

120,000
32,000

45-, 000
10,000
NA
NA
Directly0
related
employment

1,350
330

2,700 .
1,320

2,500
2,000
NA
7,000
7,500
3,000
4,500

120,000
32,000

30,000
5,000
NA
3,000
Total
industry
production
value 1973.
($, millions)

490
140

240
600

4,900
NAb
NA
250
2,000

5,600
1,600

1,000
460
NA
NA
Directly
related
production
value 1973,
($, millions)

60
55

240
120

190
60
NA
130
1,000

5,600
1,600

600
230
NA
25
a.  Includes only cans  which represent 95 percent of total aerosol containers.
b.  NA =  not available.
c.  .Related employment refers.to production of F-ll, F-12, F-22,  carbon tetra-
;    chloride and methyl chloroform.
d.  Directly related .employment and production of aerosol fillers and marketers
    was estimated as 50 percent of total industry employment and  production.

Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                                    1-19

-------
characterization of these industry sectors.  The employment values
directly related to the production or use of fluorocarbons or chloro-
carbons should not be regarded as an estimate of the jobs to be lost if
the production of the chemicals is ended or reduced.  Some of these jobs
may be lost, but many would only be affected to the extent of having to
use different chemicals or materials.  Because of the preliminary nature
of the impact analysis in this report, no attempt has been made to
estimate job losses or gains as a result of restrictions in the use of
the chemicals.
a.  Raw Material Producers -^ The raw materials used in the production of
chlorocarbons and fluorocarbons which were examined in the study are chlorine
and hydrofluoric acid.  They are the raw materials which have a significant
portion of their production dedicated to the chlorocarbons and fluorocar-
bons.  An estimated 13 percent (by weight) of chlorine demand, with a
production value of approximately $60 million in 1973, is used in the pro-
duction of the five primary chemicals: F-ll, F-12, F-22, methyl chloroform,
and carbon tetrachloride.  An estimated 42 percent of hydrofluoric acid
demand, with a production value of about $55 million in 1973, is consumed
in the production of the three fluorocarbons — F-ll, F-12, and F-22,  A
large volume of the raw materials and basic chemicals is not sold on the
open market but consumed by other segments of the producing companies.
For this reason, "production values" have been estimated by applying market
prices to all production—rather than reporting sales, which would under-
state the value of the chemicals produced by each firm.
                                  1-20

-------
     In 1973, the value of the production of F-ll, F-12, and F-22 was




approximately $240 million, and the value of carbon tetrachloride and




methyl chloroform was about $590 million.  The sum of methyl chloroform,




carbon tetrachloride, and the portion of chloroform production used to




make fluorocarbons was ah estimated 12 percent of total chlorocarbon




value (including vinyl chloride) in 1973, or $120 million.  Raw material




and basic chemical production are capital-intensive operations and, as a




result, related employment for the production of the five chemicals is




relatively small at about 4,500 employees.




b.  Aerosol Producers - Aerosol products had an estimated $2 billion manu-




facturer '.s value in 1973.  About half of the 3 billion units were propelled




by fluorocarbons.  Approximately 60 percent of the aerosol products are




filled by contract fillers; the remaining 40 percent are filled by the




aerosol product marketers.  The aerosol fillers are characteristically




small companies whose business is heavily dependent on the filling of




aerosol products.  However, there are several large aerosol fillers which




account for more than 30 percent of the industry filling capacity yet.




represent only 3 percent of the total number of firms.  The aerosol




marketers are generally large corporations who are much less dependent




on aerosol products as their primary activity than are the aerosol fillers.




Employment by contract fillers and my manufacturers of aerosol containers,




valves, caps, and related materials, directly related to products using




fluorocarbon propellants, is an estimated 11,500.  Tn addition, an




estimated 7,500 persons are employed by aerosol marketers in production,




research and development, sales, and other support activities directly




related to products using fluorocarbon propellants.
                                   1-21

-------
 c.  Refrigeration and Air Conditioning Industry - In terms of
 employment and production value, the refrigeration industry
 is  the largest industry sector which would be significantly
 affected by restricting the use of the fluorocarbons.  Production value
 of  refrigeration equipment and household refrigerators and freezers was
 $7.2 billion in 1972.  Directly related employment was 150,000 in 1972.
 In  addition, an estimated 280,000 employees are indirectly related to
 the manufacture of air conditioning and refrigeration equipment, being
 involved in service, sales, and other related industries.  The industry
 is  characterized as mature, relatively concentrated, and highly compe-
 titive.  Air conditioning and refrigeration equipment sales account for
 a large portion of the total sales of many firms in the industry.  For
 some firms, such as the large automobile and appliance manufacturers,
 sales of refrigeration equipment and air conditioners do not represent
 a large portion of total corporate sales.
d.  Foam Products Industry - Employment in the production of chemical raw
materials used in the manufacture of foams and in the production of foam
products themselves totals an estimated 55,000.  The production value of foam
products is approximately $1 billion.  However, fluorocarbon blowing agents
are used in the manufacture of only 60 percent of foam products, so the
related foam production value and total employment can be estimated at
approximately $600 million and 35,000 respectively.  It is assumed that
 foam users would use an alternative product and would thus have few, if
 any, employment and sales effects.
                                    1-22

-------
e.  Solvent Applications - Estimates of employment and yiyduction value
have not been made for the users of the chemicals as solvents since they
are so diffuse.  The solvent users include the Defense Department, various
metalworking shops, electronic component manufacturers, and many others.
They cannot be classed as a single group, as has been done, for example,
with, the refrigeration industry.
6.  Chapter VII-Initial Economic Impact Assessment
     The categorization of the potential economic impacts resulting from
implementing nine regulatory options for reducing atmospheric emissions
of F-ll, F-12, and carbon tetrachloride is shown in Table 1-3.  The
application of the nine regulatory options to production and use of the
less stable compounds (F-22 and methyl chloroform) is reported in Chapter VII.

     The preliminary economic impact assessment shown in table 1-3 was
developed by considering the following principal factors:

      •  The availability of substitute products to the major industry
         sectors now consuming the chemicals,
      •  The current dependence of the consumiug sectors on the
         potentially controlled chemicals,
      •  The current availability of vapor-recovery or vapor-reduction
         technologies,
      •  The estimated elapsed time required for the industries now
         using the chemicals to convert to alternative chemicals,
         processes or products,
      •  The relative importance of the affected products to the overall
         business activities of which they are  a part,
                                  I~23

-------
     •  The relative importance of the cost of the chemicals to final




        product prices,




     •  The degree to which the facilities producing the chemicals can




        be converted to non-regulated chemicals,




     •  The integration of the production of the chemicals, or products




        using the chemicals, into large complexes of unaffected produc-




        tion activities as opposed to plants primarily dedicated to 'the




        affected products, and




     •  The potential for threatening the viability of the producing




        firms as opposed to a small or moderate reduction in their




        sales.






     There are six industry sectors which would primarily be affected




by restrictions on the  use of fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons:



     • -Producers of the chemicals ,




     •  Firms using the fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons as chemical



        intermediates ,




     •  Firms using the chemicals as propellants,




     •  Firms using the chemicals as refrigerants,




     •  Firms using the chemicals as blowing agents, and




     •  Firms using the chemicals as solvents.




     For these six sectors, emission reduction strategies of two types




have been considered.  The first, which is not feasible for aerosol




propellants, is to upgrade the equipment using the chemicals so that




emissions to the atmosphere are reduced even though the chemicals




continue to be used.   For refrigeration and solvent uses of the chemicals,




and probably blowing agent uses, significant emission reductions can be






                                 1-24

-------
achieved using this approach.  The second strategy (the only one feasible

for propellant applications) is to require or encourage development and

use of substitute chemicals or substitutes to the products, currently using

the chemicals.  It is important to remember that for non-propellant appli-

cations, especially, this strategy involves a considerable investment in

terms of added research and development.

     The nine regulatory options summarized in Table 1-3 were defined

through discussions with the EPA and are intended to achieve a range of

reductions of emissions to the atmosphere of.the three compounds over a

given time range.  These potential regulatory strategies have no official

standing; they are intended only to identify a range of alternatives and

to enable a more specific discussion of the relative disruptions likely

to occur in the six U.S. economic sectors shown.  Other regulatory actions

are possible and will undoubtedly be considered if a decision is made to

reduce emissions.

     The promulgation of a ban of all uses of E-ll, F-12, and carbon

tetrachloride after six months (regulatory option 1) would result in an

estimated 92 percent reduction in the total projected U.S. emissions of
                                    a
the compounds over a 20-year period.   A ban of only propellant uses

(option 3) would result in a 70 percent reduction in emissions to the

atmosphere over the 20  years.  If, instead of banning the uses after six
a
 On the assumption that the decision to issue the regulation is made in
January 1976, the 20-year period runs from January 1976 to January 1996.
A 5 percent per year use growth rate in the absence of the ban is assumed.
                                  1-25

-------
months,  the ban on all uses is set for three years after the January 1976


decision (option 5), then the emission reduction would be 83 percent


instead  of 92 percent.  Imposing a ban on only propellant uses after three


years  (option 7) would produce 63 percent lower emissions.  Option 9, a


ban of propellant uses after six years, would result in a 54 percent emis-


sion reduction over the 20-year period.


     The regulatory alternatives have a range of potential economic ^impacts

                                   a
from "severe" to "essentially none"  on the seven industry sectors


examined.  A ban of propellant uses of F-ll and F-12 after six months


would have a severe impact on contract fillers of aerosol cans and the


manufacturers of aerosol valves.  The impact on the aerosol marketers


would be moderate.  Postponing the ban for three years would reduce the


potential impact on the fillers and valve manufacturers to a limited to


moderate level, depending on consumer acceptance and availability of new


aerosol products not using F-ll and F-12.  With the ban held off for six


years, the impact on the valve manufacturers and fillers is projected to


range from limited to essentially none.  However, announcement of a ban


to be placed in effect in six years (or three years) could speed the


change cycle considerably as marketers of the alternative products vie


for market share.  In this instance, the economic impact on the current


manufacturers could be substantially greater than shown here.


     A ban imposed on refrigeration uses of F-ll and F-12 after six months

is expected to result in severe impacts on the refrigeration and air con-


ditioning industry.   A ban after three years could also be severe but
a
 See Chapter VII of the report for definition of these terms.
                                  1-26

-------
is more likely to be in the moderate category.  Products using substitute




refrigerants or substitute refrigeration technologies could not be ex-




pected to be available for approximately three years — and then only in




limited quantities.  Regulations which substantially increase the price




of F-ll and F-12 or which require upgrading of the refrigeration equip-




ment  and maintenance in order to reduce emissions are not expected to have




a detrimental effect on the producers beyond some modest increase in




product prices.                       \



     A ban of major uses of the chemicals after six months or three years




is expected to have a limited impact on the viability of the chemical




producers.  While the regulations would end all or much of the production




of the controlled chemicals, and some plant might even be closed, the value




of the products represents less than 10 percent of the chemical sales of




all but one producer.  It is important to realize, however, that most




halocarbon producers are integrated and that balances between raw materials




and various products can be critical to efficient operation.  The impact




on this sector of the chemical industry could therefore be much greater




than the level indicated when individual firms are considered.



     The nine regulatory options can be ranked by their reduction in




potential emissions and by potential economic impact on each industrial




sector.  Generally the ordering of the emission reduction and the economic




impacts are in opposite directions.  However, it is not possible to select




an optimal regulatory option knowing only the emission reductions and the




economic impacts.  It is not known, for example,  whether fluorocarbon




emissions are a correct measure of potential impact on the ozone.  The




emission reductions cited above are over a 20-year period following a
                                 1-27

-------
decision  to ban  the uses of  the chemicals.  As an alternative measure,
an estimate is made in  the report of  the reduction  in total emissions
 (measured from the time when the chemicals were first produced) as a
result  of initiating  the regulatory options in 1976.  Other ways of
measuring emissions can be suggested, but a generally accepted approach
has not yet been developed.   Alternative methods would probably not
change  the ranking of the regulatory  alternatives but would allow an
identification of which regulations resulted in acceptable levels of
emissions and a  specification of the  length of time before they were
achieved.
     Following from a need to define  the correct measure of emissions is
the need  to quantify  the benefits of  reducing the level of emissions.  The
benefits  would be the damages (if any) avoided by not having the ozone
layer diminished.  In order  to select among the regulatory options, one
must have some direct or indirect way of estimating the possible benefits
of  issuing the regulations.   The incremental benefits must then be com-
pared with the incremental costs which would result from implementing the
regulations.  The decision is much more complex than simply considering
emission  reductions versus a categorzation of economic impacts.  The results
of  this report should be regarded as  a partial information base and are
not in  themselves a sufficient data set on which to base long-term decisions.

     In addition to developing measures of possible  benefits  coming from
emission reductions,  one must consider that if  there is  a danger  to the
ozone layer,  it is a worldwide danger.  U.S.  halocarbon  emissions account
for only about half of current worldwide emissions.   In  addition,  it is
likely that the emissions growth rate will continue  to be greater outside
                                  1-28

-------
the United States.  Thus, restrictions on U.S. emissions could affect




only about half the current emissions and a diminishing share of world




emissions in the future.  If substantial reductions in worldwide emissions




should becoae necessary, other countries will also eventually have to



reduce atmospheric emissions of these compounds.
                                 1-29

-------
                    II.  HALOCARBON PRODUCTION AND USE


 A. INTRODUCTION

    This  chapter  presents  both  U.S.  and  world production  and  end-use  data  for

 the compounds of interest.  While data of this  type are generally available

 (at least for the chlorocarbons) in the U.S.,  this is not the case for

 other regions of the world.   Available data have been collected and,  where

 necessary,  estimates have  been made of likely world data  for  ten commer-

 cially important  chlorocarbons and  for five major chlorofluorocarbons:  F-ll,

 F-12,  F-22,  F-113 and F-114.a                   '

      Based  on the information presented in this chapter,  it is possible to

 gain  an appreciation for  the major  role played  by the U.S.  arid Europe in the

 production  and use of the  compounds of interest.  Together  these two  regions

 of the world share anywhere  from 75 to 90 percent of the  world's production

 of these chemicals.  While the consumption share in these regions is  probably

 somewhat lower because of  exports to less industrialized  regions of the

 world, it is certainly on  the same  order of magnitude as  the  production share.

      End-use patterns, for most of the chemicals studies, are nearly the

 same  throughout the world.  Notable exceptions  are the greater proportion

 of propellant applications for fluorocarbons in Europe relative to the U.S.

 and also wider use of trichloroethylene for metal cleaning outside the U.S.
throughout the report, "F" is used as an abbreviation for "fluorocarbon;"
 the numbers (11, 12, etc.) are commonly used identification for specified
 compounds.

                                      II-l

-------
 B.   FLUOROCARBON PRODUCTION AND USE




 1.   United States




 a.   Production - United States production data for the five major fluorocar-




 bons from 1960 to 1974 are presented in Table II-l.  Fluorocarbons 12 and




 11 are produced in greatest quantity, accounting for nearly 80 percent of




 total production in 1974.  Fluorocarbon 22 represents approximately 13 per-




 cent of current production and all other fluorocarbons combined contribute




 less than ten percent of the total.




     Production of these chemicals has increased greatly over the past decader—




with the exception of F-114.  Between 1964 and 1974, production of F-22




 increased at an average compound rate of 9 percent per annum.  Production




 of F-12 increased at a rate of approximately 8 percent per annum during the




 same period.  The production increase between 1964 and 1974 for F-ll repre-




sents a growth rate midway between those of fluorocarbons 12 and 22.  In




contrast to these three compounds, F-113 has experienced very rapid growth




 (over 18 percent per annum) in the past ten years and F-114 has experienced



only moderate growth since 1965.





    United States fluorocarbon producers and their current capacities are




presented in Table II-2.   Of the six U.S.  producers, DuPont has the largest




capacity with 42 percent of the total,  while Allied Chemical is second with




26 percent.   Union Carbide, Pennwalt, Kaiser and Racon together, account for




the remaining 32 percent.   The completion and start-up of DuPont's 500 million




pound fluorocarbon production plant in Corpus Christi, Texas, may be delayed




indefinitely because of the questionable future of fluorocarbons.  Total



production in 1973 was equal to approximately 88 percent of reported capacity.
                                    II-2

-------
           Table II-l.   UNITED STATES FLUOROCARBON PRODUCTION DATA
                             (millions of pounds)
Year

I960
1961
1962
1963
1964
1965
1966
1967
1968
1969

1970
1971
1972
1973°
1974°
1974
Percent
of total
F-ll
••.••• J s
: '72 :
91
125
140
149
171
170.
182'
204
239

245
258
300
334
347

32

F-12
'• '• ; -",
165 r
174
208
217
228 •
271
286 ]
310
326
368

375
390
439
489
509

46

F-22
"'' '.' '-1 "
40
45 •
49 '
54
59
64
70
78 '
86
94
i'
100
112
123
136
141

13

F-113
.,
.'Sm ,''...
Sm.
Sm.
Sm.
12
14
16
21
25
30

36
43
50
59
64

6

F-114
• f I : '. •
10
Sm'.
11 '
12
13
22
19
23
20
21
.• • "• •• '
22
23
25
26
27

2

Others
.
Sm. . s
Sm.
Sm.
Sm.
Sm.
Sm.
Sm.
Sm.
Sm.
Sm.
• I
Sm.
Sm.
Sm.
12
14

1

Total

>287
>310
>393
>423
>461
>542
>561
>614
>661
>752

>778
>826
>937
1056
1102
\
X>9700
••100 >^
a.  Includes F-13, F-14, F-21, F-115, F-116 and others.
b.  Sm. = less than 10 million pounds.
c.  One industry source believes production of F-ll; and p12 is overstated.

Sources:  U.S. International Trade Commission and Arthur D. Little, Inc.,
          estimates, based on industry contacts.
                                 II-3

-------
Table II-2.    UNITED STATES FLUOROCARBON PRODUCTION CAPACITY BY PRODUCER-1973
                           (units as Indicated below)
Producer
Allied
DuPont
Kaiser
Pennwalt
Racon
Union Carbide
Total
Million
Ib/yr.
310
500
50
115
20
200
1,195
Thousand
metric tons/yr.
141
227
23
52
9
90
542
Percent current
national capacity
26
42
4
10
1
17
100
 a.   Nameplate capacity based on published estimates.
 Sources:   Chemical Marketing Reporter and Arthur D.  Little, Inc.
                                  II-4

-------
b.  End Use - A distribution of fluorocarbbii consumption by end use for the



years 1963, 1968 and 1973  is presented  in Table II-3a. Aerosol propellants




have consistently been  the major application throughout this period, consuming




49 percent of fluorocarbonproduction in 1973.  The next largest use has




been as refrigerants, while uses in  the manufacture of plastics, as solvents,




and in plastic foam blowing applications have each consumed between four




and seven percent.   Other small applications of fluorocarboris include use




as fire extinguishing agents,  dielectric fluids and cutting fluids.




    Propellant applications of fluorocarbons are skewed heavily toward per-




sonal products.such, as  aerosol-anti-perspirarits and hair sprays.  These two




products, along with deoderants, account for approximately 75 percent of




fluorocarbon propellant use.  The only  other single application accounting




for more than  3.5 percent  of fluorocarbon propellant  use is  the medicinal and




pharmaceutical product  category which adds another 4  percent to the personal




product total.  Further detaila  of  propellant applications, as well as details




of those uses discussed below, are presented in Chapter IV of this report.




    Use of fluorocarbons as refrigerants is predominantly in air-conditioning




applications, which account for over 85 percent of annual fluorocarbon con-




sumption in this end-use category.   The largest single use of fluorocarbon




refrigerants is in various central air-conditioning units which consume



approximately 30 percent of current  annual use.  Second largest, with approxi-




mately 25 percent is mobile(mainly automobile) air-conditioning.  All other
a.  For a graphic representation of fluorocarbon uses see Figure VI-2.
                                     II-5

-------
          Table II -3.   UNITED STATES FLUOROCARBON CONSUMPTION BY END USE
                                     (percent)
End use
Aerosol propellants
Refrigerants
Plastics and resins
Solvents
Foam blowing agents
Exports and other
Total
1963
49
29
10
2
5
5
100
1968
45
30
10
5
4
6
100
1973
49
28
4
5
7
7
100
Sources:  Chemical Economics Handbook. Chemical Marketing Reporter and
          Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                                    II-6

-------
 refrigerant use categories are relatively small,  with only a few accounting

 for more than about 5 percent of annual refrigerant demand each.

     Foam blowing agent applications are much "smaller th'an the prbpellant

 and refrigerant uses discussed above.   Rigid polyurethane foams (about 50

 percent), and flexible polyurethane foams (about 40 percent) account for

 nearly all of the halocarbonsb used in the manufacture of plastic foams.

 Thermoplastic foam manufacture accounts  for about 20 percent of the total.

 These foam products are widely used in padding and insulation applications,

 and in the latter case, the fluorocarbon trapped in the foam adds to its

 Insulating properties.

    Solvent and polymer uses of  fluorocarbons account  for  5  and 4 percent

of demand respectively.  Earlier estimates of polymer  use  are believed  to

have been overstated.  The key solvent  applications are in the aerospace

and electronics industries.  Fluorocarbon polymers have unique properties

which make them valuable iri a number of special applications where a low

coefficient of friction and chemical inertness are important.
b.  Approximately 90 percent of the halocarbons used as blowing agents are
    fluorocarbons.
                                    II-7

-------
2.  World




a.  Production - World fluorocarbon capacity and production dat;a for 1973 are




presented in Table 11-4.  United States capacity, at 542 thousand metric tons,




represents 44 percent of the total.  Europe, with a capacity of 500 thousand




metric tons per year, accounts for an additional 41 percent of world capacity.




Japan's fluorocarbon production capacity is approximately 100 thousand metric




tons per year, which represents 8 percent of the total.  Other regions of the




world, including Latin America, Australia and the USSR are estimated to repre-




sent 7 percent of world fluorocarbon capacity.




    Announced capacity expansion plans, if implemented, would raise total




world capacity to approximately 1.6 million metric tons by 1977/78.  This




represents a world compound growth rate of 6-7 percent per annum.  Actual




unrestricted world demand growth for these compounds is forecast to be




approximately 8-9 percent per annum over the next five years.  Current-




atmospheric concerns may restrict this growth.  Fluorocarbons 11 and 12




represented an estimated 86 percent of world fluorocarbon production in 1973.








b.  End Use - Table II-5 presents estimated world consumption by end use for



fluorocarbons.  Consumption in other parts of the world is believed to approxi-




mate the pattern seen in the United States.  As in the United States, aerosol



propellants constitute the primary use of fluorocarbons.  Refrigerants are




second in terms of total fluorocarbon consumption, while plastic foam blowing




is third, and solvents and plastics are fourth and fifth most important re-




spectively.
                                II-8

-------
   Table II-4.   WORLD FLUOROCARBON PRODUCTION AND PRODUCTION CAPACITY-1973
                            (thousands of .metric tons)
Region
United States
Europe
Japan
Other
Total
Fluorocarbon type
F-ll and F-12
Other
Estimated
capacity.
542
500
100
80
1,222

1,050
172
Estimated
production
475
445
90
70
1,080

930
150
Percent
of total
44
41
8
7
100

8.6'
14
Sources:  chgaical. Marketing Reporter^ European Chemical News, Japan Chemical
          Week, private communication with industry, and Arthur D. Little, Inc.,
          estimates.
                                  II-9

-------
      Table  II-5.   WORLD FLUOROCARBON  CONSUMPTION  BY END  USE-1973
                       (units  as  indicated  below)
End use
Aerosol propellants
Refrigerants
Foam blowing agents
Plastics and resins
Solvents
Other
Total
Amount
Thousand metric
tons
595
315
75
30
45
20
1080
Millions of
pounds
1310
695
165
65
100
45
2380
Percent
55
29
7
3
4
2
100
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates based on private communication
         with industry.
                               11-10

-------
    Propellant applications are somewhat more important outside of the




U.S., bringing the world average use in this category to 55 percent of the




total.  Refrigerant and foam applications are equally important in the U.S.




and the rest of the world, while solvent and polymer use are slightly less




important outside of the United States.  In general, the U.S. accounts for




roughly half .of fluorocarbon demand in each use category.
                                11-11

-------
 C.   CHLOROCARBON  PRODUCTION AND USE
 1.   United  States
 a.   Production -  Current and historical production data for ten commercially
 important chlorocarbons have been collected for this study.  These data are
 presented in Table II-6.  Growth in production for some of these compounds
 has  leveled off or dropped in the past few years.  For example, trichloro-
 ethylene production reached 611 million pounds in 1970 but was only 434
 million pounds in 1974—a drop of nearly 30. percent  in 4 years.   Ethyl chloride
 production  increased by 25 percent between 1960 and  1965;  but since the early
 1960's fluctuation, rather than growth in production, has been the rule.  Two
 rapidly growing chlorocarbons have been ethylene dichloride (EDC) and vinyl
chloride monomer (VCM) for which present production levels are approximately six
 times as great as in I960.  This represents a growth of approximately 14
 percent per annum during this period.  Methyl chloride and methylene chloride
 have grown steadily throughout the last fifteen years to production levels
 more than five times greater than in 1960.  This is equivalent to a growth
 rate of more than 12 percent per annum.  Perchloroethylene and chloroform
 have exhibited steady but slower growth rates of approximately 10 percent
 annually between 1960 and 1974.  Carbon tetrachloride production grew steadily
 through 1970 and has recently remained at a level close to 1 billion pounds per
 year.  Figures for the production of methyl chloroform  (1,1,1-trichloroethane)
 were not published until 1966, at which point 243 million pounds were pro-
 duced.  In the eight years since 1966 production has more than doubled to
 590 million pounds in 1974.
                               11-12

-------
            Table II-6.   UNITED STATES CHLOROCARBON PRODUCTION DATA
                              (millions of pounds)
Year
1960
1961
1962
1963
1964
1965
1966
1967
1968
1969
1970
1971
1972
1973
1974

Carbon
Tetrachloride
372
384
• 484
519 •
536
: 594
648
714
763 :
883
1011 ,
•1009
997
1047
= 1014
v".
Chloro-
form
76
77
98
105
119
153
179
-191
181
216
' 240
231
235
'253
301

Ethyl
Chloride
.545
497
537
592
666
686
677
618
573
679
678
620
576
660
660
'
•j
Ethylene
Dichloride
1267
1368
1774
1793
2199
2456
3617
3971
4799
6037
746Q
7558
7809
9293
7721

Methyl
Chloride
84
105
108
114
134
188
237
276
305
403
423
437
454
544
458

 Actual production of EDC is estimated to be from 1 to 15 percent greater
 than the reported figure.

Sources:  U.S. International Trade Commission, Chemical Economics Handbook,
          and Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                               11-13

-------
      Table II-6. (continued).   UNITED STATES CHLOROCARBON PRODUCTION DATA
                               (millions of pounds)
Year
1960
1961
1962
1963
1964
1965
1966
1967
1968
1969
1970
1971
1972
1973
1974
Methyl
Chloroform
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
243
NA
299
324
366
375
441
548
590
Methylene
Chloride
113
116
144
148
180
211
267
262
303
366
402
401
471
520
591
Perchloro-
ethylene
209
225
320
325
366
429
463
533
636
635
707
705
734
706
731
Trichloro-
ethylene
353
309
356
368
370
435
480
490
519
597
611
515
427
452
434
Vinyl
Chloride
1037
1044
1312
1435
1615
2000
2500
2424
2969
3736
4040
4336
5089
5351
5700
NA = Not available or negligible.


 Sources:   U.S.  International Trade Commission,  Chemical Economics  Handbook,
           and Arthur D.  Little,  Inc.,  estimates.
                                11-14

-------
    Relatively limited-foreign trade data are available for the chloro-


carbons (see Table II-7.).  Where published, imports are small and exports


vary (1974) from 4 percent of production for chloroform and perchloroethylene,


to 18 percent for methylene chloride.  In 1974, net exports for the 6 com-


pounds for which data are available amounted to approximately 1 billion

            ' \          '-          '
pounds, with an estimated favorable trade contribution in excess of $100


millionl
                               11-15

-------
        Table II-7.   UNITED STATES TRADE IN SELECTED*CHLOROCARBONS

                            (millions of pounds )
Chlorocarbon
Chloroform
Imports
Exports
Ethylene dichloride
Imports
Exports
Methylene chloride
Imports
Exports
Perchloroethylene
Imports
Exports
Trichloroethylene
Imports
Exports
Vinyl chloride monomer
Imports
Exports
1974

NA
11

NA
401

12
106

22
29

2
45

NA
412
1973

NA
NA

NA
368

42
114

45
80

47
39

NA
421
1972

NA
NA

NA
376

11
104

27
107

61
42

NA
622
1971

NA
NA

NA
347

8
87

44
NA

9
52

NA
620
NA = Not available or negligible.


3.
 Trade data are not available for the four chlorocarbons not shown.



Source:  U.S. International Trade Commission.
                                11-16

-------
b.  End Use - Estimated U.S. end-use patterns for the ten chlorocarbons

                            a
studied are presented below.

    Carbon Tetrachloride - Carbon tetrachloride (CTC) is used mainly for the

production of fluorocarbons.  This use accounted for 95 percent of consump-


tion in J.973.  In 1968, fluorocarbon production consumed 88 percent of

United States carbon tetrachloride supplies.  The remaining production is

believed to be mainly for export (figures are not available), grain fuiaigant


and.miscellaneous solvent applications (see Table II-8).  Of the CTC con-

sumed in the U.S., nearly all goes to the production of F-ll and F-12.
           ....      •     .    .';.••"    »'•>•'    •     '     .         ••
        •    Table II-8;  CARBON TETRACHLORIDE END-USE PATTERN
                                     (percent)  .

End Use (1973 production 1047 million Ib)
Fluorocarbon 12 production
Fluorocarbon 11 production
Other (including export and solvent )
Total . .

1968
57
31
12
100

1973
60
35
5
100
Source:  Chemical Marketing Reporter and Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.

    Chloroform - Chloroform in the United States is used almost totally  as

an intermediate in the production of flubrocarbon 22.  Roughly half is used

to produce F-22 gas, while approximately 40 percent is used for manufacture

of fluorocarbon plastics.  The third end-use category includes exports,  and

medical and pharmaceutical solvent applications,  (see Table II-9.).
a.  For a graphic representation of chlorocarbon uses see Figure VI-I.

                                11-17

-------
                 Table II-9.   CHLOROFORM END-USE PATTERN
                                 (percent)
End Use (1973 production 253 million Ib)
Fluorocarbon 22 (gas) production
Fluorocarbon 22 (for plastic) production
Other (including export and solvent)
Total
1968
60
30
10
100
1973
52
41
7
100
Source:   Chemical Marketing Reporter and Arthur D.  Little,  Inc.,  estimates.

                 \

     Ethyl Chloride - Most  of  the ethyl  chloride produced  in 1973  in  the

U.S. was used  in the manufacture of  tetraethyl  lead, an antiknock  compound

for gasoline  (see Table  11-10).  Miscellaneous  uses include production of

certain plastics, dyes,  and Pharmaceuticals, and use as a  solvent.  The

end-use pattern  has changed very little  in  the  past five years.  Exports


are not  reported separately, but are believed  to be small.

               Table 11-10.  ETHYL CHLORIDE END-USE PATTERN
                                 (percent)
End Use (1973 production 660 million Ib)
Tetraethyl lead production
Other (including export and solvent)
Total
1968
88
12
100
1973
85
15
100
 Source:   Chemical Marketing Reporter and Arthur D.  Little,  Inc.,  estimates.
                               11-18

-------
    '-Ethyierie Dichloride '-' More  than three-quarters  of  ethylene  dichloride


 consumption  in  1973 was  for  the  manufacture of vinyl chloride monomer,  a

                                   t  '.'•'-'
 raw material-for  polyvinyl chloride plastic.  Other applications include use


as a lead scavenger in gasoline additives, and as a raw material for the


 production of' trichloroethylene,  perchloroethylene,  methyl  chloroform,


 ethyiamines  and viriylidene chloride  (see  Table 11-11).   Exports  accounted


 for about 5percent of ethylene dichloride consumption in 1973.



           Table  11-11.  ETHYLENE DICHLORIDE END-USE PATTERN

                               :   (percent)
End Use (1973 prod. 9293 million Ib)
Vinyl chloride production
Lead scavenger ,
Trichloroethylene production
Perchloroethylene production
Methyl chloroform production
Ethylamine production
Vinyl id ene chloride production
0 ther ( inc luding expor t )
Total
1968
75
4
3
3
2
3
2
8
100
1973
78
3
3
3
2
2
2
8
100
Sources:  Chemical Marketing Reporter and Arthur Pi Little, Inc., estimates.
                                11-19

-------
     Methyl Chloride - Methyl chloride la used chiefly as an intermediate

in the production of silicones and tetramethyl lead (see Table H-rl2).

Its use in producing silicones has fallen since 1968 when 60 percent of raethvl

chloride went to this application.  Methyl chloride for production of

tetramethyl lead has grown rapidly ir> the same 5 year period, hur. this

application, as with tetraethyl lead, is threatened by the shift to lead-

free gasoline.  Miscellaneous uses include the manufacture of butyl rubber,

methyl cellulose, herbicides and quaternary amines.

               Table 11-12.    METHYL CHLORIDE END-USE PATTERN
                                  (percent)
End Use (1973 prod. 544 million Ib)
Silicone production
Tetramethyl lead production
Butyl rubber production
Methyl cellulose production
Herbicide production
Quaternary amine production
Other (including export)
Total
1968
60
18
12
6
1
1
2
100
1973
43
38
4
3
2
3
7
100
Source:  Chemical Marketing Reporter and Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                              H-20

-------
      Methyl Chloroform (1,1,1-Trichloroethane)  -  Metal  cleaning  is the  largest

 application for methyl chloroform, consuming approximately 70 percent of

 U.S.. production  in 1973  (see?Table 11-13).   This  chemical  is  employed in both

 cold metal cleaning and  vapor degreasing.   Like perchloroethylene, methyl

 chloroform has replaced  trichloroethylene  for vapor degreasing in areas where

 the latter has been restricted because of  its link to photochemical smog

•formation.    Although exports are not reported separately, trade publications

 have indicated that exports may be as  high as 14  percent of production  in

 the U.S.  at present.   In 1971 the use  of methyl chloroform in the production

 of  vinylidene chloride began; in 1973  this application  accounted for

 8 percent of  U.S.  production.

               Table 11-13.   METHYL  CHLOROFORM  END-USE  PATTERN
              '                       (percent)
End Use (1973 production 548 million Ib)
Cleaning solvent (cold cleaning & vapor degreasing)
Exports
Vinylidene chloride productidn
Other (aerosol^ solvent for adhesives etc.J
Total •?
1968
80
13
-
7
100
1973
70
14
8
8
100
 Source:  Chemical Marketing Reporter and Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                                    11-21

-------
     Methylene Chloride - Methylene chloride is used ir> many applications

as a solvent (see Table II -14.).  Virtually none is used as a chemical

intermediate.  The single most important application of methylene chloride

is in paint removal, which accounted for 40 percent of consumption in

1973.  Exports, which were first published in 1970, represent 20 percent

of consumption.  Other applications are as an aerosol product vapor pressure

depressant, in solvent degreasing, plastics processing, quick-drying coatings,

pharmaceutical and food extraction, and as a liquid component of fire

extinguishers.


                Table 11-14.   METHYLENE CHLORIDE END-USE PATTERN
                                    (percent)
End Use (1973 production 520 million lb}
Paint remover
Solvent degreasing
Aerosol sprays (solvent, vapor depressant)
Plastics processing
Other (coatings, extraction solvent)
Export
Total
1968
25
20
10
12
33
-
100
1973
40
10
8
6
16
20
100
Source:  Chemical Marketing Reporter and Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                                11-22

-------
     Berchloroethylene - The largest use of perchloroethylene is in dry

cleaning and textile processingj accounting for 65 percent of production

in ,1973 (see Table IT - 15).  This use has declined since 1968 due to the

trend tpward .wash-and-wear clothing.  Perchloroethylene is also used in

industrial- metal cleaning operations—both cold cleaning and vapor degreasing.

It has largely replaced'trichlorbethylene for vapor degreasing in areas

where air pollution regulations haves restricted use of the latter. Approximately

8 percent of perch^orqethylene production.,is used as a chemical intermediate

in the production of fluorocarbons.  Exports rose to about 10 percent of

consumption in 1973.   ~
                Table 11*15.  PERCHLOROETHYLENE END-USE PATTERN
                                    ..(percent)  ,   •
End Use (1973 production 706 million Ib)
, , • I c •
Dry cleaning solvent & textile processing
Chemical , intermediate (fluorocarbons 113, 114)
Vapor degreasing
Other (including export)
Total
1968

85
": . • "• 8 ' •
2
5
100
1973

65
8
12
15
100
Source:  Chemical Marketing Reporter and Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                               11-23

-------
     Trichloroethylene - Trichloroethylene is largely consumed in metal

cleaning (see Table II -16,).  This use has decreased from 94 percent in

1968 to 86 percent in 1973 due mainly to air pollution restrictions.  This

application includes both vapor degreasing and cold metal cleaning, of which

vapor degreasing represents by far the largest share.  Exports represented

approximately 9 percent of production of 1973.  Use of trichloroethylene

as an extraction solvent has been a minor application.


                Table II -16.  TRICHLOROETHYLENE END-USE PATTERN
                                    (percent)
End Use (1973 production 452 million Ib)
Metal cleaning (cold cleaning & vapor degreasing)
Extraction solvent
Other (including export)
Total
1968
94
3
3
100
1973
86
3
11
100
Source:  Chemical Marketing Reporter and Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                                11-24

-------
     Vinyl Chloride - The dominant use of vinyl chloride is in the

production of polyvinyl chloride (see Table II -17).   Polyvinyl chloride

(PVC) is an important plastic with applications in the fields of construction,

communications, transportation and packaging.  In addition to its key use

as an intermediate for the production of PVC, vinyl chloride is also used

as an intermediate in the manufacture of methyl chloroform.  Exports accounted

for 8 jpercent of production in 1973.


                  Table II- 17.  VINYL CHLORIDE END-USE PATTERN
                                     (percent)
End Use (1973 prod. 5351 million ib)
Polyvinyi chloride (PVC) production
Export
Other
Total
1968
85
12
3
100
1973
89
8
3
100
Source:  Chemical Marketing Reporter, and Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                                11-25

-------
2.  World




a.  Production - United States production levels represent from 30 to 60




percent of world-wide production for the ten chlorocarbons studied (see




Table II -18).  Production growth rates have been somewhat greater in the




rest of the world than in the United States.  For example, it is




estimated that chlorocarbpn production (mostly of ethylene dichloride) in




Japan more than doubled between 1968 and 1973.




     Approximately 50 percent of world carbon tetrachloride was produced




outside of the United States in 1973.  Of that, 40 percent was produced




in Europe and 10 percent in Japan and elsewhere.  The average growth rate




outside of 'the United States from 1968-73 was approximately 11 percent




per annum and within the United States approximately 6 percent per annum




during this five year period.




     Approximately half of world chloroform production in 1973 was outside




the United States, mainly in Europe.  By way of contrast, in 1968 the




United States produced approximately three-quarters of the world's chloro-



form.




     Little information was available for world-wide production of ethyl




chloride.  U.S. production probably accounts for approximately half of the




world total, with estimated production in Europe at about one-third of the



global figure.




     The United States accounted for less than half of the world's ethylene




dichloride production in 1973.  European production is somewhat greater than




that of the United States, and Japan represents more than half of either
                                11-26

-------
      Table 11-18.  ESTIMATED WORLD CHLOROCARBON PRODUCTION - 1973
                       (units as indicated below)
Chlorocarbon
Carbon tetrachloride
Chloroform
Ethyl chloride
.Ethylene dichloride
Methyl chloride
Methyl chloroform .
Methylene chloride
Pechloroethylene
Trichloroethylene
Vinyl chloride
Regional percent of totala
United States Europe Other
50
50
55
35
60
60
55
45
30
35
40
40
30
40
35
30
30
45
55
40
10
10
15
25
5
10
15
10
15
25
World total
Thousand Millions
metric tons Of pounds
950
^225
550
12,000
400
420
425
750
700
7,100
2,100
500
1,200
V
26,450
875
925
925
1,650
1,550
15,650
aRounded to nearest 5 percent.

Source:  U.S. and foreign trade publications and Arthur D. Little, Inc.,
         estimates.
                                11-27

-------
Europe or the United States.  Total world production in 1973 was approxi-




mately 12 million metric tons.




     Almost all methyl chloride is produced in Europe and the United States.




The United States accounted for approximately 60 percent of world production




in 1973 and Europe about 35 percent.  The world production figure was about




400 thousand metric tons.




     Methyl chloroform, or 1,1,1 - trichloroethane, follows a similar




pattern to the other chlorocarbons in terms of world production allotment




among regions.  Of the 375 thousand metric tons produced in 1973, the U.S.




accounted for 60 percent, Europe for 30 percent and the rest of the world




for 10 percent.



     More than half of the world's methylene chloride is produced in the United




States.  Europe produced 30 percent in 1973 and Japan 15 percent.  Outside




of the United States methylene chloride production rose 42 percent  between




1968-1973; within the United States it grew 72 percent or nearly 12 percent




per year.



     More than half (55 percent) of world perchloroethylene production is




outside the United States, mainly in Europe.  Japan accounts for 10 percent




of world production.  The world growth rate between 1968-1973 was 36 percent,




or 6 percent per year.




    ."Two-thirds of the world's trichloro«thylene is produced outside of the




United States.  Europe accounts for just over half the world production of




trichloroethylene.  Japan produces 15 percent of the world supply.  The




growth rate of trichloroethylene has been very low:  from 1968 to 1973
                                 II-28

-------
production rose only 9 percent, or 2 percent per year.  U.S. production




fell in this time period due, in part, to air pollution restrictions.




     As with ethylene dichloride, world vinyl chloride production is




slightly greater in Europe than in the United States.  Japan produces




approximately 25 percent of the world total, which was approximately




seven million metric tons in 1973.




b.   End Use - Only limited information is available on world application




patterns outside of the United States.  However, the available data for




both Europe and Japan indicate that end-use patterns for these compounds are




very similar throughout the world.  A notable exception is the use of tri-




chloroethylene for metal cleaning in Europe.  This application has become




relatively less important in the United States because of photochemical




smog problems.
                               11-29

-------
              III.  HALOCARBON EMISSIONS TO THE ATMOSPHERE




A.  INTRODUCTION

    Just as the United States accounts for approximately half of world

production for the compounds of interest, so too does the United States

account for this fraction of world halocarbon emissions.  This chapter

examines the various emission sources to determine the magnitude of emis-

sions in each application and thus lays the groundwork for Chapter IV.
»'                                                   '
    The predominant chlorofluorocarbon emission source, both in the United

States and worldwide, is the chlorofluorocarbon-filled aerosol can.  These

chemicals are found in only about half of all aerosol products, with

greatest use being in personal products such as anti-perspirants and hair

sprays.  The second greatest source of chlorofluorocarbon emissions is

automotive and commercial air-conditioning equipment.   The combined atmos-

pheric emissions from all propellant and refrigerant applications accounted

for almost 90 percent of all U.S. chlorofluorocarbon emissions (about 725

million pounds) in 1973.

    Among the chlorocarbons, the greatest atmospheric emissions are from

those chemicals commonly used as solvents.   Methyl chloroform,  methylene

chloride,  perchloroethylene and trichloroethylene all  had 1973  emission

levels in the U.S. estimated at greater than 400 million pounds.
                                   III-l

-------
B.  DISCUSSION OF EMISSION ESTIMATES AND ENVIRONMENTAL FATE


1.  Atmospheric Emissions from Chemical Manufacturing Processes,

Transportation and Storage

    Emissions of a particular hydrocarbon (or halocarbon) from chemical


manufacturing can ge associated with three different processes:


    •  The process(es) used in the initial manufacture of the chemical,


    •  The process(es) used to manufacture other chemicals from the


       particular chemical; i.e., its use as an intermediate, and


    •  Processes in which the particular chemical may be produced as


       a by-product.


    Emissions related to the third category above, i.e., by-product


formation, are not being considered in this study even though the amounts

                   a
may be significant.    Emissions of a particular chemical related to the


first and second categories are generally on the same order of magnitude,


on the basis of pounds lost per pound of product produced.


    Two recent surveys, for the EPA, of hydrocarbon emissions from chemical


manufacturing processes indicate that, on the average, total hydrocarbon


emissions are between 0.01 and 0.02 pounds per pound of product produced.


Details are given in Tables III-l and III-2.


    The emission factors given in Tables III-l and III-2 allow the estimation


of an average emission factor to be used for the specific chemicals in this


study.  It should be noted that, while the type of reactions reported on in


Table III-2 are more pertinent to this study (because they deal only with
a.  This emission category is relatively unimportant for those chemicals
    which have large use-related emissions, such as the chlorinated solvents.
                                  III-2

-------
   Table III-l.
HYDROCARBON EMISSIONS  FROM CHEMICAL MANUFACTURE
        Reaction
             Total
           hydrocarbon
            emissions
              1973
          (million Ibs/yr)
Production 1973
million Ibs/yr)
                                                           Hydrocarbon
                                                            loss rate
                                                        (Ibs/lbs product
                                                            produced)
 I) 40 Industrially
    important organic
    chemical reactions
             1227.6
     95,400
                                                              .0129
II) SPECIFIC EXAMPLES;

    1.
    Vinyl chloride
    production

2.  Ethylene dichlo-
    ride (EDC)
    production:

    a.  via oxychlo-
       rination

    b.  via direct
       chlorination
                                 17.6
                                5,300
                      .0033
                                 95. l
                                 29. 0
                                                 .0227
                                                 .0057
^Excludes methane; includes H.S and all volatile organics.

 Loss of EDC itself from this manufacturing process is estimated to be
 81.4 million Ibs/yr resulting in a loss rate of .0195 Ib/lb of EDC produced.

°Loss of EDC itself from this manufacturing process is estimated to be
 16.8 million Ibs/yr or a loss rate of .0033 Ibs/lb of EDC produced.

 Actual production in 1973 estimated to be 90 percent of production capacity
 (ADL estimate).

Sources;

1.   "Survey Reports on Atmospheric Emissions from the Petrochemical Industry"
    (in 4 volumes); U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, 1974.  Report
    numbers:  EPA-450/3-73-005a-d.

2.   "Engineering and Cost Study of Air Pollution Control for the Petro-
    chemical Industry, Volume 3:  Ethylene Dichloride Manufacture by
    Oxychlorination," U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, November 1974.
    Report Number:  EPA-450/3-73-006c.
                                   III-3

-------
   Table III-2.   HYDROCARBON EMISSIONS3 FROM CHEMICAL MANUFACTURING
                           PROCESSES INVOLVING CHLORINATION
 I) From 25 Industrially
    Important dhlorination
    reactions

II) From 16 industrially
    important chlorination
    reactions for the manu-
    facture of .ethylene
    dichloride, carbon tetra-
    chloride, ethyl chloride,
    methyl chloroform, chloro-
    form, methyl chloride,
    methylene chloride, tetra-
    chloroethylene, and tri-
    chloroethylene.
                                    Estimated total
                                     hydrocarbon
                                    emissions-1970:
                                   aver, per process
                                   (Ibs/lb of product)
.016 + .009
.019 + .009
                   Estimated loss
                   of manufactured
                   chemical-1970:
                  aver,  per process
                 (Ibs/lb of product)
.008 + .008
 The estimated emissions given were based on little or no real data on actual
 emissions; the error limits  given in the table are average deviations.

DThe reactions here included in the 25 reactions of I.
Source:

"Air Pollution from Chlorination Process;" Report prepared for Office of Air
Programs, U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, March, 1972, by Process
Research, Inc., Industrial Planning and Research, Cincinnati, Ohio under
Task Order Number 23 of Contract Number CPA 70-1.
                                    III-4

-------
chlorinated hydrocarbon production) than those reported on in Table III-l,


the accuracy of the emissions estimates in Table III-l are considered to


be much more reliable.  Data for the emissions estimates in Table III-l


were obtained from detailed questionnaires mailed out to the manufacturing


companies while essentially no real emissions data were used for the re-


sults shown in Table III-2.


    In light of these data, it seems reasonable to state that average


total hydrocarbon emissions from a manufacturing process is 0.013 pounds


per pound of product produced, and that a reasonable average for losses of

                                             a
the particular compounds of interest is 0.006  pounds per pound of product


produced.


    A more precise estimate for losses of EDC from EDC manufacturing


processes is possible from the information given in Table III-l.  Assuming


that, in 1973, 45% of EDC production was via oxychlorination and 55% via


direct chlorination, a weighted EDC loss rate of 0.013 pounds per pound


of product is obtained.


    Since it is desirable to have one loss estimate that covers both (1)


the manufacturing process, and (2) the transportation and storage of the


particular chemical, a transportation and storage loss must be estimated.


For those chemicals used only as intermediates, transportation will be in


bulk via rail, truck, ship, or barge (or via pipeline for intraplant


transfers).  These modes of transport should entail relatively small losses,


estimated to be on the order of about 0.001  pounds per pound of product.
a.  These average emission rates are believed to be conservative estimates.
                                  III-5

-------
Storage will also be in bulk and should not add measurably to this loss


factor.


    This estimated transportation and storage loss factor, when added to


the manufacturing process loss factor estimated above for a particular


chemical, results in an estimated loss factor covering both manufacture,


transportation and storage of 0.007 pounds per pound of product.  The total


loss rate of EDC should be kept at 0.013 pounds per pound of product since


most EDC is consumed at the site of its manufacture for vinyl chloride


production.


2.  Environmental Fate of Fluorocarbons and Chlorocarbons


    This section briefly describes the anticipated environmental fate of


the fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons under study in an attempt to predict


which of them should warrant the most concern.


    Most all of the compounds of interest have low boiling points (there-


fore, high vapor pressures), and low solubility in water  (see Table III-3).


These two facts help insure that almost all losses of these chemicals


(i.e., from production, transportation, storage, use, and disposal) find


their way, eventually, into the atmosphere.  It is estimated that approxi-


mately 1 percent of the losses of these chemicals fails to reach the atmos-


phere; larger amounts of some of these chemicals are initially discharged


in waste waters, and some of this dissolved portion will be "lost" by


hydrolysis or absorption, but the major portion will be returned to the


atmosphere in short order.  For example, the mean residence time of per-

                                                          «a
chloroethylene in the ocean has been estimated as 1 month.
a.  Assessing Potential Ocean Pollutants, National Academy of Sciences,
    Washington, D.C., 1975.
                                  III-6

-------
    Table III-3.  SOME PROPERTIES OF FLUOROCARBONS AND CHLOROCARBONS

Chemical
F-ll
F-12
F-13
F-14
F-21
F-22
F-113
F-114
F-115
F-116
F-13B1 ;
F-114B2
F-C-318

F-502 (azeotrope) j
/
Carbon tetrachloride
Chloroform
Ethyl chloride
Ethylene dichloride
Methyl chloride
Methyl chloroform
Methylene chloride
Perchlorethylene
Trie hlo roe thyl ene
Vinyl chloride.

Formula
CC13F
CC12F2
CC1F3
CF4
CHC12F
CHC1F
CC12F-CC1F2
CC1F2-CC1F2
CC1F2-CF3
CF3-CF3
CBrF3
CBrF2~CBrF2
CF,CF_CF0CF9
1 2. 2 2| 2
CHC1F2 (48.8%)
CC1F2CF3 (51.2%)
cci4
CHC13
CH3CH2C1
CH2C1CH2C1
CH3C1
CC13CH3
CH2C12
CC1 =CC1_
2 z
CHC1=CC12
CH2CHC1

BP(°C)
23.82
-29.79
-80.00
-128.00
8.9
-40.75
47.57
3.77
-39.10
-78.20
-57.75
47.3
5.8

1 -45.42
V
76.80
61.26
12.20
83.50
- -24.22 .
74.10
40.10
121.02
87.00
-13.90
Solubility (wt percent)
in water (25 °C )
0.011
0.028
0.009
0.0015
0.95
0.13
0.017
0.013
0.006
N/A
0.0095 (70°F)
N/A
N/A

N/A

0.08 (20°C)
1.0 (15°C)
0.574g/100ml (20°)
0.869g/100ml (20°)
400cm3/100ml
slightly soluble
2g/100ml (20°C)
slightly soluble
0.1
slightly soluble
Sources:  DuPont Technical Literature, and Handbook of Chemistry and Physics,
          44th Edition, CR Publishing Co., Cleveland, Ohio.
                                  III-7

-------
    The next most important aspect of the chemicals being investigated is




their degree of chemical stability and inertness.  The carbon-fluorine




bond is a strong one in comparison with carbon bonds to chlorine, bromine,




hydrogen or a second carbon atom.  Additionally, increasing the number of




fluorine atoms in the molecule tends to increase the carbon-chlorine bond




strength on the molecule.  The resistance to degradation by hydrolysis and




heat is said to parallel bond energies and thus the fluorocarbons are con-




sidered to be quite stable and inert.  Within the group of fluorocarbons,




the perfluoro compounds (e.g., CF,, C.F,) would be expected to be the most




stable, followed by the chlorofluorocarbons (e.g., CC1-F, CC12F2) and,




finally, the chlorofluorohydrocarbOns (e.g., CHC1F2).   Below the fluoro-




carbons in stability and inertness would be the chlorocarbons (chlorohydro-




carbons)—with one or more exceptions.  The one fairly certain exception




is carbon tetrachloride which is more akin to the fluorocarbons in its




relative stability and inertness.




    The general rule that seems to follow from the above is that the most




stable and inert compounds are those that are the most highly halogenated




(i.e., have the least number of hydrogen atoms), and that, of all the




halogenated compounds, the fluorinated compounds are the most stable.  The




presence of a double bond (e.g., in CC12=CC12 and CHC1=CC12), a hydrogen




atom, or a small ring structure (e.g*, in F-C318) tends to decrease the




stability of the compound.  A summary listing of the chemicals being studied




is given in Table III-4, broken down into three groups based on their ex-




pected degree of stability.   This degree of stability, along with estimated
                                  III-8

-------
        Table III-4.  RELATIVE STABILITY OF THE HALOCARBONSa
Group I;  Relatively high stability (over ten-year atmospheric residence)
                                           *F-115
                                           *F-116
                                           *F-13B1
                                           *F-114B2
                                           *F-C318
                                            carbon tetrachloride
Group II;  Intermediate stability (under ten-year atmospheric residence)
                            methyl chloroform
Group III;  Relatively low stability (under one-year atmospheric residence]1

             chloroform                    ethylene dichloride
             ethyl chloride                perchloroethylene
            , methyl chloride               methylene chloride
             vinyl chloride                trichloroethylene
 a.   The five halocarbons that were emphasized in the analysis of likely
     economic'impact are underlined.   These chemicals are of relatively
     high stability and are produced in large quantities relative to the
     other halocarbons in Groups I and II.   F-502 contains F-22 and F-115
     and is not shown;separately.   The compounds marked with an asterisk
     (*) are produced only in relatively small quantities.

 Source;  Arthur D. Little, Inc.,  estimates, based on private communication
          with EPA, and Wofsy, et al., Science. 187, 535 (Feb. 14, 1975).
                                    III-9

-------
levels of atmospheric emission, determined the emphasis of our analysis in

the following chapters of the report.

    It is generally agreed that any chemical with a high vapor pressure at

ambient temperatures, a low solubility in water, and high chemical stability

and inertness will, in large measure, accumulate and persist in the atmos-

phere.  The main uncertainties today are over the degree of accumulation,

the duration of the persistence, and the nature of possible reactions with

ozone and other components of the atmosphere.  Additionally, the time re-

quired for these chemicals to reach the stratosphere (where the ozone is

found) is an important parameter.

    With respect to accumulation of fluorocarbons, specifically of F-ll,
                     «
it has been contended  that measured atmospheric concentration levels, when

summed together on a global scale, equal the net world production of F-ll

up to the time the measurements were made.  The variability of the measure-

ments on which this estimate is based is large enough, however, to cast

some doubt on the implication that there is no loss of fluorocarbons (due

to degradation or chemical reaction) in the lower atmosphere.

    It is also contended  that fluorocarbons have a residence time in the

atmosphere of between 40 and 150 years.  Carbon tetrachloride should be

classed with the fluorocarbons in this respect as its lifetime has been

estimated to be 30 to 50 years.  Incorporated within these residence times
a.  Hearings before the Subcommittee on Public Health and Environment of
    the Committee on Interstate and Foreign Commerce, U.S. House of Repre-
    sentatives, 93rd Congress, 2nd Session, on H.R. 17577 and H.R. 17545,
    December 11 and 12, 1974 (Serial No. 93-110), p. 428.
                                    111-10

-------
is a delay period of several months  required for these chemicals to go

from ground level up to the stratosphere (roughly ranging from 50,000 to

165,000 feet).  It is only within the stratosphere, more specifically

around 50,000 to 115,000 feet, that some scientists believe fluorocarbon-

ozone reactions are likely to occur, with a net loss of ozone.

    In marked contrast to the fluorocarbons (including carbon tetrachloride)

the other chlorocarbons under study in this work are not expected to have

such long lifetimes in the atmosphere.  Fluorocarbons 21, 22, and others

containing hydrogen atoms may also fall into this group because all of

these chemicals contain a bond that is relatively susceptible to attack by

hydroxyl (OH) radicals in the lower atmosphere.  These bonds are the carbon-

carbon double bonds and the carbon-hydrogen bonds.



C.  FLUOROCARBON EMISSIONS TO THE ATMOSPHERE

1.  United States

a.  Production, Transport and Storage - Emissions of fluorocarbons to the

atmosphere in production, transport and storage are small (ca. 1 percent of

total emissions).  These chemicals have a high unit value relative to many

other industrial organic chemicals produced in commercial quantities and
        •-;••'--                   '                  -     .        -        •

there is, therefore, a strong economic incentive for close control of loss
a.  EPA estimate.

b.  The reaction mechanism proposed involves first the production of
    halogen atoms following absorption, of ultraviolet light by the halo-
    carbon. : The halogen atom is then involved in a catalytic reaction with
    ozone, the net result of which is the conversion of ozone (0_) to
    oxygen (00).
                                      III-ll

-------
during production, transport and storage.  Furthermore, transport and




storage are usually in bulk quantities and in sealed metal containers.




Small losses may occur in transfer and flushing operations, but these are




negligible compared to losses in end use and disposal  (see Table III-5).




b.  End Use and Disposal - As indicated in Table III-5, the major U.S.




atmospheric emissions of fluorocarbons are from propellant and refrigerant




applications.  Propellant losses account for an estimated 62 percent of




total emissions, while refrigerant emissions comprise an additional 26




percent of the total.  Emissions from foam blowing and solvent applications




are estimated to be 5 percent and 6 percent, respectively.  Emissions from




manufacture of fluorocarbon resins are negligible.




    Also shown in Table III-5 are U.S. fluorocarbon emissions by fluoro-




carbon type.  Fluorocarbon 12 accounted for approximately 390 million




pounds (48 percent) of the total estimated emissions of 824 million pounds




in 1973.  Fluorocarbon 11 represented 34 percent of total emissions, while




F-22 and other fluorocarbons accounted for 7 and 11 percent of 1973 losses,



respectively.  The bases for these emission estimates are detailed in




Chapter IV.




2.  World




a.  Production, Transport and Storage - As is the case with this category




of emissions in the United States, world atmospheric emissions of fluoro-




carbons from production, transport and storage are judged to be on the




order of 1 percent of total production, or 11 thousand metric tons in 1973.



(World production in 1973 was estimated in Table II-4 to have been approx-




imately 1.1 million metric tons.)
                                     111-12

-------
     Fluorocarbon
                             Table III-5.  ESTIMATED U.S. FLUOROCARBON EMISSIONS-1973
                                              (millions of pounds)
                       Production transport
                       and storage emissions
                                       Annual emissions from use and disposal
 Production   Emissions   Propellant
(million Ibs)(1 percent)
                                                                                    Blowing Plastic
                                                                                     Percent
Refrigerant   Solvent   agent  resin  Total  of total
F-ll
F-12
F-22
F-113
F-114
Other
b
Total
Percent of
total
334
489
136
59
26
12
1056
—
3.3
4.9
1.4
0.6
0.3
0.1
10.6
1.3
236.9
249.4
sm.
-
24.7
sm.
511.0
62.0
11
130.5
59.5

11

212.0
25.7
sm.
-
-
50
-
_
50
6.1
29.3
7.5
-




3.7

40.5
4.9
-
-
sm.
sm.
sm.
—
sm.
—
280.5
392.3
60.9

90.4

824.1
—
34.0
47.6
7.4
}
> 11.0
)
—
100.0
M
M
     'sm.' = less than 5 million pounds; '-' = none or negligible.

     •j
     . Emissions from production transport and storage are judged to be approximately 1 percent of total production.


      Does not include 'sm.'
     Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates, based on industry contacts.

-------
b.  End-Use and Disposal - The world pattern for atmospheric emissions of




the fluorocarbons parallels that of the United States in terms of emission




source.  The greatest emissions are from propellant and refrigerant appli-




cations; other emission sources are small by comparison.




    Estimated world emissions of fluorocarbons as aerosol propellant are




presented in Table III-6.  Total 1973 emissions are estimated to be 488




thousand metric tons (1,076 million pounds).  The U.S. accounted for nearly




half of these emissions and Europe accounted for an additional third of the




total.




    Estimated world emissions of fluorocarbon refrigerants are presented in




Table III-7.  Total 1973 emissions are estimated at 207 thousand metric




tons (457 million pounds).  As in the case of propellants, the U.S. accounted




for the largest part (47 percent) of the emissions, and Europe (39 percent)




was the second largest regional emission source.




    Finally, estimated 1973 world emissions of fluorocarbons from use as




solvents and foam blowing agents are 90 thousand metric tons (198 million




pounds), with the U.S.  accounting for 46 percent of total emissions in this




category.




    Total 1973 world fluorocarbon emissions are therefore believed to be on




the order of 785 thousand metric tons:




          •  propellant emissions  -  488 thousand metric tons




          •  refrigerant emissions -  207 thousand metric tons




          •  other use  emissions   -   90 thousand metric tons




                        Total          785  thousand metric  tons.
                                   111-14

-------
Table III-6.  WORLD EMISSIONS OF FLUOROGARBON AEROSOL PROPELIANTS - 1973




                       (units as indicated below)
Region
United States
Europe
Other
Total
Estimated emissions
(thousand
metric tons)
232
170
86
488
(millions
of pounds)
511
375
190
1076
Percent
of total
48
34
18
100
      Source:   Arthur D.  Little,  Inc.,  estimates.






   Table III-7.  WORLD EMISSIONS  OF FLUOROCARBON REFRIGERANTS - 1973




                       (units as  indicated below)
Region
United States
Europe
Other
Total
Estimated emissions
(thousand
metric tons)
96
81
30
207
(millions
of pounds)
212
179
66
457
Percent
of total
47
39
14
100
      Source:   Arthur D.  Little,  Inc.,  estimates.
                                  111-15

-------
 D.   CHLOROCARBON EMISSIONS  TO THE ATMOSPHERE




 1.   United States




 a.   Production, Transport and Storage - Emissions to the atmosphere of




 chlorocarbons during manufacture, transport and storage are judged to be




 on the order of  0.5 to 1.5 percent of production.  For the chemicals used




 only as intermediates, losses during transport and storage are minimal




 since they are usually transported in bulk form over short distances and




 are stored for relatively short periods in closed vessels.  Ethylene di-




 chloride emissions are far greater than any of the other chlorocarbons




 simply because of the massive amount manufactured.  Trichloroethylene,




 perchloroethylene, methyl chloroform and methylene chloride are believed




 to have emission rates of one percent during production, transport and




 storage.   Ethyl chloride and methyl chloride are judged to have emission




 rates of 0.7 percent each, while carbon tetrochloride and chloroform losses




during production transport and storage are on the order of 1.5 percent of




production.   These emissions, as well as those from end-use and disposal




are discussed below and are summarized in Table 111-18.




b.   End-Use and Disposal - There is tremendous variation among the chloro-




carbons in emissions to the atmosphere from end-use.  For those chemicals




that are used as chemical intermediates, the emissions are small.  For




example,  chloroform and carbon tetrachloride emissions are believed to be




no greater than one percent in the manufacture of fluorocarbons.  On the




other hand,  for chlorocarbons used in dry cleaning and metal cleaning, it




is likely that nearly all of the product going to these applications even-



tually is lost to the atmosphere. Emission estimates for the 10 chlorocarbons




 studied are developed below.




                                 111-16

-------
     In the tables below "Percent" refers to estimated emissions from pro-


duction transport and storage  (as a percent of production, P), emissions


from use as a chemical intermediate (as a .percent of consumption in this


application, C), emissions from end uses (as a percent of production, P),


and a correction for emissions not reaching the atmosphere calculated as


a percent of total emissions, E); therefore the percent column does not


total to 100.


     Using the carbon tetrachloride production figure for 1973 of 1047


million pounds, approximately 1.5 percent, (15.7 million pounds) of this


chemical product is lost to the atmosphere during production, transport


and storage.  Together with the losses from solvent use and use as a


chemical intermediate, an estimated 46 million pounds of carbon tetrachloride


was lost to the atmosphere in 1973 in the United States (see Table III-8).


        Table III-8.   ESTIMATED U.S.  CARBON TETRACHLORIDE EMISSIONS-1973
Emission Source
Production, transport
and storage
Chemical intermediate :
fluorocarbons 11 & 12
Other (including solvent)
Rebased to environment but not
reaching atmosphere (due to
hydrolysis or water dissolu-
tion)
Total
Percent
1.5
•1.0
2.0
-1.0
-
Basis
P
C
P
E
-
Amount
(million pounds)
15.7
9.9
20.9
-0.5
46.0
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
Q
 See Section B. 2. (p. III-7) of this chapter for derivation.

 See explaination of "Basis" in text, above.


                                111-17

-------
     U.S. atmospheric emissions of chloroform in 1973 are estimated to be




on the order of 14 million pounds.  The loss rate during production, trans-




port and storage is judged to be the same as for carbon tetrachloride:




1.5 percent of production.  In its use as a chemical intermediate for the




production of F-22, it is estimated that a 1 percent loss rate is appropriate




for the amount of chloroform going to this application (ca. 235 million




pounds, based on Table II-9).  Emissions resulting from solvent applications




are estimated at 3 percent of total production.




           Table III-9.  ESTIMATED U.S. CHLOROFORM EMISSIONS-1973

Emission source
Production, transport
and storage
Chemical intermediate:
fluorocarbon 22
Other (including solvent)
Released to environment but not
. reaching atmosphere (due to
hydrolysis or water dissolu-
tion)
Total

Percent
1.5

1.0
3.0

-1.0
—

Basis
P

C
P

E
— •
Amount
(million pounds)
3.8

2.4
7.6

-0.1
13.7
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                                   111-18

-------
     In 1974, 85 percent of the ethyl chloride produced in the United




States was consumed in the manufacture of tetraethyl lead.  Using an




emission rate of 0.6 percent for this process, 3.4 million pounds were lost




to the atmsophere in 1973.  The emission rate for the "Other" category is




higher than this because it includes use as a solvent.  From the total




potential emissions of 17.9 million pounds we have subtracted 1 percent of




the losses (0.2 million pounds) from the total to take into account the




amount that is likely to have been hydrolyzed.  The total U.S. amount of




ethyl chloride lost to the atmosphere in 1973 is estimated at 17.7 million




pounds (see Table 111-10).




      Table 111-10.  ESTIMATED U.S. ETHYL CHLORIDE EMISSIONS-1973
Emission source
Production, transport
and storage
Chemical intermediate:
tetraethyl lead
Other (including export)
Released to environment but
. not reaching atmosphere
(due to hydrolysis or water
dissolution)
Total
Percent
0.7
0.6
•1.5
-1.0
—
Basis
P
C
P
E
—
Amount
(million pounds)
4.6
3.4
9.9
-0.2
17.7
 Source:  Arthur D.  Little,  Inc.,  estimates.
                                    111-19

-------
     As was developed in the previous chapter, the estimated loss rate




for ethylene dichloride (EDC) production, transport and storage is 1.3 per-




cent of production.  The estimated loss rates for all of the end uses of




ethylene dichloride are small with the exception of the "Other" category




which includes uses for EDC in this category  (8 percent of total EDC demand)




is the most critical determinant of EDC emissions.  Total U.S. emissions of




EDC were on the order of 440 million pounds in 1973 (see Table III-ll).




       Table III-ll. ESTIMATED U.S. ETHYLENE DICHLORIDE EMISSIONS-1973

Emission source
Production, transport
and storage
Chemical intermediate:
vinyl chloride
lead scavenger
trichloroethylene
perchloroethylene
methyl chloroform
ethylamines
vinylidene chloride
Other (including export)
Released to environment but
not reaching atmosphere
(due to hydrolysis or water
dissolution)
Total

Percent

1.3

0.2
0.1
0.6
0.6
0.6
0.6
0.6
40.0



-1.0
—

Basis

P

C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C



E
—
Amount
(million pounds)

120.8

14.5
2.8
1.7
1.7
0.9
1.1
1.1
297.4



-4.4
437.6
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                                  111-20

-------
     Methyl chloride is used almost .exclusively as an intermediate to




produce other chemicals and thus emissions are minimal.  More than 80 per-




cent of methyl chloride was consumed in the production of silicones and




tetramethyl lead in 1973.  The "Other" category emission rate is higher




than that for chemical intermediates because some of these miscellaneous




uses have relatively high potential for loss of the chemical to the




atmsophere.  Total-1973 U.S. emissions are estimated to have been 10.5




million pounds (see Table 111-12).     .             .




        -Table 111-12.  ESTIMATED U.S. METHYL CHLORIDE EMISSIONS-1973

Emission source
Production, transport
and storage
Chemical intermediate:
silicones
tetramethyl lead
butyl rubber
methyl cellulose
herbicides
quaternary amines
Other
Released to environment but
not reaching atmosphere
(due to hydrolysis or
water dissolution)
Total

Percent
0.7

0.6
0.6
0.6
0.6
0.6
0.6
10.0

-1.0
—

Basis
P

C
C
C
C
C
C
C

E
—
Amount
(million pounds)
3.8

1.4
1.2
0.1'
0.1
0.1
0.1
3.8 .

-0.1
10.5
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                                    111-21

-------
     Virtually all of the methyl chloroform used in metal degreasing


 (cleaning solvent) and as a solvent for adhesives or other materials


evaporates and is thus released to the atmosphere.  Atmospheric emission


from the production of methyl chloroform and from its use as an inter-


mediate to produce vinylidene chloride are small by comparison.  An


estimated 428.9 million pounds of methyl chloroform was released to the

                                                           j
atmosphere in 1973 in the U.S. (see Table 111-13).


      Table 111-13.  ESTIMATED U.S. METHYL CHLOROFORM EMISSIONS-1973
Emission source
Production, transport
and storage
Chemical intermediate:
vinylidene chloride
End Uses:
cleaning solvent
other (including adhesive
solvent)
Released to environment but
not reaching atmosphere
(due to hydrolysis or
water dissolution)
Total
Percent
1.0
0.6
70.0
8.0
-1.0
-
Basis
P
C
P
P
E
-
Amount
(million pounds)
5.5
0.3
383.6
43.8
-4.3
428.9
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                                   111-22

-------
     As in the case of methyl chloroform, the majority of the end uses



of methylene chloride result in loss to the atmosphere by evaporation.



The large "paint remover and other" category includes plastics processing,
                      * ..       '                    •


and these two uses account for over 75 percent of methylene chloride



emissions.  The other important emission sources are use of methylene



chloride in solvent degreasing and in aerosol applications, where the



chemical acts as both vapor depressant and solvent.  In all, it is estimated



that about 430 million pounds of methylene chloride went into the



atmosphere from the U.S.  in 1973 (see Table 111-14).



        Table 111-14..  ESTIMATED U.S. METHYLENE CHLORIDE EMISSIONS-1973
Emission source
Production, transport
and storage
End uses:
cleaning solvent
aerosols
paint remover
Released to the environment but
not reaching atmosphere (due
to hydrolysis or water
dissolution!
Total
Percent
1.0
10.0
8.0
65.0
-1.0
-
Basis
P
P
P
P
E
• -
Amount
(million pounds)
5.2
52.0
42.0
338.0
-4.4
432.8
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                                  111-23

-------
     The major source of U.S. perchloroethylene atmospheric emissions is




the use of this chemical as a dry cleaning and textile processing solvent.




This application accounted for about 460 million pounds (77 percent) of




the estimated U.S. 1973 emissions of about 600 million pounds.  Emissions




from other end uses were small by comparison, as were emissions from




production, transport and storage (see Table 111-15).




   Table 111-15.  ESTIMATED U.S. PERCHLOROETHYLENE EMISSIONS-1973

Emission source
Production, transport
and storage
Chemical intermediate:
fluorocarbons 113 & 114
End uses:
dry cleaning and textile
processing
cleaning solvent
other (including export)
Released to the environment
but not reaching atmosphere
(due to hydrolysis or water
dissolution)
Total

Percent
1.0

1.0

65.0
12.0
50.0

-1.0
-

Basis
P

C

P
P
C

E
-
Amount
(million pounds)
7.1

0.6

458.9
84.7
53.0

-6.0
598.3
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                                 111-24

-------
     In its end uses as a metal cleaning and extraction solvent, it is




assumed that nearly all of the trichloroethylene going to these uses




represents emissions to the atmosphere in that year.  These two applications




accounted for about 390 million pounds ,(90 percent) of the nearly 430




million pounds of trichloroethylene estimated to have been released to




the atmosphere from the U.S. in 1973.  This emission level represented




about 95 percent of 1973 U.S. production of trichloroethylene (see Table 111-16),




     Table 111-16. ESTIMATED U.S. TRICHLOROETHYLENE EMISSIONS-1973

Emission source
Production, transport
and storage
End uses:
cleaning' solvent
extraction solvent
Other (including export)
Released to the environment
but not reaching atmosphere
(due to hydrolysis or water
dissolution)
Total

Percent
1.0

86.0
3.0
50.0

-1.0
-

Basis
P

P
P
C

E
-
Amount
(million pounds)
4.5

388.7
13.6
24.9

-4.3
427.4
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                                  IH-25

-------
     Vinyl chloride monomer (VCM) emissions approached 200 million pounds




in 1973, or about 3.7 percent of total production of the compound (see




Table 111-17).  The loss of VCM during polymerization was approximately




184 million pounds, or 93 percent of total emissions.




     Table 111-17.  ESTIMATED U.S. VINYL CHLORIDE MONOMER EMISSIONS-1973

Emission source
Production, transport
and storage
Chemical intermediate:
polyvinyl chloride
Released to the environment
but not reaching atmosphere
(due to hydrolysis or
water dissolution)
Total

Percent
0.3

3.9

-1.0
-

Basis
P

C

E
-
Amount
(million pounds)
14.5

184.1

-2.0
196.6
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., and EPA estimates.
                                  111-26

-------
      Table .111-18.   ESTIMATED U.S. CHLOROCARBON EMISSIONS-1973
                            (millions of pounds)
Chlorocarbon
Carbon . .
tetrachloride
Chloroform
Ethyl chloride
Ethylene
dichloride
Methyl ; chloride
Methyl chloroform
Methylene chloride
Perchloroethylene
Trichloroethylene
Vinyl chloride
Emissions
from production
transport and storage
15.7
3.8
4.6
120.8
3.8
r 5.5
5.2
.7.1
4.5
... 14-5
Emissions
from end use
and disposal
30.8
10.0
13.3
321.2
6.8
427.7
432.0
597.2
427.2
184.1
Total
potential
emissions
46.5
13.8
17.9
442.0
10.6
433.2
437.2
604.3
431.7
198.6
Total
a
adjusted
emissions
46.0
13.7
17.7
437.6
10.5
428.9
432.8
598.3
427.4
196.6
aThe amount of chiorocarbon released to the environment but probably not
 reaching the atmosphere due to hydrolysis or water dissolution has. been
 subtracted in this column.

 EPA estimates.

Source:  Athur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                                111-27

-------
 2.  World




 a.  Production, Transport and Storage - World atmospheric emissions of the




 chlorocarbons  from production, transport and storage are believed to be




 on  the  same order of magnitude, percentagewise, as in the United States.




 They range from about 30 percent of total emissions for carbon tetrachloride




 and chloroform to approximately one percent of total emissions for methyl




 chloroform and trichloroethylene.  Again, it is the end-use pattern that




 is  the  key variable in determining which of the chlorocarbons will have




 relatively large (greater than 100 thousand metric ton) atmosphere emissions.




 b.  End-Use and Disposal - For all of the chlorocarbons, application emissions




 are judged to  be greater than disposal emissions.  These categories have been




 combined because the disposal losses tend to be small and not easily




 quantifiable and also because the distinction between 'end use* and disposal




 is  not  always  well-defined.  As stated above, the major emissions (for




 those chemicals with large emissions) occur in the end  use  category.




     The world emission estimates shown in Table 111-19 combine the total




 production, transport, storage, end use and disposal estimates into one




 figure  for each chlorocarbon.  The purpose of this world estimate is to




 give an indication of the importance of various geographic emission sources




 in  relation to the U.S. emissions, and also to indicate the approximate




 level of total chlorocarbon emissions to the atmosphere on a global basis.




As  discussed previously, most of these chemicals are believed by atmospheric




 scientists to be subject to high rates of decomposition in the lower




atmosphere.
                                     Ill-28

-------
                        Table 111-19.   ESTIMATED WORLD CHLOROCARBON EMISSIONS-1973

                                             (units  as indicated  below)
i
NJ
Chlorocarbon
Carbon tetrachloride
Chloroform
Ethyl chloride
Ethylene dichloride
Methyl chloride
Methyl chloroform
Methylene chloride
Perchloroethylene
Trichloroethylene
b
Vinyl chloride
Regional percent of total
United States Europe Other
50
50
55
35
60
60
55
45
30
25
40
40
30
40
35
30
30
45
55
40
10
10
15
25
5
10
15
10
15
35"
World total
Thousand Millions
metric tons of pounds
41.7
12.4
14.6
565.2
7.9
324.2
346.4
609.0
648.3
351.6
92.0
27.4
32.2
1,246.3
17.5
714.8
763.8
1,342.9
1,429.6
775.3
              founded to nearest 5 percent.



               EPA estimates.


              Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.

-------
                 IV.  ANALYSIS OF MAJOR U.S. EMISSION SOURCES

                    AND ALTERNATIVES FOR EMISSION ABATEMENT


A.  INTRODUCTION

     The preceding chapter identified the major sources of halocarbon emissions.
                                                           i*
The high-volume applications of these compounds (aerosols,frarrigeration,

plastic .foam production, and solvent cleaning) are the most sensitive points

for emission reduction strategies.  This chapter discusses in detail the

technologies of these major applications and sets forth the most feasible

emission control options.


B.  PRODUCTION, TRANSPORT, AND STORAGE EMISSIONS

     Atmsopheric emissions of the chlorocarbons and fluorocarbons from pro-

duction, transport and disposal are extremely small (ca. 1 percent of total

emissions) for those compounds having relatively large atmospheric discharges.

In view of the small size of these emissions relative to those from end use

and disposal and the relative cost/effectiveness of reducing emissions from

these two groupings, we have not examined the alternatives for emission abate-

ment from production, transport, and storage.
                                      IV-1

-------
C.  END USE AND DISPOSAL EMISSIONS



1.  Aerosol Propellants




a.  Introduction -  The  fluorocarbons are one of three major types of propellants




used in aerosol products today.  The other two are hydrocarbons and compressed




gases.  Some of the Important characteristics of each type and factors which




affect the selection of a specific type for a given aerosol are discussed




in  the sections which follow.  The fluorocarbons and hydrocarbons are




characterized as liquified gas propellants.  They are gases at normal room




temperature and pressure, but become liquified when compressed and confined




under pressure in an aerosol container.




     Sketches of several different types of aerosol containers are shown in




Figure IV-1.   In the case of the liquified propellants, the vapor pressure




of the liquid, confined at a temperature above its normal boiling point,




provides the propellant force.  When the actuator button is pressed, opening




the valve, the pressure forces the contents through the valve orifice and




out the nozzle in the form of a spray, mist, foam or steady stream depending




on the type of delivery desired.




     An important advantage of liquified propellants is that they provide




relatively uniform pressure over the life of the product.  Vapor pressure is




dependent on temperature, but since most aerosols are used at or near room




temperature,  pressure variations are relatively small.   Another advantage of




liquified gas propellants is that they form part of the solvent system and




as such provide a "burst" effect.  In other words, as the solution leaves




the nozzle, the propellant immediately vaporizes or flashes off from the




solution.   This vaporization aids in producing a fine (true aerosol) spray.
                                   IV-2

-------
            •*^;.^
            ;*'>:.'• ':';'•;.••
            i$"5 "• •'- •-'-..'., • i • •-•-•  . .-. .-
            >;COMPRESSED GAS-'
            ^'•PROPELLANT
            V;:'-. :r-;«'|i| ':-.•-;
            iunn
            fi" f '• s. ; :
hinin
                     ...
            '• • ' /Liouio . •
            U CONCENTRATE
                                                    Operates by
                                                    pressing^ down
                     Propellanl gas
                     	 pressure
                        opproi.
                        35 p.s.ig.
                        ol 70'F.
                    ~ propellent
                    -~ ami active
                    - ingreditnts
                                                                          Proptllanl
                                                                      prestwr cpproiimole!*
                                                                       40p.i.ig. aiTO'F
                                                                    |      wporphoss

                                                                         Liquid phot<
     	 perl urn*	
     	eclive i
     Slnglt-phM* atrosol is powered by (1)
     compressed gas. This type is used lor
     whipped cream.
                  Two-phM* spray or misl aerosol has (t) liquefied
                  propellanl in solution with product. (2) gas or vapor
                  phase to supply pressure. This type is used tor
                  majority olaeroiob
Two-phie* foam aerosol hits (1) liquefied
propeHant in emulsion with product. (21 gas
or  vapor phase. Typical use is  shave
teams
                                         PRODUCT
                                                         —VALVE
                                                         -POLTEIHYLME
                                                             PlSTO»
                                            GAS
                                     5*5 PlUC
                                                    IIUKIIIUII CM (W
   Three-plwe*  aerosol  has  (t)     CompertmenM  aerosol has plastic piston       Co-dl«penslng. Diagram shows operation ol hot shave
   liquetal  propellanl.  (2)  product     thai separates propellanl gas and product. A       aerosol. Co-dnpensing offers potential tar personal pro-
   Jh>t floats on propellanl, 0) gas or     variation  employs a polyethylene  bag to    ^  ducts, drugs, foods.    •'
r'  vapot phase.  •     '    '         separate product and gas. •                *          '



                    Figure  IV1-1.    Types  of  Aerosol  Containers



 Source:    Modern  Packaging Encyclopedia,  1972/73.
                                                     IV-3 .

-------
In powder sprays, the liquified propellant serves as the suspending medium


for the powder.  The burst effect and rapid evaporation of the propellant


make it possible to deliver a "dry" spray.  This is considered an important


feature, for example, for anti-perspirants.  Background and detailed


discussion of aerosol technology may be found in a variety of sources,

                               a
including the Aerosol Handbook.

                                                                       *
     Fluorocarbons are used as aerosol propellants, even though they are


more expensive than other propellants, because they offer an advantageous


combination of properties including:


     •  Safety - nonflammable and a low order of toxicity,


     •  Liquified gas form - advantages of this feature have been


        described above,


     •  Versatility - fluorocarbons can be blended to provide a range of


        pressures and solubility characteristics,


     •  Chemical stability/inertness - little or no deleterious effect on


        other components of product formulation or on the container, and


     •  Odorless - especially important for perfume formulations.


Nonflammability is probably the single most important attribute since this


characteristic, more than any other, distinguishes fluorocarbon from hydrocarbon


propellants.


     The three major fluorocarbon propellants are F-ll, F-12 and F-114.  A


few other fluorocarbons are used in only relatively minor,amounts; these


include F-115, F-22, F-142b, and F-152a.  Physical properties of these compounds


are included in Table IV-1.  Fluorocarbon C-318 was used in some aerosol food


products, but has been supplanted by F-115.  Fluorocarbon 12 has a.relatively
aThe Aerosol Handbook, Johnsen, et al. editors, W. E. Borland Co., 1972.
                                      IV-4

-------
                  Table  IV-1.  PHYSICAL PROPERTIES OF AEROSOL PROPELLANTS

Propellant
Types

Fluorocarbons
F-ll ' • '
F-12
F-114
F-115
F-21
F-22
F-142b
F-152a
F-C318
Hydrocarbons
Propane
Isobutane
n- Butane
Dimethyl Ether
Compressed Gases
. Carbon Dioxide
Nitrous Oxide
Nitrogen
Chlo rocarbons
Methylene Chloride
Methylchloroform
Methyl Chloride
Ethyl Chloride
Chemical
Formula


CC13F
CC12F2
-CC1F2CC1F2
CC1F2CF3
CHC12F
CHC1F2
CH3CC1F2
CH3CHF2
"4*8

63%
i-C4H10

CH3Oci3

C02
N20
N2

CH2C12
CH3CC13
CH3C1
CH3CH2C1
Boiling
Point , °F


,74.9
-21.6
38.8
-38.4
48.1
-41.4
15.1
-13
21.5

-43.8
10.9
31.1
-12.7

_
-127
-320

104
165
-10.6
54.3
Vapor Pressure
70°F


13
85
27
120
23
136
44
76
40

124
45
31
78

852
735
—

7
2
74
20
130°F


"39
196
73
.267
65
312
107
191
107

274
110
81
187

_
-
—

24
7 :
174
56
Kauri-3-
Butanol
Value


60
18
12
7
102
25
20
11
5

. -

-
-

_
•-
—

136
117
,+100
—
Flammability
Limits
Vol % in Air


nonflammable
nonflammable
•nonflammable
nonflammable
nonflammable
nonflammable
9.0 to 14.8
5.1 to 17.1
nonflammable

2.2 to 9.5
1.8 to 8.4
1.9 to 8.5
3.4 to 18.0

nonflammable
nonflammable
nonflammable

nonflammable
nonflammable
7.6 to 19.0
3.8 to 15.0
Toxicityb-
Rating


5
6
6
6
4 to 5
5a
-
6
6

5
5
5
—

5a
-
—

4 to 'j
-
4
4
a.  Higher number indicates stronger solvent power.
b.  Underwriters Laboratory Toxicity Rating System -
    6 least toxic, as a reference point, carbon
    dioxide is class 5a.
Sources:'  1.  DuPont and Allied Chemical Trade Literature
          2.  Modern Packaging Encyclopedia, Sept., 1967-
          3.  The Aerosol Handbook, Johnson et  al.
              editors,  1972.

-------
 high vapor  pressure  and  is used  to  provide  the pressure or propelling force




 in many formulations.  To maintain  pressure at a safe level in  the container,




 F-12 is used  in  combination with a  vapor pressure depressant, either a higher




 boiling fluorocarbon or  another  organic solvent.  Typically F-ll is blended




 with F-12 to  reduce  pressure and to improve solubility and compatibility with




 other components of  the  formulation.  Fluorocarbon 114 is used  alone or in




 blends with F-12 primarily in colognes, perfumes, and some specific brands




 of personal care products.




 b.  Emission Sources  -  An estimate  of fluorocarbon  emissions  to  the atmosphere



 in the form of aerosol propellants,  based on 1973 U.S. consumption of aerosol




 products is given in Table IV-2.  The total 1973 propellant emissions for




 fluorocarbons F-ll,  F-12 and F-114  were slightly greater than 500 million




 pounds.  Based on estimates of 1974 sales of aerosol products,  emissions in




 1974  were approximately  90 percent  of the 1973 level.  These totals include




 losses of propellant during filling of the  aerosol containers,  estimated




 by industry sources  to be on the order of 3 percent of the total propellant




 charge.




     As indicated in Table IV-2  hair sprays and anti-perspirants (plus




deodorants) are  the two largest categories for fluorocarbon emissions—



representing approximately 75 percent of the total  emissions  as aerosol




propellant.   Fluorocarbon propellants are used in more than 90 percent of




the medical and pharmaceutical aerosol products. This  category accounted for




emissions of approximately 17 million pounds of F-ll and F-12 in 1973,  or about




4 percent of total fluorocarbon propellant emissions.  Fluorocarbon propellants




are used to some extent in many other aerosol product categories, but either
                                   IV-6

-------
                                          Table IV-2.  ESTIMATED U.S. FLUOROCARBON EMISSIONS AS AEROSOL PROPELLANT3
                                                                  BY PRODUCT TYPE - 1973
_*• Aerosol unit estimates «^ ^ Fluorocarbon propellant emission estimates ^
^


, Aerosol type
Personal
Hair care
Antlperspirants
• and deodoranto
Medicinal and pharmaceutical
Colognes and perfumes
Shave lathers
Others

Household
Room deodorants
Cleaners
Laundry products
Waxes and polishes
Others'

All Other Products
Insecticides
Coatings
Industrial
Foods and pan spray
Automotive
Vet. and pet
Others

Millions
of units
filled

469
577

66
144
171
70


170
211
163
105
43


143
268
132
115
89
16
34
Percent
of units
propelled
by F.C.

95
95

90
95
10
80


20
10
20
30
25


30
10
30
5
15
50
40

Average
weight
(Ib/unit)

0.8
0.6

0.4
0.1
0.6
0.5


0.5
0.9
0.9
0.8
0.8


0.9
0.8
0.9
0.8
0.8
0.5
0.6
Average
Percent
propellant
Per unit

50
65

80
45
10
60


50
20
35
15
50


40
45
50
65
30
50
30
~"* (millions of pounds) "~"






Subtotal




Subtotal






Subtotal








Subtotal
Total Units Filled . 2,986
Total Emissions (millions of pounds)
Percent of F.C. Propellant Emissions

F-ll
emissions

103.0
85.5
188.5
11.0
-
_
7.5
18.5

2.7
2*1
4.2
1.5
2.0
12.5

5.5
3.4
6.0
-
1.0
0.5
1.0
17.4

236.9
46.4
F-12
emissions

72.0
114.3
186.3
5.5
1.0
0.4
7.5
14.4

5.0
2.1
6.0
2.5 •
2.0
- 17.6

9.0
6.6
11.0
- -
2.5
' 0.5
1.5
31.1

249.4
48.8
F-114
emissions

3.4
7.0
10.4
3.0
6.7
0.6
1.0
11.3

_
-
-
-
-
0.0

-
-
-
3.0
-
-
-
3.0

24.7
4.8
Total F.C.
emissions

178.4
206.8
385.2
19.5
7.7
1.0
16.0
44.2

7.7
4.2
10.2
4.0
4.0
30.1

14.5
10.0
17.0
3.0
3.5
1.0
2.5
51.5

511.0
100.0

Percent
of total

35.0
40.4
75.4
3.8
1.5
0.2
3.1
8.6

1.5
0.8
2.0
0.8
0.8
5.9

2.8
2.0
3.3
0.6
0.7
0.2
0.5
10.1

100.0

*Use and filling emissions for products produced in 1973; emission lag averages 6 months for most products;  some unit estimates have been rounded.
Sources:  Chemical Specialties Manufacturers Association and Arthur D. Little, Inc. estimates based on industry  contacts.

-------
because  these other categories are small or because fluorocarbons are used




in only  a small portion of the units, the total fluorocarbon emissions from




all other categories is relatively minor, with no one group of products




accounting for more than 4 percent of total fluorocarbon propellant emissions.




c. Alternatives - Potential alternatives to the presently used fluorocarbon




propellants are described below.  Physical properties of these alternatives




are included in Table  IV-1.




     Other Fluorocarbons - Based on discussions with fluorocarbon producers,




the possibilities for substituting other fluorocarbons that are potentially




less stable in the atmosphere due to the presence of hydrogen atoms or




unsaturation are very limited.  Unsaturated fluorocarbons are characterized




as generally toxic and therefore unacceptable as propellants.  As more




hydrogen atoms are added, the fluorocarbons become flammable.  Fluorocarbon




22 might be a substitute for F-12 in some cases, but some producers question




whether it would also be found to pose a significant threat to atmospheric




ozone.  Fluorocarbons F-31,  F-32, F-142 and F-152 are all flammable and




therefore lack a key advantage of the current fluorocarbon propellants.




There is also a problem in finding an acceptable substitute for the lowei




boiling component, typically F-ll, used as a vapor pressure depressant




and solvent.   Use of F-21 as a low-pressure component would be possible




at a reasonable cost,  but since it is a very strong solvent, it is likely to




act as a skin irritant if present as a substantial portion of the propellant




system.  Therefore,  it is questionable whether fluorocarbon 21 would be




suitable for use in personal products—which represent the major use for




fluorocarbon propellants.




     Assessment of the possibility of using perfluorocarbons (containing
                                  IV-8

-------
only carbon and fluorine) as propellents is difficult at this point.  Producers

indicate that such compounds would be more complex, higher molecular weight

species, which would be considerably more expensive than the simpler products

presently manufactured commercially.  DuPont has offered F-C318 (perfluoro-

cyclobutane) in limited quantities in the past, particularly for food products;

but this use has been supplanted by F-115.  DuPont estimates that the cost of

F-C318 might be five to ten times that of F-ll even with large scale commercial

production.  Other perfluoro compounds (e.g., perfluoropropane, perfluoro-n-

butane and perfluoroisobutane are currently being produced only in experimental

quantities.

     The manufacturers of these compounds estimate that commercial prices for

one of these compounds, perfluoropropane, would be on the order of $2 to $6

per pound depending on the scale of operation.  (This price range is about ten

times the price of F-ll and F-12.)  In addition to higher cost, the perfluoro-

carbon compounds have the important disadvantage of being generally poor sol-

vents .

     Hydrocarbons - Hydrocarbons used as liquefied gas propellants include

isobutane, propane, n-butane, and dimethyl ether.  Isobutane and propane are

the two which are most widely used.  Hydrocarbons offer most of the performance

features of fluorocarbons and are appreciably lower in cost.  However, they are

highly flammable, and this has prevented their general use as substitutes for

fluorocarbons.   In some instances, minor amounts of hydrocarbon are blended

with  halocarbohs  to reduce costs.  The proportions used are such that the

halocarbons suppress flammability.
 An ideal propellant has high enough solvent power to dissolve the product
 ingredients but is not strong enough to irritate the skin.
                                     IV-9

-------
     In general, hydrocarbons have replaced fluorocarbons in applications




for liquefied gas propellants where:




     a)   fluorocarbon propellants cannot sufficiently suppress the




          inherent flammability of the product ingredients to meet




          nonflammable classifications (e.g., spray paints), and




     b)   the product is water based and sufficiently nonflammable to




          use hydrocarbon propellants (e.g., shave lathers).




     Compressed Gases - Compressed gases used as propellants include nitro-




gen, carbon dioxide, and nitrous oxide.   Their advantages are low cost,




low toxicity, and nonflammability.  The disadvantages of nitrogen that




have prevented its widespread use stem basically from its insolubility in




the liquid phase of the product formulation.  All of the propelling force




depends on the degree of compression of the nitrogen gas above the liquid




phase.  As the product is used, the increase in volume of the gas phase




results in a proportional reduction in pressure — since there is no reser-




voir of dissolved or liquefied gas in the liquid phase.  This decrease in




pressure causes undesirable changes in spray characteristics, typically




a coarser spray.




     To provide volume for sufficient nitrogen propellant to expel all of




the product, a larger can or lower proportion of product fill must be used




than in the case of liquefied gases.  Also, since there is no burst effect




at the nozzle, the sprays generated tend to be coarser than those achieved




with liquefied propellants.
                                    IV-10



                                                                   Arthur I) Little Inc.

-------
     Carbon dioxide and nitrous oxide have considerably greater solubility




in the liquid phase of aerosol formulations and, therefore, are preferred




over nitrogen as propellants.  However, they share many of the undesirable




pressure characteristics of nitrogen and until recently have been used




primarily only in foams or such products as furniture polishes and wind-




shield de-icers where coarser sprays are satisfactory.  Nitrous oxide has




the further disadvantage of being a powerful oxidizing agent - a property




which greatly increases the flammability of products propelled with this




gas.




     Recent developments announced by valve manufacturers and carbon




dioxide suppliers indicate that there may be some potential for use of




carbon dioxide as a propellant to replace fluorocarbons.  An assessment of




this possibility is presented below under "Technical and Economic Evaluation."




     Chlorocarbons - Several chlorocarbons — methyl chloride, ethyl chlo-




ride, and vinyl chloride — have been considered  as potential propellants




by virtue of their low to moderate vapor pressures.  However, they are also



noted for undesirably high solvent power, toxicity, and flammability.




Vinyl chloride was formerly used to an appreciable extent in propellant




blends, but its use has been banned because of its carcinogenic properties.




None of these are viable alternatives to fluorocarbon propellants.




     Methylene chloride is the most important of the chlorocarbons used in




aerosols.  It does not have adequate vapor pressure (b.p. 104°F) to serve




as a propellant but is used as a higher boiling component for its combina-




tion of nonflammability, solvent properties, and relatively low cost.
                                  IV-11

-------
Another chlorocarbon solvent used for similar reasons is methyl chloroform.




Methylene chloride is used as a partial replacement for fluorocarbons in




some hair sprays to reduce product costs, however, because of its strong




solvent action it tends to act as a skin irritant.  Typical concentration




levels are less than 10 percent to avoid a significant incidence of skin




irritation.  One large chemical manufacturer has promoted a hair spray




propellant system based on a mixture of methylene chloride and nitrous -




oxide, but this system has not achieved commercial acceptance because of




the irritation problem.  Further work may resolve this problem.




     Mechanical Devices - There are many mechanical devices or other




delivery systems which may be cited as potential alternatives to the




fluorocarbon propelled aerosols.  Many products are currently offered in




both aerosol and non-aerosol forms.  An alternative in some cases would be




to return to the product form which was used prior to the aerosol form.




However, aerosol proponents argue that in many applications there is no




equally effective, convenient, and satisfactory means for dispensing the




product.  Examples range from hair sprays and anti-perspirants to insecti-




cides and certain medicinal and pharmaceutical products.




     Finger- or hand-activated mechanical pumps represent an area of




considerable interest and development effort.    A pump-based hair spray




was brought on the market in 1972, and at least seven companies now offer




hair sprays, both men's and women's that use pump delivery systems.




Standard test methods for evaluating performance characteristics of pumps




have been proposed,  and a number of companies making these pumps are
                                   IV-12

-------
having difficulty meeting current demand.  The current demand level is on the



order of  50 to 60 million pumps per year for hair care products.  This is



approximately 13 percent of the number of aerosol hair care units which were



marketed  in 1974.



     At least two container designs which are capable of pressure dispensing



without the use of propellant are available.  One design utilizes an expendable
                                                                    0

rubber bladder inside a rigid outer container.  The recovery force of the blad-



der, expanded with the product during filling, provides the dispensing pressure.



Another container utilizes a compressed steel spring to deliver a burst of
                                                          i


spray from a dispensing chamber.  The container is a two-part design.  The



user reloads the spring for each burst of spray by rotating the bottom part of



the container 180°.  The development and evaluation of these designs is still


underway, but due to limited pressures, spray delivery characteristics, and



cost of the containers, it appears unlikely that either of these designs offers



a viable alternative for most personal aerosol products.



     Several manufacturers have available container designs characterized as



"bag-in-can" types.  In these containers the product is held in a plastic



pouch or bag mounted within a conventional aerosol can.  These delivery systems



require the use of some type of conventional propellant but the propellant is



not released until the can is destroyed or recycled.  Several technical and



cost problems have yet to be solved for these systems.



     Other product forms or delivery systems of the non-aerosol type that can



be cited to compete effectively with current aerosols and their other altern-



atives include such items as squeeze bottles, roll-on applicators, stick-type



applicators, squeeze tubes, wick-type dispensers, saturated pad applicators,



felt tip applicators, and products which can be applied by hand from a glass



or plastic container.




                                    IV-13

-------
d. Potential Environmental Hazards of Alternatives - The various propellant

alternatives discussed above should be examined in terms of possible adverse

environmental effects which could result from their replacement of fluoro-

carbons 11 and 12.  This assessment seems more difficult in view of the

unsuspected environmental hazard which has, in theory, been linked to long-

term atmospheric emissions of F-ll and F-12.a  Nevertheless, it  is  important

to review the environmental characteristics of the alternatives so that  other

known  hazards are  not  created through substitution.   Some  environmental  char-

acteristics of fluorocarbons,. hydrocarbons, compressed  gases  and chlorocarbons

are discussed below.

     Other Fluorocarbons - In view of the current ozone destruction hypothesis,

other fluorocarbons must be assessed in terms  of  stability in the lower

atmsophere as well as with respect to toxicity ratings and other possible

environmental hazards.    According to current  belief of scientists, who

are studying the ozone depletion hypothesis,   molecules containing carbon-

carbon double bonds or carbon-hydrogen bonds should be susceptible to

attack by OH radicals in the lower atmosphere  and should therefore have

relatively short (e.g.  1-5 year) atmospheric residence times.   On the other

hand,  saturated perfluorocarbons (containing only carbon and flourine atoms)

could be so stable that environmental effects  would be negligible for an

indefinite period.   At this point the long-term effects of a build-up of

stable synthetic halocarbons in the atmosphere are not fully understood and

further studies of the possible environmental  hazards of these compounds are

now underway.
aThe scope of this study did not include an assessment of the ozone deple-
 tion hypothesis and no judgement on this question should be inferred here,
 or elsewhere in the report.
                                     IV-14

-------
     Hydrocarbons - Propane and various saturated isomers of butane are

by far the predominant hydrocarbon propellants today.   As paraffins, these

compounds exhibit low photochemical reactivity and are exempt compounds

under Rule 66 of the Los Angeles County Air Pollution Control District.

Furthermore, when comparing the potential magnitude of hydrocarbon emissions

as aerosol propellant to total hydrocarbon emissions from other sources,

it appears that.the environmental impact of substituting hydrocarbons for

fluorocarbons in this application would be small.  For example, if the

total 1973 fluorocarbon propellant emissions of approximately 500 million

pounds were replaced pound-for-pound by hydrocarbon emissions, these emissions

would represent less than one percent of national hydrocarbon emissions

in 1970 as estimated, by the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency.3 In  the

past, the flammability of these compounds  (which may be suppressed with

halocarbons) has mitigated against their use in those products where

fluorocarbons are most widely used.

     Compressed Gases  - For the quantities which would be involved in aerosol

spray applications, the compressed gases would be unlikely to present an

environmental hazard.  Nitrogen, carbon dioxide and nitrous oxide are all

natural components of the atmosphere.  Nitrogen makes up approximately 75

percent, carbon dioxide 0.05 percent and nitrous oxide about  0.00016  percent

by weight of the earth's atmosphere.   Even for nitrous oxide, the quantity

of atmospheric emissions which would result from substituting this compressed

gas for current world-wide use of F-ll and F-12 as aerosol propellants would

be less than one-tenth of one percent of the estimated annual global emissions

 The National Air Monitoring Program;  Air Quality and Emissions Trends
bVol. 1, EPA, 1973. Table 1-5.
 Bolz, R.E., and G.L. Tiave, (eds.), Handbook of Tables for Applied Engineering
 Science, The Chemical Rubber Co., Cleveland, 1972. P. 533.

                                     IV-15

-------
of nitrous oxide from biological action.  Unfortunately, as was noted earlier,

these gases are far from ideal aerosol propellants for many applications.

None of them will deliver a fine spray with current technology, nitrogen

has very poor solubility properties, and nitrous oxide presents a direct

personal hazard because of its strong oxidizing power.

     Chlorocarbons - These compounds are undesirable as broad substitutes

for the fluorocarbon propellants because of the direct human hazards they

would present in terms of flammability, toxicity and skin irritation. ;In

view of these characteristics, no assessment of possible environmental

hazards is presented here.   It is worth noting, however, that methyl chloride

has been identified as a possible source of stratospheric chlorine atoms.

Although a natural source is believed to exist for much of the methyl chloride

present in the atmosphere, substitution of methyl chloride for F-12 as a

propellant would increase estimated U.S. anthropogenic emissions of this

chemical by a factor of about thirty.

e.  Technical and Economic Evaluation of Aerosol Alternatives - The approxi-

mate selling prices (mid-1975) of the various major types of aerosol pro-

pellants in use are listed by Table  IV-3.  The fluorocarbons, clearly, are

the most expensive propellants among those commonly in use.  One industry

source estimated that in his company's aerosol product line, fluorocarbon

propellants represent, on the average, about 30% of the direct product cost.

If direct substitution of alternative propellants such as hydrocarbons
aRecent work by one producer  suggests  that methylene chloride may be  sub-
  stituted as vapor depressant,  in  small quantity without causing flamm-
  ability, skin irritation or  toxicity  hazards.  Also,  since  the hydroxyl
  reactivity rate  of methylene chloride is relatively high, it probably
  poses  less of a  threat  to  the  atmosphere than the more stable  fluorocarbons.
                                    IV-16

-------
      Table IV-3.  APPROXIMATE  SELLING PRICE OF MAJOR
                   AEROSOL PROPELLANTS - 1975
                        (cents per pound)
Propellant  types
Fluorocarbons
   F-ll
   F-12
   F-114
   F-115
Price
  35
  41
  49
 150
Hydrocarbons
   Propane
   Isobutane
   n-Butane
  14
  12
  12
Compressed gases
   Carbon dioxide
   Nitrous oxide
   Nitrogen
   5
  19
   3
Chlorocarbon
   Methylene chloride
  17
 Price will vary considerably depending on quantities purchased
 and shipping costs. These are prices to aerosol fillers.
Source: .Arthur D. Little,  Inc., estimates based on industry contacts.
                              IV-17

-------
were possible, propellant cost would be reduced to about 10 percent of product


cost.  There have been strong economic incentives, therefore, for producers of


aerosol products to use alternative propellants, wherever possible, to form-


ulate marketable products.  However, in the absence of regulatory controls,


the market place, however imperfect, ultimately serves to determine which


product or products the consumer finds most satisfactory on a cost/performance


basis.  Historically, the consumer has found fluorocarbon products to be most


satisfactory in many cases.


    There seems to be a general consensus among aerosol industry representa-


tives that it is not possible to make a direct substitution of one type of


propellant for another or substitute a mechanical delivery system for an


aerosol system without significantly altering the characteristics of the


product in question.  Thus, assessment of the technical feasibility of


alternatives to fluorocarbon based aerosols is difficult because of the many


subjective product qualities involved as perceived by the consumer.  The con-


venience of aerosols relative to mechanical applicators is one example; the


unpleasant feel of a wet, cold spray on the skin is another.  In hair sprays,


a pump spray may be more satisfactory for a particular hair style than an


aerosol product, or vice-versa.  The desired amount of 'holding power1 and


the 'feel' of the hair are important considerations according to aerosol hair


spray marketers.


    A number of pump type hair sprays are currently on the market, as noted


previously.  The pumps used in these products cost approximately 10 to 15$.


In a comparison with aerosol spray systems, the pump can be viewed as a

                                                          3.
replacement for both the aerosol valve and the propellant.   The valve and
 But not a total replacement since the product must be reformulated with

additional solvent to replace solvent power of the propellant.



                                      IV-18

-------
overcap for fluorocarbon aerosol products cost approximately 3 to 4$.  Propel-




lant costs obviously depend on the amount used, which in turn depends on




specific formulation and size or weight of the product.  The combinations of




F-ll and F-12 typically used cost about 40-45
-------
 of  the C0? system.  Filling costs are on the order of l-2<: per unit higher

 because of the saturation step required with CO..

     Aerosol products are labeled and marketed on a total contents weight

 basis; i.e., the weight of propellant is included in the product weight.

 Since there is no propellant in a pump spray and since a carbon dioxide

 aerosol spray contains much less propellant than a fluorocarbon aerosol, there

 is  some question as to the content weight which constitutes an equivalent
                                                                        \
 amount of product in each case.  As noted above, differences in formulation

 required to meet desired performance characteristics are also involved.

 For example, use of additional solvent may be one method to at least partially

 replace liquified propellant.  Furthermore, a marketing strategy may be

 adopted whereby the alternatives are either marketed at the same total content

 weight or in the same size package as the fluorocarbon propelled aerosols.

 These factors complicate any direct cost comparison.

     The general consensus of the industry at this point seems to be that-

 pump sprays presently cost slightly more than fluorocarbon aerosol sprays
                                           a
 while CO -based products cost slightly less.  Again, it is worth repeating

 that any comparison of costs should be viewed with the understanding that

 the product performance characteristics of each of the alternatives are

 different.

     Hydrocarbon-based hairspray products in which water was included in

 the formulation to suppress flammability were on the market at one time

 several years ago.  They reportedly were less costly than fluorocarbon

based products, but they never achieved successful consumer acceptance and

were eventually withdrawn from the market.  In the anti-perspirant product
aThis comparison is on a total product weight basis,  including aerosol
 propellant.
                                      IV-20

-------
 category,  there has been no widely acknowledged success to date in the use of .

 compressed gas or hydrocarbon propellants.   (One industry source reports that

 an anti-perspirant formulated with a methylene chloride/hydrocarbon propellant

 system has been marketed on a limited scale  for several years.)  Developments

 are underway on pump-based products, and a product of this type is reportedly

 undergoing limited market tests.  Alternative product forms already on the

 market, and in apparently increasing quantities, include roll-ons, sticks,

 and pad-type products.  There has been an effort to promote forms which spray

 a dry powder, but these are criticized on the basis that most of the powder

 does not adhere to the skin.  Another possibility, if fluorocarbon-based

 anti-perspirants were to be banned, is that  there would be a resurgence of

 deodorant  aerosols—provided that these can be formulated with an alternative

 propellant such as CQ--

    Information on perfluorocarbon compounds under evaluation as propellants

 is limited because interest in them was generated only recently by the threat

 of possible restrictions on the use of F-ll and F-12, and also because of

 confidentiality agreements between femulators and suppliers.  However, at

projected  commercial prices of $2 or more per pound, they would be at a

severe, if not prohibitive, cost disadvantage relative to the other alterna-

 tives—except perhaps in high-cost specialty items such as perfumes or medical/

pharmaceutical products.

 2.  Refrigerants

 a.  End Use - The end use of fluorocarbons in refrigeration and air condition-
                               o
 ing is distributed between R-ll , 12 and 22, accounting for all but a few
aThe 'R1 in this terminology is an abbreviation for 'refrigerant* and is
 equivalent to the *F' code used for fluorocarbons in other sections of this
 report.
                                       IV-21

-------
percent of the total refrigerants sold.  The estimated quantities used are




shown in Table IV-4.






            Table IV-4.  END USE OF FLUOROCARBON REFRIGERANTS BY TYPE
Fluorocarbon
R-ll
R-12
R-22
Other
Total
1973 End Use
(millions of pounds)
18
168
90
24
300
(percent)
6
56 x
30
8
100
Source:  Arthur D. Little, estimates based on industry data.




    An estimate of 1973 fluorocarbon refrigerant use and emissions to the




atmosphere is shown in Table IV-5.  This table is based on data compiled




by industry associations, the U.S. Department of Commerce, fluorocarbon




producers and refrigeration and air-conditioning equipment manufacturers.




The individual emission estimates are calculated from unit data, using the




assumptions given on the table.




b.  Emission Problem Areas - As indicated in Table IV-5, fluorocarbon




emissions from automobile air-conditioning, from residential and commerical




air-conditioning, and from food store refrigeration are all relatively




large.  Approximately 80 percent of the fluorocarbon refrigerant emissions




are derived from air-conditioning applications.  It appears that more than




60 percent of all refrigerant emissions could be eliminated with improved




service procedures and with relatively minor design changes.  Another 25




percent of emissions could be recovered at the point of disposal, and the




remaining 15 percent eliminated only by changing to a different refrigerant.




                                     IV-2 2

-------
                                                         Table IV-5.  ESTIMATED U.S. FLUOROCARBON EMISSIONS AND USE AS REFRIGERANT - 1973

. Type
of b
equipment

Halor Appliances
Room A/C l
pehumldif iers1
Freezers '
Refrigerators
Other
Ice makers
Water coolers
Mobile A/C*
Unitary residential A/C
Unitary commercial A/C
Centrifugal chillers
Reciprocating chillers
Unit coolers
Food store refrtg. '
Mobile ref rig. 2
Beverage refrlg.
Packaged terminal A/C



Refrigerant
commonly
used
t

22
12
12
' 12

12
12
12C
22
22
11.12.22
11.12.22
12
12,22
12
12
22



nits In
service
millions)
Units
shipped
1973.
(millions)
•Units
scrapped
1973
(millions)
Average
unit
charge
(Ib/unlt)
^ Unit Estimates _

29.0
5.1
22.4
68.7

1.3
3.8
45.0 .
11.4
4.0
0.05
0.2
1.7
0.2
0.5
23.8
1.0



5.35
0.65
2.42
6.77

0.22
0.39
7.53
2.15
0.62
0.005
0.02
0.19
0.008
0.07
3.57
0.15

-

4.00
0.16
1.10
4.00

0.03
0.16
7.00
0.40
0.17
0.001
0.003
0.12
0.006
0.03
0.65
0.03

- -

2.00
. 0.84
1.25
0.63

2.00
.1.00
3.80
9.20
36.0
2500
350
14.0
675
14.0
1.2
2.5

-
Original
charge
1973
million Ib)


10.7
0.5
3.0
4.3

0.4
0.4
28.6
19.8
22.3
12.5
7.0
2.7
5.4
1.0
*-3
0.4
9.0
132.3
Leakage
not re-
coverable
million Ib)

Preventable
leakage
(million Ib]
Recoverable
refrigerant
at disposal
(million Ib)

Total
emissions
follllon Ib)
^ Emission Estimates11
~~*"
1.2
0.1
0.6
0.9

0.1
0.1
6.8
2.1
2.9
6.3
1.4
0.5
6.8
0.1
0.6
0.1 -
2.2
32.8
• "
Small
Small
Small
Small

Small
Small
42. 81
12.6
17.3
15.0
8.4
Small
16.2
0.8
3.4
Small.
11.9
128.4

6.4
.0.1 >
.!• 1
2.0

0.1
- 0.1
21.3
2.9
4.9
2.0
0.8
1.3
. 3.2
0.3
0.6
0.1
3.9
51.1

7.6
0.2
1-7
2.9

0.2
0.2
70.9
17.6
25.1
23.3
10.6
1.8
26.2
1.2
4.6
0.2
18.0
212.3

Percent
of
Total
>,

3.6
0.1
0.8
1.4

C.I
0.1
33.3
.. 8.3
11.8
11.0
5.0
0.8
12.3
0.6
2.2
0.1
8.5
LOO.O
?
to
              Small - leas than 0.1 million pounds

              "Preventable through relatively minor modifications to current equipment design or service procedures

              b,
                                                                                                          ""R-22  is  uaed  in  busses.
                                                                                                          Unit data  are  on a per store basis.
'Emission basis:    •                                                                                .
      i  Factory charged, sealed units:  2 percent of charge per year basic leakage (not recoverable).
      2.' Field charged sealed  compressor units:   2 percent basic leakage and 12 percent service- and design related  (potentially preventable).
      3. Field charged open motor units:  5 percent basic  leakage and 12 percent service- and design-related (potentially preventable).
      4. Mobile  (automobile) A/C unit:  4 percent basic  leakage and  25 percent service- and design-related (potentially preventable).
   1-4. Refrigerant charge remaining at time of scrap is  equal to 80 percent of original charge.

Sources:   U.S.  Department of  Commerce  and Arthur D.  Little,  Inc.,  estimates based  on  Industry contacts.

-------
c.    Identification of Potential Solutions - Potential solutions to fluoro-


carbon losses of refrigerants may be classified as follows:


      •  Leak prevention,


      •  Recovery during servicing or disposal,


      •  Use of alternate refrigerants or refrigeration systems, and


      •  Reduction or elimination of refrigeration and air conditioning.


Alternate refrigerants will be discussed in detail in Section d, "Evaluation


of Chemical Alternatives."


     A short discussion of refrigeration systems is given below, as back-


ground for understanding the potential solutions discussed.  Figure IV-2


illustrates the basic vapor-compression refrigeration system, which is the


most widely used refrigeration cycle today.


     The cycle consists of compression of the refrigerant gas, cooling by


water or air to convert the gas to liquid, and expansion through a valve


to permit evaporation of the liquid.  Evaporation absorbs heat from the


refrigerator unit or air being conditioned.  The warmed refrigerant then renews


the cycle at the compressor.  There are many variations, including more complex


cycles, in order to provide designs that are optimized for particular appli-


cations.


    Leak Prevention - Leakage losses are at a relatively low level for hermet-

      a
ically  sealed systems, being reported at about 2 percent of the initial


charge per year, based on a 10-year life with about 80 percent of charge left


at that time.  This rate appears to be about the best the state-of-the-art is


capable of since home refrigerators and window air conditioners are mature,
 In the air conditioning and refrigeration industry, the term "hermetic" is
 taken to mean a system in which the compressor drive motor is sealed in the

 refrigerant atmosphere.
                                     IV-24

-------
                                         COMPRESSOR-
                              H1GH_PRESSUH(!_S!0£_
                             " LOW PRESSURE SIDE
                                                     MOTOR-
                               (REFRIGERATION LOAD)
      Figure IV-2.   Equipment Diagram for Basic Vapor Compression Cycle
Source:   ASHRAE Handbook of Fundamentals. American Society  of Heating,
          Refrigeration and Air-Conditioning Engineers, Inc.,  Joseph D.
          Pierce, Chairmant 1972.
                                    IV-25

-------
highly  competitive products, and do not use mechanical connectors nor elastomer




seals.




     Non-hermetically sealed systems on the other hand have substantial




losses; two general categorizations appear reasonable for this class:




mobile  and stationary.




     The dominant subcategory of mobile systems is the automobile air




conditioner.  Auto air conditioners are reported as leaking at a rate of




2-3 ounces per year per unit, but overall losses are reported as closer




to 16 ounces per year per unit.  The larger figure is due to the practice




of service stations promoting refrigerant recharging, with the spent charge




being lost to the atmosphere.  As in the case of home appliances, the pro-




duct is mature and well engineered, with the rotating shaft seal and the




flexible hoses as leak sources.  Leaks from the rotating seal may show




small reduction by using two series seals, but this would add cost and add




to the power requirements to overcome the added friction—with little reduc-




tion in emissions.




     A greater point of leverage to reduce losses in auto air conditioners




is to modify the flexible elastomer hose.  This hose has a very high perme-




ability at the high temperatures (150°F) under the hood.  To shorten it would




probably help but wouldn't attack the basic problem, and would result in a




greater transmission of noise and vibration to the cab.  A more basic ap-




proach is to replace the elastomer hose with flexible metal hose.  The




three flexible hoses commonly used represent between 5 and 10 percent of




the manufacturing costs of a system.  Hose manufacturers indicate that they




have not yet achieved metal flexible hoses that will stand up to the- vibrations




as the auto A/C system is presently designed.  However, the failure mode
                                   IV-26

-------
has been postulated as  due  to  torsion from engine rock, which could be allevi-




ated by extra length of hose,  providing a loop.  A further significant reduc-




tion of losses may be achieved through reduction in service losses, which is




discussed in that section later  in this report.




    The other category  of non-hermetically sealed systems is that of stationary




systems.  One subcategory is represented by unitary commercial air conditioners,




another by large commercial refrigeration and air conditioning systems




(chillers)..  These subcategories are characterized by field assembly and




charging.  Since mechanical tubing connectors are used, such systems are prone




to leak rates in the order  of  twice those found in. hermetically sealed systems;




resulting in an average charge life of 5 rather than 10 years.




    Precharged compressor units  that contain the bulk of the necessary charge




sealed within by self-sealing  connectors are reported to be in about 40 to 50




percent of the unitary  residential A/C units.  The evaporator and tubing sets




are factory evacuated and filled with a holding charge of refrigerant.  During




field assembly when the connectors are made up they automatically open the




seal with little or no  refrigerant loss.  Such connectors are swivel type and




are less likely to be mlsmade  than conventional flared or compression fittings,




according to the manufacturer.   (One manufacturer, however, is of the opinion that




conventional fittings,  if properly installed under supervision, are as good .




from a potential leak viewpoint.)




    These seal connectors are  of two types; one being a seal that is pierced




when assembled and does not reseal when broken again.  This type is the one




used in 40-50 percent,of the unitary residential units.  The other, that will




reseal itself, is.more  expensive and currently is used only in mobile homes,
                                      IV-27

-------
as protection against untrained mechanics.  Such connectors may provide an



answer to much of the leakage in other field-assembled units.



    Another method that has been suggested to reduce leaks in these systems



is that field systems be assembled by silver soldering the majority of con-



nections instead of using the customary tubing connectors.  Indeed, according



to several representative, contractors, they preassembled as much of the



tubing as possible so as to have a minimum number of connectors made up in
                                                                        \


the field.  However, it was also reported that field soldering is difficult



and probably not practical.  This approach may warrant further investigation.



    In any event, it appears that the bulk of losses from these systems may



come from servicing rather than leakage,  where a more common practice appar-



ently is to vent the old charge completely,  in smaller units, before adding



the new refrigerant and lubricant,  on the supposition that water or air or



oil residues may be partially the cause of malfunction.  On larger units,



partial bleed off is practiced for the same reason.   This practice and poten-



tial solutions to the losses incurred are discussed under "Recovery During



Servicing or Disposal" belowi



     An additional potential leak reduction procedure would be to require



use of electronic leak detectors for all field installations.  Apparently



most manufacturers use these instruments, but the common field test is to



use the torch tester that indicates halocarbon presence by a color change



of the flame:  its sensitivity is 3.2 oz/year compared to 0.01 oz/year for



the electronic detector.  The objection to using the electronic detector



has been stated as too high a sensitivity, so that when making up the



refrigeration system, there is too much fluorocarbon about and the detector



is alarming all the time:  the installer can't locate the leak.  Also,
                                     IV-28

-------
leakage at installation will remain in the area for some time.  These ob-

jections are open to question:  the less sensitive detector may be

used for locating large leaks.  If necessary, the installations may be left

for a day or so and then rechecked with the electronic detector.  Obviously,

the cost of installation increases, but the objective of lowest possible

leakage is attained.

     Recovery During Servicing or Disposal - The largest losses from her-

metically sealed units appear to occur upon disposal.   Currently there is

no incentive for recovery of the refrigerant charge, and since the scrap
                                                              )
value of such units is marginal at best, most are discarded in dumps where

ultimately loss of the remaining charge occurs.

     Disposal losses may be prevented if the right combination of incentives

is provided, backed by regulation.  A relatively inexpensive pump and re-

ceiver tank constitutes the principal capital investment required for a

service organization or individual to collect refrigerant for recycle.

Since prices for refrigerant run in the order of $2.00 or so per pound re-

tail, and appliance charges are often one pound or less, recovery is an

economically marginal activity.  Therefore, possible additional incentives

may be bounties or rebates, possibly covered by an initial purchase price

addition.  Such a procedure would probably require a training program for

servicemen and centrally located recycling centers for reception and repro-

cessing of the returned refrigerant.

     Prevention of losses from the non-hermetically sealed units may be

possible using the same approach of incentive plus regulation.  These units

are serviced by competent, trained persons who should be able to handle

recovery with little additional training.
                                    IV-29

-------
     Of particular interest here is auto air conditioning.   As previously

stated, the current servicing use appears to be about a pound per year per

unit, whereas manufacturers claim the units should not leak more than about

two to three ounces per year, and that the remaining replacement use is

unwarranted.  This area requires more investigation and definition to as-

certain whether such use is or is not necessary.  If it turns out that

such use really is not necessary but the shops think it is, a re-education

program may be in order, and, perhaps, diagnostic tools or methods may be>

developed to assist the shop personnel to establish the real cause of auto

air conditioning malfunction.  In addition, sale of recharge cans on the

open market as a do-it-yourself kit may have to be restricted.

d.  Evaluation of Chemical Alternatives

    Alternative Refrigerants for Vapor Compression Cycle - The 1972 ASHRAE
                        o
Handbook of Fundamentals  lists 78 refrigerants with standard designation.

They are categorized as follows:


                                                         Number of
              Category                                Chemicals Listed

    Halocarbon Compounds                                     39   *
    Cyclic Organic Compounds                                  3
    Azeotropes                                                5
    Hydrocarbons                                              5
    Oxygen Compounds                                          2
    Nitrogen Compounds                                        2
    Inorganic Compounds                                      12
    Unsaturated Organic Compounds                            10


Particular refrigerants have been selected over the years as the more desira-

ble chemicals from the viewpoint of performance, availability arid price.  The

halocarbons, cyclic organic compounds and azeotropes have largely replaced

all the others (compounds R-ll, 12 and 22 appear to have dominated)  in spite
 1 Chapter 14 of this volume is an excellent reference on refrigerants.
                                     IV-30

-------
of generally higher prices.  The reason this has occurred is the combination




of nontoxicity, and chemical inertness along with good performance character-




istics inherent in these compounds.   In the following discussion, the more




common factors used to evaluate refrigerants are discussed.




    •  Toxicity




         Underwriters' Laboratories classify the comparative hazards




    to life of gases and vapors in six groups ranging from sulfur




    dioxide (a refrigerant formerly in wide use) which, in concen-




    trations of about one-half to one percent for durations of




    exposure of about 5 minutes, is lethal or produces serious injury,




    to Refrigerant 12, which in concentrations up to at least about




    20 percent by volume for durations of exposure of about 2 hours




    does not appear to produce injury.  Most of the fluorocarbons fall




    under the very low toxicity classifications, numbers 5 and 6.




    Ammonia (another common refrigerant in the past and still used)




    falls into Group 2, also quite lethal.  Even methylene chloride




    which was suggested as a reasonable substitute refrigerant by




    one chemical manufacturer interviewed, is listed as just slightly




    less toxic than Group 4 which is considered lethal at 2 to 2 1/2




    percent for two hours' exposure:  This could still be a serious




    hazard for home appliances where people may be sleeping at the time




    when a leak occurs, although it may be acceptable in large indusr-




    trial or commercial uses where size may justify the added precautions




    and equipment needed for protection against accidents.
                                  IV-31

-------
•  Flammability




     Flammability is of concern from the viewpoints of the manu-




facturer who has to handle it, as well as of the user, because of




potential leakage.  Ammonia leakage in food storage warehouses .




still causes explosions.  Sulfur dioxide is nonflammable but highly




toxic.  Methyletie chloride and the fluorocarbons are nonflammable.




The hydrocarbons, such as butane and iso-butane, are good refrig-




erants, nontoxic but flammable.




•  Effect on Elastomers




     Since elastomers are used as o-ring seals and gaskets in




refrigeration systems, tkeir compatibility with the refrigerant




is important to prevent leaks.  Further, the combined effects of




the refrigerant with tha lubricant used in sealed systems is often




synergistic.  Methylene chloride is quite hard on most cammon




elastomers, as is, Refrigerant 21:  most other common fluorocarben




refrigerants have.at least one or two coramon elastomers that are




little affected but in this category they do not appear to have




a clear cut advantage over alternate refrigerants.  Hydrocarbons




have almost no effect-on elastomers.




•  Effect on Cpnstruction Materials




     Ammonia.cannot be used with copper-bearing metals.  Sulfur




dioxide reacts with any moisture present to form sulfuric acid




which is very corrosive to most metals.  Magnesium, zinc and




aluminum alloys containing more than 2 percent magnesium are




not recommended for use with the halogenated compounds where




even trace amounts of water are present.  So again, for most
                                  IV-32

-------
 refrigerants, materials of construction must be carefully




 selected,  although  again, hydrocarbons are quite non-reactive.




 •   Performance Characteristics




      To  quote from  the ASHRAE Handbook of Fundamentals:  "As a




 rule, the  selection of a refrigerant is a compromise between con-




 flicting desirable  properties.  For example, the pressure in the




 evaporator should be as high as possible and, at the same time,




 a low condensing pressure is desirable.  Low viscosity and low




 surface tension are desirable properties but, on the other hand,




 they make  it difficult to provide dropwise condensation which.would




 improve heat transfer.  High capacity accompanied by low power




 requirements would  also be desirable if possible.  These and.




 other conflicts must be resolved in selecting a refrigerant.




     Since evaporation of the liquid is the only step in the




 refrigeration cycle which produces cooling, the latent heat of




 a refrigerant should be as large as possible.  On a molar basis




 the latent heat is  about the same for materials having the same




 boiling point.




     Since the compressor operates on volumes of gas or moles,




 refrigerants with similar boiling points will produce similar




 capacities in the same compressor.  The weight of the refrig-




 erant circulated would be different, depending on the molecular




weight.  The compression ratio in centrifugal compressors is




 affected by the vapor, density.  The density is related to the




molecular weight of the gas as well as the temperature and




 pressure of operation."
                                 IV-33

-------
     As a result of these considerations and others, within




reasonable operating pressures the choice of refrigerants are




particularly restricted for use as components in multistage




systems for achieving low temperatures, and for use in normal "low"




temperature refrigerators/freezers, as well as in standard refrig-




erators, and air conditioners.  For these reasons, Refrigerant 12




has only one or two potential substitutes even among the fluorochloro-




carbons, for the common household refrigerator, without involving




total redesign.




Potential Substitution




•  Substitution of Halocarbons
     If Refrigerant 22 is an acceptable compound, having a hydrogen




bond and, hence, being subject to destruction before becoming a




hazard to the ozone layer, then window air conditioning units,




unitary air conditioning systems and some central chillers will




be unaffected.  These applications appear to account for a sig-




nificant portion of the AC&R applications.  Changing from 12 to




22 for the home refrigerators and freezers would require substantial



redesign.  R-22 is widely used for reciprocating units in central commer-




cial air-conditioning systems, up to about 100 ton capacity, and




for centrifugals over 3000 tons or so.  The much higher pressure




required for R-22 means increased initial cost in terms of wall




thickness, welds, code requirements, etc. and is worthwhile in the




larger centrifugals.  R-ll is used for centrifugals up to 300 tons




or so (and operates under a vacuum), and R-12 is used for the
                                 IV-34

-------
 intermediate centrifugals.   Therefore conversion to R-22 would




 require complete redesign of the  small and  intermediate centri-




 fugals up to about 3000 tons capacity.




      Changing from 12 to 22  for auto  air conditioners would




 require a considerably more  complex redesign than that required




 for a similar conversion for refrigerators  and freezers, primarily




 caused by the high temperatures the system  is exposed to under




 the hood.   In addition to the higher  pressures,  the higher tem-




 perature may cause stability problems for the refrigerant, and




 will greatly increase the permeation  through currently used




 elastomer flexible hose.




      For all the applications described above that potentially




 could use 22 in place of 12,  a severe constraint  is placed on




 the conversion due to the fact that,  particularly for home




 refrigerators and freezers,  the high  degree of competition and



'resulting low margin of profit available to the  manufacturer,, com-




 bined with the potential legal responsibility for consumer products




 under today's laws, may discourage manufacturers to the point of  their




 considering  going out of  the appliance business  and investing the capital




 insother ventures or in other divisions of  the company.



     .Refrigerant 501 is an azeotropic mixture of  75 percent




 of  Refrigerant 22 and 25  percent  Refrigerant 12  and, therefore,




 is  not an acceptable substitute.




      If we then consider  that R-22 is not acceptable either,




 further consideration leads  to development  of equipment to
                                 IV-35

-------
handle perfluorides, or development of a completely new refrig-




erant.  The.perfluorides are in the order of 20 times more costly




than R-12, since R-12 is an intermediate.  Perfluorides also




have poor compatibility with the lubricants.  In addition, the




perfluorides would have to be thoroughly investigated and proven




to have no ill effect on the ozone layer, in addition to passing




the more conventional requirements, before industry would be




willing to undertake both their manufacture and use.




•  Ammonia




     Ammonia is a very good refrigerant and is used in both the




vapor compression cycle and the absorption cycle (to be described




later).  It is, however, both toxic and flammable.   Hence its use




has been restricted largely to industrial storage and manufacturing




operations where the practices and precautions are able to be




enforced to assure safety.  For use in commercial buildings and




in homes, a major redesign would be required to contain the




ammonia cycle equipment out-of-doors where chances of hazards would be




minimized, or to take other precautions to ensure personal safety.




     Ammonia is closer to R-22 than to R-12 in characteristics that




bear on equipment design:  hence it would present a severe restriction




on design of a substitute system for automotive air conditioning,




for the reasons cited in the preceding section of this report:




high temperatures under the hood, and high condensing pressures.
                                  IV-36

-------
     •  Hydrocarbons




          Many of the hydrocarbons are good performers as refrigerants,




     and are used in industrial environments to some degree.   Propane,




     butane, and iso-butane are three common hydrocarbons that have




     good refrigeration characteristics and, though flammable, are




     not toxic.  Their use would necessitate adequate safeguards against




     reaching explosive limits in air mixtures, and probably require




     mounting the refrigerant cycle equipment outside of areas occupied




     by people, such as homes.




     Alternative Refrigerants for Other Cycles - Although the vapor com-




pression cycle dominates the refrigeration and air conditioning industry,




other cycles are used.  The most commonly used are:  absorption, thermo-




electric, steam Jet, air cycle and liquid nitrogen.




     •  Absorption




          A simplified diagram of the basic absorption refrigeration




     cycle is shown in Figure IV-3.




          As in the vapor compression cycle, the refrigerant is pressurized,




     liquefied, cooled and then allowed to vaporize in the evaporator




     where it absorbs heat to accomplish refrigeration.   However, instead




     of using a compressor to pressurize the refrigerant, it is cooled  to




     permit liquefaction at a low pressure by absorption in a miscible




     absorbent fluid and pumped as a liquid to the generator.  Heat is




     applied at the generator to drive off the refrigerant as a vapor and




     to pressurize it.  The refrigerant is then cooled in the condenser




     to form a pressurized liquid for use in the evaporator again.
                                   IV-37

-------
                                   _Mt»T
                                   . IN
                      PUMP


                     0
           Figure IV-3.   Basic Absorption Refrigeration Cycle
Source:
ASHRAE Handbook of Fundamentals. American Society  of Heating
Refrigeration and Air-Conditioning Engineers,  Inc., Joseph
D. Pierce, Chairman, 1972.
                                     IV-38

-------
Modern systems are more complex, mostly due to devices to Increase
thermal efficiency.
     Two systems have been commercialized:  water-lithium bromide,
and ammonia-water.  In the former, water is the refrigerant and a
water-lithium bromide solution is the absorber, whereas in the
latter, ammonia is the refrigerant and water is the absorber.
Because of the toxicity and flammability of ammonia, the water-
lithium bromide appears to have gained greater acceptance and
is used for commercial air conditioning.
     The ASHRAE Handbook of Fundamentals discusses advantages and
disadvantages of the various absorption pairs and should be re-
ferred to for more detail.
     The April 7, 1975, issue of Air Conditioning, Heating and
Refrigeration News shows that 2,222 absorption and adsorption units
were shipped in 1973.  These quantities peaked at 3,193 in 1970 and
have declined to the above value.
     The water-lithium bromide system is limited to refrigeration
above 32°F, however, since the refrigerant freezes at that temperature.
As a result, it has been applied principally to commercial air con-
ditioning.  Under promotional support by the gas industry, even
home air conditioning systems have been made and sold in the past.
     It should be noted that substituting the absorption cycle for
the vapor compression cycle has implications on the type and quantity
of energy use.  If electricity must be used, for instance, heat is
used at the power generating station to produce electricity, which
then is subject to transmission losses,' aad then is converted into
                                   IV-39

-------
heat again  to power  the absorption refrigeration system.  The net


result is very low energy efficiency.  On the other hand, moderate


temperature waste heat may be used as the energy source for absorption


systems.  Indeed, as the technology of solar energy is developed,


absorption  systems will be designed using heat from the sun as at


least part  of the energy input.


     An interesting comparison of the efficiency of power use of


absorption  and thermoelectric with vapor compression is given in


the ASHRAE  Guide and Data Book, Equipment, 1972, as follows:


"Operating  efficiencies of the three most practical refrigeration


systems are as follows for a 0°F freezer and 90°F ambient:
                   ..    *•       :  ' '   .

     -  Thermoelectric:     approximately 0.3 Btu/Watt hr


     -  Absorption:         approximately 1.5 Btu/Watt hr


     -  Vapor Compression:  approximately 3.0 Btu/Watt hr"


     However, conversations with manufacturers indicate that ab-


sorption cycles are close to vapor compression systems at their


present stage of development:  They are more expensive in terms


of initial  cost but may pay for this difference long term in lower


operating costs*  Further, units are now available that operate


off of hot water as a heat source and are being used in conjunc-


tion with solar heating plants.



•  Thermoelectric      „


     There was a great flurry of activity ten years or so ago in


development work with thermoelectric approaches.  This method con-


sists of forcing electrical current to flow through a thermocouple


junction (two dissimilar.metal wires connected together in a loop)
                                  1V-40

-------
which causes heat absorption.  However, although most refrigeration




and air conditioning firms tried to develop commercial equipment, all




such work appears to have ceased:  The approach has been deemed not




commercially feasible, primarily due to a high initial cost in the




order of ten times conventional refrigeration systems.




     Thermoelectric systems efficiencies are an order of magnitude




lower than vapor compression systems, as noted in the discussion




of absorption systems immediately preceding.




•  Air Cycle Refrigeration




     Air cycle refrigeration equipment is still used for air con-




ditioning in some aircraft:  The "Brayton" cycle offers low weight




and compactness over vapor compression cycle equipment.  Air cycles




were used for cold storage and heater/cooler applications but were




displaced from those uses by the advent of halocarbons.  They do




offer an alternative to halocarbons, using a safe, nontoxic and




cheap refrigerant:  air.  The air cycle equipment has a low




efficiency, however, and this fact has restricted its use severely.




•  Steam Jet Refrigeration




     Steam jet refrigeration systems are used for industrial cooling




applications such as freeze-drying foods, chemical crystallizers, etc.




In these systems water is the refrigerant and is pumped and com-




pressed by a steam jet ejector instead of a motor-driven compressor.




Thus, like the lithium bromide or ammonia absorption systems, the




equipment is simple, quiet, low in vibration, and low in cost.  How-




ever, it must reject two to three times as much heat as a conventional




vapor compression type and generally requires water cooling.
                                  IV-41

-------
     9  Liquid Nitrogen




          Liquid nitrogen is used as a refrigerant for refrigerated trucks




     and trailers, where a hard freeze is required (and for cryogenic




     applications).  At this point, we do not know how competitive such




     systems are for broad use, but they are obviously competitive for




     these specialized applications.  Since nitrogen makes up four-fifths




     of the atmosphere and is nonflammable and nontoxic, it appears to be




     a good alternate to consider in more depth if fluorocarbon use must




     be discontinued.  The major disadvantages of liquid nitrogen are




     constant replenishment and the special care required in handling




     and distribution due to its very low temperature.  The low tempera-




     ture of liquid nitrogen also imposes a very large thermodynamic




     disadvantage on such a system overall whereas a conventional freezer




     requires 1.002 HP of work per ton of refrigeration at 32°F, a liquid




     nitrogen system requires approximately 2.65 HP.   This is really a



     special application which is not practical in most potential uses.




e.   Problems with Implementation of Potential Solutions -




     Development Time - It must be recognized that the current equipment and




refrigerants have been developed after many trials and errors, and that they




represent the most economical solutions to refrigeration and air conditioning




needs:  any changes will involve redesign with associated time and cost com-




mitments .




     Potential solutions other than installation and servicing procedure




changes may be classified as product modifications and new product development.





     •  Product Modifications




          This category may include such changes as metal hose
                                        IV-42

-------
substitution in auto air conditioning systems, and substitution of




self-sealing connectors for field-installed systems.




     Development time for such changes may range from a year for




testing alternate connectors up to 2 to 2-1/2 years for the design




and testing of. alternate hose-materials and configurations.  Another




1 to 2-1/2 years would be needed for tooling and start-up of new




production equipment, according to industry sources*




.•  New Product Development                   r




     Examples that fall under this classification may be develop-




ment of a new refrigerant and/or development of equipment to use




the new or an existing alternate refrigerant.




     Industry sources have stated the following time requirements:





     Refrigerant Producer                              Years




     Identification of new refrigerant and




      toxicity tests                                    2-5




     Pilot plant testing                                 1




     New production facility                             3




                                            subtotal    6-9





     Equipment Manufacturer




     Design and test                                    3-5




     Limited production field trials                     2




     Obtain new manufacturing equipment                  2




                                            subtotal    7-9






     Thus,  according to. industry sources,  a 7-9 year development
                                  IV-43

-------
     period may be required to convert from R-12 to R-22 in those applications




     where conversion is feasible.  Full commercial development of a completely




     new refrigerant could require a similar time period, although some over-




     lap would be expected.




     Development Costs - Even small changes made to high-volume products such




as refrigerators and auto air conditioners involve significant capital needs.




In particular, the consumer oriented products must be exhaustively tested both




to satisfy regulatory agencies and in addition to assure the manufacturer that




he will not expose his customers to either hazardous equipment or to an in-




ferior product in a. very competitive marketplace.  Because of these restric-




tions the market for such products has dictated evolutionary product develop-




ment, not a revolutionary one.




     The extensive development program is followed by the need for heavy




capital investment in tooling for such high-volume products, since the manu-




facturing lines are highly automated.




     f.   Cost-Effectiveness of Potential Solutions




         Containment and Recovery




         Because of the very high development costs, extended development




     time requirements and large in-service inventory of equipment, coupled




     with the observations from Table IV-5 that on  the order of 85 percent




     of  the current emissions are potentially preventable,  containment




     and recovery of a significant portion of that 85 percent may prove




     to  be the more cost-effective short-term method of all the potential




     solutions discussed here, to reduce fluorocarbon refrigerant emissions.




          Even the containment and recovery approach will require a very




     careful evaluation and will not be without cost  penalties  for consumers.
                                      IV-44

-------
     Substitution of R-22 for Other Common Halocarbon Refrigerants




     If we assume that R^22 is an acceptable refrigerant, then the next most




cost-effective approach (eliminating R-ll and 12) may be:




     •  Home freezers and refrigerators:  attempts to use R-22 have not been




        successful;' further development work will be required.



     •  Home A/C and commercial A/Chillers:  small and large units are now




        available using R-22; intermediate sizes would be redesigned to




        use R-22.




     •  Auto A/C may not be adaptable to R-22.  Therefore, the more cost-




        effective course may be the choice of an alternate refrigeration




        cycle, such as absorption or the reverse Brayton cycle.




     •  Further development may allow other applications to use'R-22.



Existing units could be recharged with R-ll .or 12 if some level of emission




were deemed acceptable during the useful life of these units.




     Complete Restriction of Common Halocarbon Refrigerants



     If we assume that R-22 is not acceptable, a safe and technically well-




     developed choice may be substitution of the absorption cycle.




     •  Home freezers and refrigerators:  since systems have been designed




        and sold for this application in the past, they could be updated and




        substituted.  The original designers used natural gas as the energy




        source; modern commercial A/C applications have been .designed to use




        steam or even hot water as the energy source.  However, new designs




        coupled with solar energy sources, electric power, or home heating




        systems;could be developed.  The crux of the problem, however, is




        (based on contemporary technology) the acceptability of a toxic and




        flammable refrigerant (ammonia).
                                        IV-45

-------
•  Home A/C and commercial A/C:  Commercial A/C units employing




   absorption cycles are available today.   Extension of the range




   of capacities would be required for commercial designs.   For




   home systems, designs have been commercially produced and could




   be again; the same problems mentioned above for home freezers




   and refrigerators exist.  However, technologically the switch




   is reasonable.




•  Auto air conditioning:  Several other alternatives have been




   seriously investigated for auto A/C; among them are the absorp-




   tion cycle and the reverse Brayton cycle.




        The absorption cycle does not look very promising for auto




   A/C for the following reasons:                         '      •




        a.  The absorption cycle requires  a heavy duty cycle to




            attain an acceptable efficiency; auto A/C operates on




            a very low duty cycle.




        b.  The physical size and weight of current designs that use




            air cooling are too large.




        c.  The absorption cycle is sensitive to the acceleration




            and vibration of a mobile unit, particularly in designs




            that do not use pumps but rather depend on thermal




            convection.  However, considerable development work is




            being done on the absorption cycle for use in conjunc-




            tion with solar heating systems, so this cycle should




            be watched closely as a potential alternate for existing




            auto A/C's and also for other  applications.
                                     IV-46

-------
             The reverse Brayton cycle can use air as the refrigerant.


        Systems using this cycle have been built for aircraft use, and


        development work is being done currently toward extending its

                                           '•   •     «    '     •*-;..'
        us6 to other applications.  At present, it has a very low co-


        efficient of performance, however, it may provide an acceptable


        substitute system for auto air'conditioning.  Considerable


        development is required.


        Other:  The dessicant system looks sufficiently developed to be


        the most cost-effective alternate for dehumidification needs if


        R-22 is not acceptable.  In addition, this system may provide an-


        other alternate to the absorption cycle as a less effective but


        viable general air conditioning system.


             In summary, therefore, the more cost-effective approaches may


        be as follows:


        :     a.  R-22 acceptable:  conversion of all systems except auto


                 air-conditioning to R-22.


             b.  R-22 not acceptable:  (1) containment and recovery of


                 losses, (2) conversion to absorption cycle with supple-


                 mental development of the Brayton cycle and dessicant


                 systems.


        Once again, option b.(1) is by far the lowest cost alternative of


        the three because it involves the least amount of redesign of


        current systems.


3.  Solvents and Drycleanlng


a.  Fluorocarbon Solvent Applications and Alternatives - In addition to their


thermodynamic advantages of high vapor pressures and low boiling points that
                                    IV-47

-------
make  them useful in aerosols, blowing agents, and refrigeration systems,



fluorocarbons also have useful solvent properties.  This has been discussed



briefly under aerosol applications.  Other major applications of fluorocarbon



solvents are in degreasing and drycleaning; the major compounds used are F-113



and F-ll.  The major advantages of these solvents are:  nonflammability; high



vapor pressure resulting in quick drying; low heat of vaporization; low order



of toxicity; high density; low surface tension; inertness; purity; and selec-



tive solvency compared to chlorinated solvent alternatives.  Due to their



high cost, fluorocarbon solvents are used where these properties are of para-



mount importance or result-in lower unit costs.



     Degreasing - Degreasing applications are generally in high technology



areas such as aerospace equipment and electronics.  Usually a major concern



is the minimizing of residual surface contaminants.  In the electronics indus-



try in particular, high surface cleanliness is imperative for the reliable



operation of minaturized circuitry and semiconductor devices.  Where chlori-



nated solvents offer similar safety and solvency characteristics, some industry


                                                               3.
contacts expressed concern over traces of the solvent inhibitor  left on the



cleaned surfaces; on the other hand, a major supplier of these solvents is of



the opinion this problem has been solved in most applications.  The major



chlorinated solvent alternative in this use is inhibited methyl chloroform



(1,1,1-trichloroethane).  If the problem of inhibitor residues in semiconduc-



tor applications can be overcome by advanced inhibitor formulations, it is



very likely that the electronics industry could resolve problems of material



Incompatibility (vis-a-vis methyl chloroform) within 2-3 years.
 Additives which reduce or eliminate hydrolysis of the solvent.
                                     IV-48

-------
     Drycleariing - Domestic use of fluorocarbons in drycleaning is dominated
   t
by Dupont's Valclene formulation of F-113.  In Europe, F-ll is a common fluoro-

carbon solvent.  Prime selling points are F-113's high vapor pressure (leading

to fast drying cycle times) and low toxicity-—both very desirable characteris-

tics in coin-operated machines.  The selective solvency of F-113 relative to

perchloroethylene also allows the cleaning of specialty items such as furs

and leather; these materials are now cleaned with the flammable petroleum

solvents.  The relatively high cost of Valclene has resulted in a high level

of vapor emission control on all Valclene machines.  It is doubtful that sol-

vent losses could be reduced much farther than they have been already without

excessively high control costs.

b.  Chlorocarbon Solvent Applications and Alternatives - As outlined previously,

the major applications of chlorinated solvents are in drycleaning, metal de-

greasing, and paint-stripping (methylene chloride only).  The character of

emissions from the cleaning applications and the options for emission abate-

ment are outlined below.

     Metal Degreasing - Metals soiled with oils, greases, waxes, tars, and

other soils not readily removed with water are often cleaned using organic

solvents—either common hydrocarbons such as kerosene, methyl ethyl ketone,

acetone, mineral spirits, and alcohols; or halogenated hydrocarbons such as

as perchlorethylene and trichlorotrifluoroethane (F-113).  This type of

operation is involved in a wide range of industries, the major category

being the metal working industry.  This group includes automotive, aircraft,

appliance, electronics, and business and industrial machinery manufacturers.

Other manufacturing industries such'as printing and plastics companies use

these solvents in normal maintenance.  Similar usage occurs even in non-

manufacturing industries such as automotive and appliance repair stations.
                                      IV-49

-------
However, most of.'the smaller non-manufacturing uses of metal cleaning solvents




use the less expensive hydrocarbon solvents.  It is usually in the larger,




more routine manufacturing industries, where fire safety and recovery ability



are Important factors, that the nonflammable and more expensive halogenated




solvents are used.




     Metal degreasing can be roughly classified into two types of operation:




cold cleaning and vapor degreasing.  Cold cleaning involves dissolution and




removal of the soil from the work when contacted with liquid solvent by immer-




sion, spraying, or wiping.  Vapor degreasing is usually a larger, more cen-




tralized operation; a schematic vapor degreaser is illustrated in Figure IV-4.




The equipment basically consists of an immersion heater in a liquid sump, a




vapor space containing the dense chlorinated solvent vapors, a circumferential




freeboard chiller—a network of water cooled and/or refrigerated tubing—that




contains the vapor layer, and freeboard wall section that further confines the




vapor.  The installation also usually possesses a hood or group of lip vents




which recover vapors escaping from the degreaser.  In operation, the cold,




soiled work penetrates the solvent vapor space and condenses a continuous flux




of pure solvent on its surface which dissolves and rinses away soil leaving




a clean, hot surface which dries almost immediately upon exiting the degreaser.




Cleaning may be facilitated by immersion or spray contact with liquid solvent.




Larger vapor degreasers are often enclosed and conveyorized and are illustrated




in Figure IV-5.  Continuous distillation of solvent from the sump concentrates




soil in the base of the degreaser raising the boiling point of the sump




liquid.  When this temperature reaches a certain point, the solvent is dis-




tilled first in the degreaserj then in a more efficient still to further con-




centrate the sludge.  Solvent concentration in the ultimate still bottom
                                       IV-50

-------
Water
Jacket
        Liquid  Solvent
t
f
Work
                             t     t
                               Solvent
                               Vapor
            .  •. .• .'•  •'  '.,• • '. ': r '. .'.• • •• •. /.. ...•/•".'.•••  •' '. '"'.-.";
              •»  . ':••,...•.•/•.••••.•-•.•;  •"•/'••.,-.
            ;. ... -. •> • • -••' ••••//'•.. •"•••;.-..'''• •• •- '•- -'

        Figure IV-4.   Basic Vapor Degreaser
        Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc.
                                                           Freeboard
                                                           J_L
                                                           Condensate
                                                              Trough
Q\
                                                                  Heater
                             IV-51

-------
                                Conveyor
        Condenser

        Condensate
          Trough
<_n
r-o
                                                /
                                            Heater
Solvent
 Vapor
 Space
             Liquid
             Solvent
              Sump
                                               Freeboard
                          Figure IV-5.     Enclosed Conveyorized Vapor Degreaser
                          Source:   Arthur D.  Little,  Inc.

-------
residue will range from less than 5 percent to 40 percent by volume.  Contami-




nated cold cleaning solvents are usually recovered in the same way.




     Cold cleaning solvent losses are usually difficult to control since




the operation is often decentralized, individual stations are often small,




and a large part of the loss may be carried off on the work.  Vapor de-




greasers are sometimes referred to as a "controlled" method of solvent




cleaning.  Losses are localized and usually occur as diffusive or con-




vective vapor loss, dragout of condensed solvent on the work, and sludge



losses due to inadequate distillation or steam stripping.  Diffusive and




convective losses are estimated to be 0.125 to 1.0 Ibs/hr per square foot




of air-solvent interface depending on the method of operation.  Dragout




losses are impossible to quantify in a general way, but can be very large




if the operation is run incorrectly.  Still-bottom losses may represent up




to 20 percent of the losses from a well run open-top degreaser, and propor-




tionately more for an enclosed automated line.



     Metal degreasers have already come under heavy pre'ssure to control




emissions.  Their first challenge came from Los Angeles County's Rule 66




and similar legislation which attempted to control trichloroethylene




emissions since that compound had been implicated in smog formation.  The




industry is under growing pressure  from OSHA to reduce work area vapor con-




centrations due to increasingly stringent threshold limit value (TLV) assign-




ments.  As a result, many manufacturers have switched from trichloro-




ethylene to another chlorinated solvent, usually a chemically inhibited




form of 1,1,1-trichloroethane.  There is an understandable and well justi-




fied reluctance in industry to move to the flammable petroleum solvents,
                                      IV-53

-------
especially since these often come under the same environmental and health




safety regulations.  Metal degreasers have also reconsidered alkaline




aqueous washes as a substitute for solvent cleaning.  Historically, there




have been good reasons for using the relatively expensive chlorinated solvents,




such as quality of cleaning, metal compatibility, building space constraints,




ease of integration in the manufacturing process, overall cost, and water




pollution control regulations.  In some cases, the cost of solvent emission




control may change the relative cost advantage of solvent cleaning vis-a-vis




alkaline washing.  Mew chemical formulations have resulted in aqueous washes




more compatible with non-ferrous metals and less conducive to rusting or




corrosion.  Still, it is difficult to make general statements on the eco-




nomic viability of switching to aqueous washes especially given the rising




price of fuels for wash drying ovens, more stringent water pollution control,




and site-specific constraints such as available space.




     Fortunately, it appears that emissions from solvent degreasers, especially




vapor degreasers, can be significantly reduced with control techniques pres-




ently available at relatively low cost.  There are many vendors now selling




auxiliary refrigerated freeboard chillers which can reasonably be expected




to reduce present solvent losses by 40 percent at many locations.  Commercial




carbon adsorption units which have been economically viable only on large




systems have  also been readily sold which may eliminate  losses by 50 percent




or more.  Sales  impetus for  these control devices has  come both  from regula-




tory requirements and from  the economic  incentive of  recovering  valuable




solvent.  A third control device which could have significant  impact on  the
                                   IV-54

-------
most common type of degreaser—the simple open-top unit—is a cover which


must be down when work is not being done.  An alarm or servoactuator could


ensure its proper use and the cost would be relatively small.  If one


assumes a 15 square foot degreaser open for 3 hrs/day with no work being


processed, using such a cover would save over $800 per year in solvent

                                                       2
worth 15-l/2
-------
     The last important avenue of control is ensuring proper recovery and


disposal of contaminated solvent.  As previously mentioned, distillation


and steam stripping can recover most of the solvent from degreaser wastes.


However, such facilities are not always available or properly employed.  In


such cases, central reprocessing could be required.  For combinations of


soil and solvent where considerable solvent is unavoidably lost in the  liquid


wastes,  incineration  of  the  unrecovered  solvent would be a feasible  approach.


     Manufacturers of emission control equipment have related the costs of


control equipment to the cost of solvent loss as a selling point for -that


equipment.  On a representative 3' x 51 open-top degreaser solvent losses

                        2
may average 0.5 Ib/hr ft , or over a 2000 hr. work year, 15,000 Ibs/yr


worth'approximately $2325.  A new cover and alarm for this machine might cost


$250, and save $300/yr in solvent losses; since the cover usually comes with


the machine, perhaps $50 might be needed to install an adequate alarm.


Alternatively, a refrigerated freeboard chiller might cost $2000 initially,


$150/yr to run, and-may save $800/yr in solvent loss.  Operating separately,


an automatic carbon adsorption unit may cost $9000 initially, $400/yr to


runk and may save $1100/yr in solvent.  The basic cost of  the degreaser


alone is on the order of $4200.


     Although the numbers quoted above are for one specific case, the general


pattern of recovered solvent value recouping the cost of emission control


appears to apply to most degreasing applications.  Furthermore^ requiring


some method of control of diffusion losses (by proper initial design and/or


installation of emission control equipment), ensuring proper equipment opera-


tion, and careful disposal of waste sludges, may reduce solvent, emissions
                                   IV-56

-------
from degreasing operations in general by 40-60 percent.  A definitive study of




this problem is being conducted for EPA by a group at Dow Chemical.  The final




report should be available by the end of 1975 and will include both commercial




information and the results of carefully conducted emission tests which will




quantify the loss reductions that can be obtained with available technology.



     It should be emphasized that if methylchloroform (1,1,1-trichloroethane)  is




the only domestic halocarbon solvent that must be controlled, then there exists




a wide-variety of alternative halogenated solvents.  In many cases trichloro-




ethylene would be a perfectly acceptable substitute were it not for conflicting




smog-related air pollution regulations.  Perchloroethylene is another possible




substitute, although its higher boiling point may cause some material or oper-




ating problems.  Methylene chloride is another possibility, although it may be




too active a solvent for many applications.  For applications requiring selec-




tive solvency, lack of residue, lower temperatures, or otherwise able to justify




a higher-priced cleaning agent, there exists a variety of fluorocarbon based




solvents; the major one is F-113.
                                      IV-57

-------
     Drycleaning, - Drycleaning is the use of organic solvents to clean tex-




tile products of stubborn soils or clean textiles which would be damaged by




aqueous laundering or high drying temperatures.  The major solvents used do-




mestically are perchloroethylene and the petroleum drycleaning solvents:




Stoddard solvent and a solvent mixture known as 140-F.   Various chemical and




equipment vendors, industry associations, and researchers have estimated




that 40 percent to 70 percent of domestic drycleaning is done with perchloro-




ethylene; we estimate the fraction to be 65-70 percent  at present and his-




toric trends will enlarge that market share in the future.  Of minor impor-




tance domestically is Dupont's "Valclene" drycleaning solvent based on F-113.




Use of this solvent has been discussed in the previous  section on fluoro-




carbons.  European drycleaners use, in addition to the  solvents already men-




tioned, trichloroethylene and F-ll.  Trichloroethylene  tends to bleed dyes




from acetate fabrics and is therefore unpopular in this country.  Until




1928, gasoline was the major domestic drycleaning solvent; it was then su-




perseded by Stoddard solvent—a less flammable and odorfree petroleum based




solvent.  An awareness of the fire hazard of petroleum solvents led to the




development of less flammable 140-F and the adoption of chlorinated solvents-




initially carbon tetrachloride.  Carbon tetrachloride in turn has been re-




placed by less toxic perchloroethylene which is now used in 65-70 percent




of domestic drycleaning; the balance is still largely held by the less ex-




pensive petroleum solvents.  Local zoning restrictions  and safety codes




have and should continue the trend towards halogenated  solvents; we under-




stand that no petroleum solvent based equipment has been made in the last
                                     IV-5 8

-------
 several years  although some is  still being  sold  from  inventories.  Charac-




 teristics  of cleaning solvents  are given  in Table  IV-6.




      Approximately 70 percent of  the perchloroethylene used in drycleaning





is consumed by commercial establishments as opposed to industrial operations.




Commercial drycleaning equipment can be divided into three categories:




transfer type, dry-to-dry type,  and coin-operated.   The transfer type ma-




chine, with cleaning capacity typically between 20 and 120 pounds, is the




design most prevalent today.  Figure IV-6 illustrates schematically the op-




eration of such a unit.




     In a transfer machine, the clothes are washed in a recirculating sol-




vent stream; an in-line filter continuously removes, impurities from the sol-




vent.  After washing for a predetermined length of time,  the clothes are




spun dry—this process of centrifugally draining excess solvent from the




work is known in the trade as "extraction."  After extracting the bulk of




the solvent, the clothes are removed from the washer-extractor and stripped




of most of the remaining solvent in a hot air dryer.  Steam-heated air cir-




culates past the tumbling clothes, over a water-cooled condenser, and back




to the heater with some fraction bled to an exhaust.  Periodically the




filter must be replaced with a fresh cartridge or load of powder adsorbent.




To recover solvent from the wet filter powder (or "muck") most often gen-




erated by commercial drycleaners, the waste is steam heated and vaporized




solvent is collected by a water-cooled condenser.  Conscientious drycleaners




also distill a fraction of their solvent volume to remove soils not ad-




sorbed by their filters.
                                   IV-59

-------
                                               TABLE  IV-6   CHARACTERISTICS OF DRYCLEAKING SOLVENTS
Property
Flash Point (TCC), °F
Initial Boiling Point, °F
Dry End Point, °F
Specific Gravity, @ 60 °F
Density, Ib/gal
Aromatic Content, Vol. %
Corrosiveness
Heat of Vaporization, Btu/lb
Toxicity (TLV) ppm
Odor
Color
Vapor Density (Air=1.00)
140-F
138.2
357.8 -
396
0.789
6.57
12.1
None
•v,500b
200
Mild
Water White
1.0
140-F
R-66a
143
356
400
0.8063
6.604
7.0
None
•v-500b
200
Mild
Water white
1.0
Stoddard
100
305
350
*
0.779
6.49
11.6
None
•v,500b
200
Sweet
Water White
1.0
Stoddard
R-66*
108
316
356
a. 788
6.56
5.9
Hone
•vSOO6
200
Sweet
Water White
1.0
Pe rch 1 o roe thy 1 ene
non-flammable &
non-combustible
250
254
1.623
13.55
0
Slight on metal
90
100
Like ether
Water White
5.8
F-113
non-flammable &
non-combustible
117.6
not known
1.574
13.16
0
none
63
1000
Like CCL4
Water White
6.3
M
        8 This  refers  to the  "old"  Los Angeles  Rule 66  solvent  regulation, which  allowed up  to  8%  aromatic content.



        k This  value  can be expected to  vary  depending  as  it  does  on  the  exact  composition of the  solvent.



        Source:  Preliminary data from EPA report on drycleaning being prepared by.TBW, Inc.,  Environmental Services.

-------
                                                                                                      Air Vent
          Dirty
          Clothes
<
                                                          Air Vent
                                    Punp
Clean
Damp


Cloches
                                     Washer/Extractor
                                                                                                       Fresh
                                                                                                        Air
                                                                                                                            Dry
                                                                                                                            Clothes
                                          Figure IV-6    Transfer-Type Drycleaning  Syste

                          Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc.
                                                                                                        Dryer

-------
     In the "dry-to-dry" design washing,  extraction,  and drying all occur




in the same machine.  This design has the advantages  of eliminating .the




transfer of wet clothes, eliminating a labor consuming operation and pro-




viding an opportunity to diminish solvent losses.   In practice, many dry-




cleaners feel such a design reduces their throughput  and at peak periods




they often use the machine just for washing and transfer wet clothes to a ,




separate dryer.




     Solvent losses in  transfer-type drycleaning operations occur at six




points in the  system:   at the,washer-extractor, in transfer to .the dryer,




at the dryer,  as residual solvent in the clothes, in filter .wastes, and




still bottoms.  The amount lost at each point "varies widely'between in-




stallations.   Competent operation and maintenance of equipment is a big




factor in determining the solvent losses, or  the corollary "mileage" ob-





tained in use.  The results of' a 1975 survey  by the International  Fabricare




Institute have been summarized  in a  chart  (see Figure  IV-7) of production




efficiency or  mileage in  terms  of pounds of clothes cleaned per drum of  solvent,





     Solvent loss at the washer can  occur because of leaking equipment such




as deficient seals, or by convection losses incurred when  the  door  is open-




ed and the system is ventilated.  Losses at the dryer  can  occur for those




same reasons and also through pressure-equalizing vent  losses, insufficient




cooling of the condenser, and inefficient recovery of  hot  liquid solvent




(e.g., collection in open buckets).  Filter losses are increased by not




draining cartridge  type filters or—the more  common cause—by  inadequate




distillation of powdered  filter waste sludges.  National Institute  of Dry-
                                     IV-62

-------
                          70-1
                          •0-
                          SO-
                         r
f
B
                                       PETROLEUM
                                                      7O-
                                                      «,.
                                                      90-
                I
                                                      SO
                                                      so-
                                         n
                                                                          KNCMUMETHVLENE
                                                           i
                                                       n   n
n
                                    Figure IV- 7.  Solvent Mileage (in Ibs of Clothes Cleaned/55 gal. of Solvent)
         Source:  "Results of membership survey of drycleaning operations," I FT Special Reporter 3-1
                  Jan. -Feb. 1975,  Published by International Fab ri care  Institute.

-------
cleaning estimates of filter losses are given in Table IV-7.  The same prob-

lem of inadequate distillation causes solvent loss in still bottoms; however,

distillation is an infrequently practiced technique with most commercial dry-

cleaners so those losses are correspondingly small.

     The predominant method of solvent loss control (aside from regular main-

tenance of good operation) is the use of compact carbon adsorption systems.

These units ar.e typically sized to be steam stripped at the end of each

day, and, if well maintained, can be expected to pay for themselves within

three years in recovered solvent value.  The carbon adsorption unit is usually

connected with floor vents, and often the washer and dryer ventilation ducts

to recover as much of the free solvent vapors as possible.  The emission re-

ductions obtainable with these-systems are being quantified in a definitive

study of drycleaning emission being conducted by a group at TRW for the

EPA.  The final report of this study should be available by the end of the
                             -V "
year.                                                    .     .-,•••

     An interesting perspective on the possibilities for emission reduction

is provided by considering the use of F-113 in drycleaning.  This solvent

is far more expensive than perchloroethylene, and thus high loss rates can-
                                                                        o
not be economically tolerated.  As a result, solvent mileage in Valclene

(F-113) machines is typically 30,000 Ibs/drum versus 6,900 pounds per drum

for most percnloroethylene installations.  Valclene is very volatile so

losses from equipment could be very high unless good control systems were

provided.  These units are typically on total recycle of both solvent and

air.  Pressure equalization is often provided by elastomeric expansion cham-
                                       %
bers.  Solvent recovery in the dryer is enhanced by a refrigerated condenser.
a.
  Registered trademark for DuPont's formulation of F-113 dry cleaning fluid.
                                      IV-64

-------
             Table IV-7.   SOLVENT LOSSES IN PEBCHLOROETHYLENE PLANTS

                 (in pounds of pare per 1000 pounds of  cleaning)
Point of loss
Retained In filter muck:
(a) Rigid tube filter - no cooker
(b) Rigid tube filter - auck cooked
(c) Regenerative filter - wick cooked
. Retained in paper cartridges:
(a) Drained
(b) Dried in cabinet vented to adsorber
Retained in still residue
Plants without
vapor adsorber

125
45
20

18
—
16
Plants with
vapor adsorber

125
45
20

18
12
16
Source:  Martin, A.R. and Fred Loibl.  "Perc Vapor Emission - How to Estimate It",
         The NID Technical Bulletin, T-471.  May, 1971.   National Institute of
         Drycleaning.
                                      IV-65

-------
Carbon adsorption is normally provided.  If these same measures were applied

to perchloroethylene units, the solvent mileage should be as low or lower
                                                        i
than that obtained with Valclene due to perchloroethylene's lower volatility.

However, there is a penalty for such good control; Valclene units generally

cost 25 percent more than comparable perchlor'oethVlene machines equipped with

carbon adsorption units.    .•.->••

     The cost of solvent in proportion to the other costs of a typical commer-

cial drycleaner is only a small fraction of the total  (less than 10%).  How-

ever, a potentially significant cost may be fines imposed for not complying

with OSHA regulations on maximum allowable vapor concentrations,.

     A number of drycleaning plants now operating do-not>meet'these ILV

criteria; as these installations come  into Compliance, per unit solvent con-

sumption by the industry may decrease  since some measures that control ambient

vapor concentrations also reduce total solvent loss..
                     $                                             .
     The drycleaning industry will be'hard pressed  to  meet the demands of

OSHA and the EPA.  Operation of their 'equipment is4traditionally poor as

indicated by the average solvent mileage.  The industry is experiencing

hard times and is short of cash "for tlew investments, even for such remunera-

tive investments as: carbon adsorption units. 'Equipment sales to the indus-

try have plummeted in the last several years.  There is a glut'of 'old, used,

cheap equipment on the market.  Emission control will  be just one more bur-

den the industry will find hard to bear.

     In summation, it appears that with reasonable  care and attention, most

drycleaners can reduce their solvent losses by about 50 percent through

achieving the solvent mileage performance now reached  by only 10 percent of

the industry.  Emission rates could conceivably be  cut to 20 percent of their

present level if Valclene emission control'technology were adapted to
                                     IV-66

-------
 perchloroethylene units  at the expense of  higher  capital .and  operating  costs.




 In the event that one or both pf  these solvents had  to be  eliminated,




 Valclene could substitute for perchloroethylene in all applications and the




 reverse  substitution  could occur in all applications except where the aggres-




 sive solvency  of  perchloroethylene would forbid its use (e.g., in leather




 cleaning).   The petroleum solvents can achieve, the same cleaning results as




 either of these;  however, the associated fire hazard would be a serious im-




 pediment to  reversion  to the older technology—both because of existing




 fire regulations  and  industry experience.  These solvents also have other




 environmental  problems relating to photochemical smog formation.




 4.  Foam Blowing  Agents  - Halocarbons  are  used in  the manufacture of foams




 made from polyurethane,  polystyrene, and polyolefins.  They are primarily used




 as  the blowing agent which forms the cellular structure.  The use of halocar-




 bons as blowing agents in polyolefin foam  manufacture is quite small in com-




 parison  to their  use in polyurethane and polystyrene foams.  The most com-




monly used halocarbons are trichlorofluoromethane  (F-ll) which is the agent




 primarily used for polyurethane foam manufacture, and dichlorodifluoromethane




 (F-12) which is used for both polyurethane and polystyrene foams.  Methylene




 chloride is used  to a minor extent in.the  manufacture of flexible polyurethane




 fo%ams as a blowing agent but: it also finds use'as a cleaning solvent in the




manufacture of polyurethanes.




a.  Plastic Foam Types - The most important foam categories which use halo-




carbon blowing agents are rigid polyurethane, flexible polyurethane, extruded




polystyrene, and expanded polystyrene.                                 .




     The use of halocarbons in plastic foam manufacture is summarized in




Table IV-8.




     Rigid polyurethane foam - This is a major application for halocarbon
                                       IV-67

-------
                     Table IV-8.   DESCRIPTION OF USE  OF HALOCARBONS IN  PLASTIC FOAM MANUFACTURE
<
oo
Halocarbon
typically
used
F-ll»12,113,
114
F-ll
F-ll
Methylene
chloride
F-12, Methyl
chloride
F-ll, 12
F-114,12
Methyl chloride
fluorocarbon
Type of
plastic
foam
Low density
rigid poly-
urethane
High density
rigid poly-
urethane
Flexible
polyurethane
Extruded
polystyrene
EPS (expanded
polystyrene)
Poly olefin
Extruded poly-
styrene board
Type of
fabrication
process
Pour (bun process)
spray in place
frothing
Pour
Pour
Extrusion
Steam chest
molding
Extrusion
Extrusion
Location of
fabrication
process
Plant , on-site
Plant
Plant (slab
stock or
molded shapes)
Plant
Plant
Plant
Plant
Typical
product
application
Insulation
Furniture
parts
Cushioning,
bonded foam
fabrics
Food trays
Packaging,
insulation
Packaging,
insulation
Insulation
Alternative
blowing
agent
Water/CQ2
Water/C02
Water/CO
Pentane
Pentane
azodicarbami.de
aliphatic hydrocarbons
nitrogen
methylene chloride/
hydrocarbons
                 Also used as cleaning solvent in urethane foam operation
                Source:  Arthur D. Littlej Inc.,  estimates  based on trade publications and industry contacts.

-------
 blowing  agents.   F-ll is  the  blowing  agent most  frequently used.  The rigid




 polyurethane  foams  are used primarily f6r insulation.  Typical densities of




 these  foams are about 2 pounds per  cubic foot.   They are either fabricated




 in-plant (using the "bun" or  continuous slab process described below) or on-




 site using spray  techniques.




     Minor quantities of'rigid polyurethane foams are also made for special




 applications  by the frothing  process  which uses  F-12, F-113  (1,1,2-




 trichloro-l,2,2,-trifluoroethane) and F-114 (sym-dichlorotetrafluoroethane.




     Another  minor  application for  somewhat higher density rigid poly-




 urethane foams  (8 to 30 pounds per  cubic foot) is in the fabrication of




 furniture parts.  In this application, the halocarbon blowing agents are




 less frequently used than alternative blowing agent systems.




     For the  sake of clarity, we have included all these alternative




 fabrication methods in the rigid polyurethane foam category.  The major




 component in  this category (roughly 80%) are the 2 pounds per cubic foot




 insulation foams.




     Flexible polyurethane foam - The flexible polyurethane  foams are




 primarily used for  cushioning and carpet uriderlay applications.  The




 blowing  agent used  for  flexible polyurethane foam can be either of several




 fluorocarbons (although F-ll  is the most widely  used) or to  a minor ex-




 tent methylene chloride.  The halocarbon blowing agents are  primarily




used as  a supplement  to water/CO,, blowing agent  systems.




     Extruded polystyrene foams - Extruded polystyrene sheet, film and




board stock use halocarbon blowing  agents.  Extruded sheet products,




which represent the major portion of  this category, use F-12 as the prin-




ciple blowing agent.
                                      IV-

-------
     Hydrocarbon blowing agents, such as n-pentane, were traditionally




used for extruded foam sheet products.  Due primarily to fire hazards




associated with the manufacturing process, there has, since 1967, been




a shift toward the use of halocarbon blowing agents for the manufacture




of these products.  Rigid extruded board stock uses either methyl chloride




or fluorocarbon blowing agents.  Densities of these products are




typically in the 2-7 pounds per cubic foot range.  (Higher density ex-




truded foams are also made for wood substitutes but these typically use




solid rather than gaseous or liquid chemical blowing agents.)




     Extruded foam sheet is used primarily for disposable dinnerware and




packaging applications.  Rigid polystyrene board stock is used for pack-




aging and insulation applications.




     Expanded polystyrene foam - The term "expanded polystyrene" (EPS)




usually refers to a 1-4 pounds per cubic foot foam used for such products




as hot drink cups, flotation block, ice-chests, and packaging material.




It is made by a molding process (rather than by extrusion).  The major




blowing agent used for EPS foam manufacture is n-pentane or isopentane.



but F-ll is being used to an increasing extent.




     Polyolefins - Polyolefin foams include both polyethylene and poly--




propylene although polyethylene is much more frequently used.  The low




density polyethylene foams were first introduced by the Dow Chemical




Company in 1958.  They are used in considerably smaller quantities than




the polyurethanes and polystyrene foams because the processing methods




are somewhat more expensive.             .




     There are two broad categories of polyolefin foams. -The low density




foams (less than 10 pounds per cubic foot) are made by an extrusion pro-




cess and the products are sold as sheet, board, and profiles.  Both F-114
                                       IV-70

-------
and F-12 are used as blowing agents.  The high density polyolefin foams




do not use halocarbon blowing agents.




     Typical applications for the low density polyolefin foams are pack-




age cushioning, gasketing and sealing, marine buoyancy products, and




expansion joints in building construction.




b.  Processes for Foam Manufacture - Manufacturing processes for the four




major foam types are discussed below.




     Rigid and flexible polyurethane foams - Both rigid and flexible poly-




urethane foams are formed by mixing two or more reactive liquid ingredients




together.  The chemical reaction which results forms a polymeric structure.




The incorporation of a blowing agent (or gas evolved from the polymeriza-




tion) provides the cellular structure.  The ingredients are mixed in a




foam machine which consists of a pumping unit capable of accurately meter-




ing two or more components and a continuous mixer capable of blending and




efficiently mixing the various components.  Both the pumping and mixing




functions are critical to the proper manufacture of polyurethane foams.




The equipment used for mixing and dispensing both rigid and,flexible films




is quite, similar.  After dispensing from the metering unit, the physical




means used to contain the foaming mixture differs widely.




     Rigid polyurethane foams can be manufactured by a batch process, by




a continuous slab or "bun" process, by foaming or frothing in place, and




by spraying.   Of these methods, continuous slab production and foaming




in place are the most common.  Continuous production of rigid foam slab




stock (commonly used for insulation) involves pouring the liquid mixture




as a thin layer onto a continuously moving conveyor where it foams to




form a continuous block of foam.  After oven curing, the foam is sliced
                                     IV-71

-------
to specific thicknesses by a variety of mechanical methods.  Occasionally




facing materials used as surface skins are continuously applied to rigid




foams during fabrication by the continuous slab process.  Foaming in place




involves pouring the liquid mixture of foam components after mixing di-




rectly into a cavity (such as the walls of a refrigerator or building).




After chemical reaction, the foam expands to completely fill the cavity.




Occasionally a frothing procedure is used in foaming in-place applications.




In this procedure, a high pressure mixture is utilized and frothing occurs




as the blowing agent (typically F-113 or 114) contained in the foam mix-




ture vaporizes on emerging from the dispenser due to the reduction in




pressure.




     Sprayed polyurethane foams are often used for on-site application of




rigid polyurethane foams.  Here the liquid ingredients emerge from the




dispenser as a spray rather than a continuous stream.  Consequently the




losses of halocarbon blowing agent during foam formation are somewhat




higher than for the other rigid foaming methods.




     Flexible polyurethane foams are made by either a molding process  to




form such items as automotive safety pads, sun visors, and cushions, or




a continuous slab ("bun") process which resembles the continuous slab




process used for rigid foams.  Conveyors range from 50-100 feet in length.




After forming the slabs are cured with radiant heat or steam.




     The majority of flexible polyurethane foams are formulated so that




an open-celled structure results.  In some portion of the cases, they are




put through a wringer-like device to crush a portion of the cell walls in
                                IV-72

-------
and F-12 are used as blowing agents.  The high density polyolefin foams




do not use halocarbon blowing agents.




     Typical applications for the low density polyolefin foams are pack-




age cushioning, gasketing and sealing, marine buoyancy products, and




expansion joints in building construction,




b.  Processes for Foam Manufacture - Manufacturing processes for the four




major foam .types are discussed below.




     Rigid and flexible polyurethane foams - Both rigid and flexible poly-




urethane foams are formed by mixing two or more reactive liquid ingredients




together.  The chemical reaction which results forms a polymeric structure.




The incorporation of a blowing agent (or gas evolved from the polymeriza-




tion) provides the cellular structure.  The ingredients are mixed in a




foam machine which consists of a pumping unit capable of accurately meter-




ing two or more components and a continuous mixer capable of blending and




efficiently mixing the various components.  Both the pumping and mixing




functions are critical to the proper manufacture of polyurethane foams.




The equipment used for mixing and dispensing both rigid and.flexible films




is quite, similar.  After dispensing from the metering unit, the physical




means used to contain the foaming mixture differs widely.




     Rigid polyurethane foams can be manufactured by a batch process, by




a continuous slab or "bun" process, by foaming or frothing in place, and




by spraying.  Of these methods, continuous slab production and foaming




in place are the most common.  Continuous production of rigid foam slab




stock (commonly used for insulation) involves pouring the liquid mixture




as a thin layer onto a continuously moving conveyor where it foams to




form a continuous block of foam.  After oven curing, the foam is sliced
                                     IV-71

-------
to specific thicknesses by a variety of mechanical methods.  Occasionally




facing materials used as surface skins are continuously applied to rigid




foams during fabrication by the continuous slab process.  Foaming in place




involves 'pouring the liquid mixture of foam components after mixing di-




rectly into a cavity (such as the walls of a refrigerator or building).




After chemical reaction, the foam expands to completely fill the cavity.




Occasionally a frothing procedure is used in foaming in-place applications.




In this procedure, a high pressure mixture is utilized and frothing occurs




as the blowing agent (typically F-113 or 114) contained in the foam mix-




ture vaporizes on emerging from the dispenser due to the reduction in




pressure.




     Sprayed polyurethane foams are often used for on-site application of




rigid polyurethane foams.  Here the liquid ingredients emerge from the




dispenser as a spray rather than a continuous stream.  Consequently the




losses of halocarbon blowing agent during foam formation are somewhat




higher than for the other rigid foaming methods.




     Flexible polyurethane foams are made by either a molding process  to




form such items as automotive safety pads, sun visors, and cushions, or




a continuous slab ("bun") process which resembles the continuous slab




process used for rigid foams.  Conveyors range from 50-100 feet in length.




After forming the slabs are cured with radiant heat or steam.




     The majority of flexible polyurethane foams are formulated so that




an open-celled structure results.  In some portion of the cases, they are




put through a wringer-like device to crush a portion of the cell walls in
                                IV-72

-------
 order  to  form an  open  cell  structure which  enhances  "breathabillty" of



 the  foams for cushioning  applications.



     Carbon  dioxide, formed by  the  chemical reaction of water with the



 isocyanate component of the liquid  mixture,  is  the most commonly used



 blowing agent for flexible  polyurethane  foams.   Halocarbons are used



 alone  or  in  combination with  the water/CO-  blowing agent  system to pro-



 duce foams with more desirable  physical  properties (such  as lower density



 and  softer "feel").                             .



     Methylene chloride is  used to  some  extent  as a  blowing agent in



 flexible  foam fabrication.  It  is also widely used throughout the poly-



urethane foam industry  as  a  cleaning solvent for flushing  foam heads and
                                    • /


 for  general  equipment  cleanup.   It is also used as  a  thinner to reduce



 the  viscosity of  unreacted  urethane prepolymer  components and in opera-



 tions  which  bond  flexible polyurethane foams to fabric.   Its high vola-



 tility causes it  to be removed  from the  foam during  heat  curing.



     Extruded polystyrene - The raw materials for manufacture of extruded



 polystyrene  foams are  polystyrene pellets and blowing  agent.  The poly-



 styrene pellets are fed to  the  extruder  which consists essentially of a



 screw  in  a heated barrel.   The  extruder  melts and plasticizes the pellets



 into a molten mass.  The  blowing agent is introduced into a mixing zone



 along  the screw of the extruder.  A typical blowing  agent injection sys-



 tem  is shown in Figure IV-8.  The mixture of molten  polystyrene resin and



 dissolved gas is  then  passed  into a second  extruder  whose function is to



 reduce the temperature of the mixture and finally extrude it into the
                                  IV-7 3

-------
                                      BLOWING AGENT INJCCTION SYSTEM
    VAF'OR EQUALIZING LINE
    (FOR KILLING PURPOSES)
               BULK STORAGE
                  TANK
              FOH BLOWING AGENT
         V////7///////777////////Y///
     FILL LINE
                                                 PLUNGCR INJECTION
                                                 PUMP
Figure IV-8.
                 Schematic Diagram  of System Used for  Injecting
                 Blowing Agent into Extruder for  Production  of
                 Foamed Polystyrene Sheet
Source:  Plastics  Technology.  October, 1969,  P.. 46.
                           IV- 7 /i

-------
shape of a hollow tube into the atmosphere over a cone shaped expansion

die.  Cell formation is completed within the walls of this hollow tube.

The cooled tube is then slit to specific widths and taken up on large

diameter rolls which are stored for several days to permit air to diffuse

into the cells.  Most of the release of blowing agent occurs at the plant

site.

     To fabricate the most common products made from extruded polystyrene

foam, meat trays and egg cartons, the sheet is heated between two banks
                             ..    "* "     '    .   '      •'   '

of radiant heaters to a semi-molten state and then formed into the shape

of the final product in male or female molds using vacuum.   	

     Extruded polystyrene board was originally developed by the Dow

Chemical Company.  This product, known as Styrofoam® was introduced for

military applications during World War II and was used for commercial

insulation and floral foam applications thereafter.  Typical densities

are 1.7 pounds per cubic foot.

     Early patents3 describe the foam board extrusion equipment as a

holding vessel with a bottom port and a conveyor  with internal mixing to

prevent channeling.  The mixture is discharged into a tunnel through

which the foam expands and is shaped.

     Expandable polystyrene (EPS) -.Typical applications for EPS foams

are for insulation board for the construction industry, flotation block,

packaging dunnage, and thread spools.  The products typically have den-

sities ranging from 1-4 Ibs/cu.ft.
         , O.K. ( to Dow Chemical) U.S. Patent 2,450,436 (1948), and
 2,515,250 (1950).
                                 IV-75

-------
     These products are made from an EPS bead which has a density of




approximately 40 pcf and contains 5.5-7.5% of a volatile blowing agent.




Expansion is carried out by feeding beads to a pre-expander into which




controlled live steam is also fed.  The pre-expander is a simple insu-




lated cylindrical drum having an agitator to the vertical axis and a dis-




charge chute near the top.  It may range anywhere in size from 10^-200




gallons, depending on the article to be made.  Beads are also expanded




by a combination of heat and vacuum.  After pre-expansion, the beads are




conditioned by passing through an air conveyor to bins or bags where sur-




face moisture evaporates and the internal/external pressure differential




due to the blowing agent normalizes, the beads c'ool and harden, and are




then stored for between 24-36 hours.                                .




     In molding the beads to their final shape, they are charged to a




mold using either air or gravity and the mold is clamped shut.  Steam is




directly injected into the steam chest surrounding the beads and causes




them to expand, fill the interstices between the beads, and finally to




fuse or weld together.-  The mold is then coaled by spraying atomized




water or by exhausting using a vacuum pump or jet eductor.  Cycle times




vary between 6 seconds and 4 minutes, depending on the shape and wall




thickness. Six seconds might be a typical time for molded cups; thicker




parts used for insulating blacks, for example, might have cycle times of




up to 4 minutes.




     The blowing agent is incorporated into the beads either by a steep-




ing process or during the suspension polymerization process.
                                  IV-76

-------
     As indicated previously, pentane is the blowing agent most commonly




used but recently expandable beads containing F-ll have become commercially




available and are used to a minor extent.




     Polyolefins - The low density foams are primarily made by an extru-




sion process similar to that used for extruded polystyrene foams.  Plas-




tic pellets are fed to an extruder and the blowing agent (typically F-114




or F-12) is injected along a low pressure section of, the extruder screw.




The molten polymer and thoroughly dispersed blowing agent are then ex-




truded to the atmosphere via a die of appropriate shape.  Expansion (cell




formation) takes place and a cell,structure is formed.  Most of the blpw-




ing agent leaves the polymer during this step.




c.  Emissions to the Atmosphere - The quantity of halocarbon lost to the




atmosphere during manufacture, subsequent field use, and ultimate dis-




posal of plastic foams varies greatly.  Listed below are some of the



factors which must be considered:                4          .




     •  Type of foam and blowing agent,




     •  Open versus closed cell content,




     •  Solubility of halocarbon in the plastic,




     •  Density and cell structure of the foam,




     •  Surface area-to-volume ratio of the fabricated foam product,




     •  Losses during manufacture (highly dependent upon manufacturing




        process), and




     •  Rate of diffusion of specific halpcarbons through the plastic




        matrix, highly dependent on whether or not the foam is enclosed




        during field use.
                                    IV-7 7

-------
     •  Ultimate disposal method and lifetime of the fabricated foam




        product.




     Our estimate of halocarbon losses to the atmosphere from plastic



foams is shown in Table IV-9.  We have considered the factors listed above




and have relied on technical publications, industry contacts as well as




our in-house knowledge of the manufacture, field application and ultimate




disposal of plastic foams.




     The figures shown in Table IV-9 should be regarded as rough estimates.




Since it was necessary to include a variety of foam applications into




broad categories, product lifetime is highly variable and ultimate dis-




posal methods differ widely.  Our general method of estimating losses of




halocarbons to the atmosphere from plastic foams is described below.  The




column numbers refer to Table IV-9;




     •  In Column 1 we have listed the total quantity of foam used based




        on estimates of 1973 foam production.




     •  Column 2 lists our estimate of the percentage of that total foam




        quantity which uses halocarbons.  This percentage was applied to




        the total in order to derive the total weight of foam using halo-




        carbons shown in Column 3.




     •  Column 5 is an estimate of the total quantity of halocarbon used,




        based on the percentage of halocarbon commonly used in manufactur-




        ing foams, as shown in Column 4.




     •  In Column 6 we have estimated the percentage of halocarbon which




        is lost to the atmosphere during manufacture, field use, and ulti-




        mate disposal.
                                   IV-7 8

-------
                Table IV-9.    ESTIMATED U.S. USE OF HALOCARBONS IN  PLASTIC  FOAM MANUFACTURE  - 1973

                                                          (millions of  pounds)
                                        (i)
(2)
(3)
                                                                           (4)              (5)             (6)            (7,)
                                                                      Percent of halo-                  Est.  percent  Eat. quantity
             Halocarbons                  Est.percent  Weight of foam  carbon commonly   .                of halocarbon  of halocarbon
  Type of      primarily    Total quantity  using halo- using halocarbon  used in form-   Quantity of halo- lost  to the   lost to atmos-
plastic foam	used	of foam produced   carbons    blowing agent	ulation	carbon used	atmosphere3	phere
Rigid poly-
ur ethane
Flexible
polyurethane


Extruded
polystyrene
sheet-
Expanded
polystyrene
(EPS)
Extruded
polystyrene
board
Poly ole fin
Total
F-11,12
frothing
F-11,113
mixture
methylenc
chloride
F-12


F-12


Methyl
chloride
fluorocarbon
F-114,12

350

960



140


190


35


11
1686
85

55



50


5


100


65
-
300

530



70


10


35


7
952
15

7



7


6


10


16
-
44.8

35.4



4.9


0.5


3.5


1-1.
88
20

95



95


90


100


95
-
9.0

32.9



4.7


0.4


3.5


1.1
51
-J
         Although  almost all of these emissions occur immediately, figure given Is  for emissions within  ten years.

         Methylene chloride used both as blowing agent and as  solvent.

        Source:  Modern Plastics, January, 1975, and Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.

-------
      All of the halocarboh will eventually be lost to the atmosphere.   If


 the foam product is ultimately disposed of by incineration, the halo-


 carbons will be destroyed before leaving the incinerator. , In estimating


 the atmospheric losses shown in Column 6, we have arbitrarily set a 10-


 year time limit.  The estimated total quantity of halocarbon lost to the


 atmosphere within 10 years is shown in Column 7 and is based on multiply-


 ing the estimated percentage halocarbon loss (shown in Column 6) by the


 quantity of halocarbon used (shown in Column 5).


      In Table IV-10 we have prepared an estimate of specific halocarbon


 losses to the atmosphere (within a 10-year period) based on 1973 produc-


 tion figures.  Probably 90 percent of the losses occur during manufacture


 and the first year thereafter.


      Rigid polyurethane foams - It is important to the manufacture of


 rigid polyurethane foams to minimize losses of blowing agent since the


 presence of blowing agent in foam insulation is critical to maintaining


 the low heat transfer coefficient which is a major asset of the rigid


 polyurethane insulation foams.

                      a
      Detailed studies  have been carried out to predict the diffusion of


 halocarbon from rigid polyurethane foams,  and to predict the concentra-


tion of halocarbon remaining in the foam cells.  These studies have shown


 that the rate of diffusion of halocarbon out of the foam is smaller than


 the rate of diffusion of oxygen and nitrogen into the cells.   Other


 important factors affecting loss of halocarbons to the atmosphere are:


 ambient temperature during use; surface area to volume ratio of the foam
 a
  Cuddihy, E.F. and J. Moacanin, Cellular Plastics, pub. no. 1462., National

  Academy of Science  (1967).
                                   IV-80

-------
        Table IV-10.
ESTIMATED U.S. FLUOROCARBON AND CHLOROCARBON EMISSIONS FROM FOAM BLOWING
                        (based on 1973 production)
Type of
plastic foam
Rigid
polyurethane
Flexible
polyurethane
Extruded
polystyrene
sheet
Expanded
polystyrene
(EPS)
Extruded
polystyrene boan
Polyolefin
Total
Estimated total
quantity of halo-
carbon lost to
atmosphere within
10 years
(millions of pounds)
-9-5
32.9
4.6
0.5
3.5
1.1
52.1
Type of
halocarbon
typically
used
F-ll.
F-12,113,
114 - frothing
F-ll, 113
methylene
chloride
F-12
F-12
methyl chloride
fluorocarbon
F-114
F-12
-
Estimated
percentage
distribution
90
10
70
30
100
100
NA
60
40
-
Estimated
quantities
of halocarbon
lost to atmosphere
(million of pounds)
8.6
0.9
22.9
10.0
4.6
0.5
<3.5
0.7
0.4
52.1
<
CO
       Source:   Arthur  D.  Little,  Inc.,  estimates.

-------
 product;  and the extent to which the foam surfaces are exposed to  ambient

                    «a
 conditions.   Norton   has studied the fraction of FC-11 which remains in


 the cells of 1" thick slabs of a 2.2 pcf rigid polyurethane foam aged in


 air 25°C  with both surfaces exposed for time periods  from 50 days  to  20


 years.  There is,  of course,  a distribution of F-ll concentration  through


 the thickness of the foam.   Cells at the outer edges  lose F-ll very


 quickly,  but  after  20  years roughly  12  percent of  the original FC-11  still

 remains in the cells in the center of the foam.   In our estimate shown


 in Column 6  of Table IV-9,  we have assumed that  the combination of manu-


 facturing,  field use,  and disposal losses during the  initial 10-year  life


 of an average rigid polyurethane foam product are no  greater than  20  percent.


      Flexible polyurethane foams - We estimate that halocarbons are used


 in the  manufacture of  roughly 54.percent of all flexible foams.  (Roughly


50 percent of flexible slab foam production and 65 percent of flexible


molded foam production use halocarbon blowing agents.   The ratio of slab


to molded foam production is roughly 3/1.)


      Unlike  rigid  foams,  the  presence of open cells is critical to the


 applications  for which flexible polyurethanes are used (cushioning and


 carpet  underlay are examples).   This results in  rapid loss  of halocarbon


 from the  interior  of the  cells.   The major portion of halocarbon loss


 occurs  during manufacture or  shortly thereafter.   Furthermore,  the flex-


 ible polyurethane  foams are more exposed to ambient conditions during


 field use and on the average  probably have a shorter  product lifetime


 than typical  rigid  polyurethane foam products.   We estimate that 95
 aNorton,  F.J.,  Journal  of  Cellular  Plastics, January, 1967, P. 23.
                                    IV-8 2

-------
        of the halocarbon used to make flexible foams escapes to the




atmosphere within 10 years.




     Extruded polystyrene foams - Roughly 50 percent of extruded polystyrene




foam sheet production utilizes halocarbon blowing agents.  Roughly 85 percent




of the blowing agent is lost during manufacture and we estimate that another




10 percent is lost during field use.  Thus, essentially all (95 percent) of




this halocarbon is lost to the atmosphere within 10 years.  It is impor-




tant to note that there is an increasing trend toward the substitution of




halocarbon blowing agents for pentane which in the past was commonly used




for extruded foam sheet.  The percentage of all extruded polystyrene foam




which uses halocarbon blowing agents will probably increase over the next




several years.




     Expanded polystyrene - Only a small percentage of EPS foam currently




uses halocarbon blowing agents; however, we estimate that 90 percent of this




quantity is lost to the atmosphere within 10 years.




     Extruded polystyrene board -  Dow's Styrofoam is  the only domestic




extruded polystyrene foam board.  They consider the identification and




concentration of blowing agents to be proprietary information.  It is




known, however, that fluorocarbons are used as blowing agents in addition




to or in combination with methyl chloride.   The exact quantity and type



of fluorocarbon are not known.  We estimate that the weight of blowing




agent is less than 10 percent of the weight of Styrofoam production.
                                  IV-83

-------
d.  Alternatives to the Use of Halocarbons


     Rigid polyurethane foams - The presence of residual halocarbon within


the interior of the cells in rigid polyurethane foam results in a heat


transmission rate which is roughly one-half of that which would be experi-
                                  »,

enced if the cells were filled with air.  This fact is of primary impor-


tance in the use of halocarbon blowing agents for polyurethane manufacture.


These materials can be manufactured using the water/CO- blowing agent sys-


tem but the rigid polyurethane foams would then lose their economic ad-


vantage over other insulating systems.  We are not aware of any satis-


factory substitute for halocarbon blowing agents for rigid polyurethane


foams which will produce a foam of adequate structural and thermal pro-


perties.


     Flexible polyurethanes - The halocarbons are primarily used as auxil-


iary blowing agents in the formation of flexible polyurethane foams.  The


carbon dioxide which results from the interaction between water and the


isocyanate component of the active mixture is the primary blowing agent


in most commercially manufactured flexible foams.  The use of auxiliary


blowing agents allows foams with lower density and lower compression loads


to be made than those which are made using the water/CO~ system alone.


     Vacuum blowing has been proposed as a method for eliminating blowing


agents in flexible foam production.  It is also possible to utilize inert


gases as blowing agents.  Aroyl azides which decompose to give nitrogen


have also been investigated as well as acetic acid and combinations


of alcohols and strong acids.  Thus, there are a variety of agents which
                                   IV-84

-------
can be substituted for the halocarbons which are used as auxiliary -blow-




ing agents in flexible foam manufacture.  The use of these agents will




undoubtedly result in either an economical or technical compromise when




compared to the current halocarbons.




     Extruded polystyrene foams - As previously discussed, members of the




pentane family (n-pentane, isopentane or petroleum ether) have tradition-




ally been used as blowing agents for extruded polystyrene foams.  The




advantage of the pentanes is their low cost (roughly one-sixth that of




halocarbon blowing agents).  The major advantage of the halocarbon blowing




agents is their lack of flammability and the ability to produce foam of




somewhat lower density than the pentanes.  The lower cost of the pentane




blowing agents are offset by the necessity for higher capital investment




in order to provide explosion and fire protection.  Inert gases, such as




nitrogen and solid chemical blowing agents are also used to foam poly-




styrene but their use is restricted to the higher density (approximately




40 pcf) foams and these two types of blowing agents have not been found




practical for making low density (less than 10 pcf) extruded polystyrene




foams.




     EPS foams - Members of the pentane family (neopentane, isopentane,




and n-pentane) are most commonly used blowing agents in manufacturing




EPS foams.  Halocarbons are used to only a very slight extent.  Solid




chemical blowing agents which release gas upon decomposition as well




as carbonate esters that release carbon dioxide have been investigated




as alternative blowing agents.  The EPS foams compete with extruded poly-




styrene foam board for insulation and various other applications.
                                    IV-85

-------
     Polyolefin foams - Hydrocarbon blowing agents can be used as sub-

stitutes in the manufacture of low density polyolefin foams.  It is also

possible to make polyolefin foams by the leaching of soluble salts, re-

lease of hydrogen by bombardment w.it.h high energy electrons, solid chemi-

cal blowing agents and injected gases such as nitrogen or C0_.  However

these agents do not give lov? density foams.

e.  Opportunities for Recovery of Fluorocarbon Blowing Agents
    from the Manufacture of Polyurethane Foams

     Flexible polyurethane foams - Since the flexible polyurethane foams

are formulated to have an open celled structure, the majority (approximate-

ly 90 percent)  of fluorocarbon blowing agents are lost during the foam manu-

facturing step.  The foams are dispensed from the mixing head onto a belt

which moves through an enclosed tunnel.  After solidification of the cell

structure on the 40-foot conveyor, the foam bun is then sliced and sent

to storage.

     Of these four steps in the operation—pouring, foam formation on the

conveyor, cutting, and warehouse storage—the major source of fluorocarbon

loss is from the conveyor.  The bun may reach temperatures between 120-

160°C due to heat generated by the reaction of the components.  This re-

sults in volatilization of the fluorocarbon blowing agent.  We estimate

that 75 percent of the fluorocarbon is lost from this zone.  The second most

important source of fluorocarbon loss is at the cutting station.

     Because of the extreme toxicity of the toluene diisocyanate (TDI) used

in the foam formulation, most flexible polyurethane bun lines are extremely

well ventilated with hooding over critical areas such as the conveyor
                                   IV-86

-------
and cutting area.  Fumes are exhuasted via duct work and a centralized




roof fan.  Most plants currently discharge the mixture of TDI, C0_, and




fluorocarbon vapors to the atmosphere.  Since a sensitivity to even low




concentrations of TDI can be developed, the air flows in the vent systems




are probably quite high in order to minimize the concentration of TDI in




the exhaust.  These low concentrations, as well as the potential that TDI




has for the poisoning of carbon adsorption systems, represent two problems




that could arise in an attempt to recover fluorocarbons from flexible




polyurethane foam plants.




     Since the liquid mix is relatively cold during the dispensing step,




there are no significant losses of fluorocarbon from this stage of the




operation.




     Rigid foams - Rigid polyurethane foams differ from flexible foams in




that they are formulated to have a closed cell structure in order to re-




tain the maximum quantity of blowing agent for the longest possible time.




Only minimal quantities (probably less than 5 percent) of the total loss of




blowing agent occurs during the manufacturing operation.




     The rigid polyurethane foam slab is formed in an enclosed tunnel




similar to that used for pouring the flexible foams.  The loss of fluoro-




carbon blowing agent will be primarily from this area and will occur in




that portion of the tunnel prior to the solidification of the foam



structure.  The enclosed tunnel is vented by an arrangement similar to




that used for flexible foam manufacture and similarly could be used for




the recovery of f luorocarbon blowing agents.
                                   IV-87

-------
     A higher molecular weight polymeric form of TDI is used in fabricat-




ing rigid foams.  This component is less volatile than TDI itself; hence,




the concentrations of TDI in the vent system will be considerably lower




than for flexible foam manufacture and the ventilation systems which are




used are, therefore, less likely to have the very high flow rates utilized




in flexible foam venting systems.
                                  IV-88

-------
                     V.  CONVERSION TIMETABLES








A.  INTRODUCTION




     In the event of a restriction in the use or production of a chemical,




there is a finite response time before substitutes will be available




to satisfy the needs filled by the restricted chemical.   The magnitude of




economic disruption resulting from restrictions in the use of fluorocarbons




or chlorocarbons is critically dependent on the timing of the restrictions




and thus the response time available to chemical producers and substitute




product producers.




     General conversion timetables have been developed so as to define a




framework within which to consider timing as a variable in the regulatory




options.  The following summarizes those steps in a conversion process




which could potentially have a significant impact on the time required to




replace various chemicals under consideration and the products using them.




Conversion Steps Directly Related to Producing Substitute Chemicals




     •  Screen alternative chemicals and test utility in intended use.




     •  Develop process technology for alternative chemicals.




     •  Develop raw material supplies for producing the new chemical




        (e.g., new mines, new chemical and physical production facilities).




     •  Build new plants (or modify existing ones) for the production of




        the new chemicals.
                                  V-l

-------
Conversion Steps Related to Products Using a Substitute Chemical or
to a Substitute Product


     •  Test compatibility of the chemical with other materials and


        chemicals in intended uses.

                                  'f!"
     •  Test products in which the chemical is used for safety and


        medical acceptability.


     •  Develop new equipment capable of using the chemical for the


        intended use (e.g., refrigeration equipment).


     •  Test new equipment for safety and medical acceptability.


     •  Expand the production capacity of existing products not using


        the restricted chemical.


     In most cases, definitive predictions of the time required for ade-


quate supplies of a new or substitute product to be available cannot be


made.  Many of the steps listed above may not be necessary and many  can


be undertaken in parallel.  Any development project involves unpredictable


components ranging from unsatisfactory medical test results, to materials


and equipment shortages, to lack of consumer acceptance.  The probable


range of conversion times varies greatly depending on the specific product.


Substitute products are currently sold which are intended to satisfy the


demand for fluorocarbon aerosol, antiperspirant products.  However, there


could be serious problems producing sufficient quantities of some components


of the substitute products (such as valves for CO. aerosols) if a sudden


massive conversion were required.  In addition, the vast majority of


refrigeration equipment uses fluorocarbon products, and an extended period


would be required to bring on a new refrigerant and refrigeration system


with comparable safety and performance factors.
                                  V-2

-------
     Since the concern has arisen about the potential effects of fluoro-




carbon  and chlorocarbon emissions on the ozone layer, many of the firms




producing the chemicals and producing products using the chemicals have




been working to develop substitute chemicals and products.  In most cases,




the results of this work are not in the public domain and thus cannot be




explicitly incorporated in this analysis.  The conversion times from this




point would be less than if the planning and developments which have been




underway had not taken place.




     The major chemical producers and consumers (particularly aerosol




manufacturers) have regarded restrictions in chemical usage as a serious




possibility for the last six months to one year.  During this time, efforts




have been directed at identifying alternative chemicals and products which




do not use potentially restricted chemicals.  It is not reasonable to




assume that any significant efforts have been directed toward procuring




new production facilities for substitute chemicals, their raw materials




or products using substitute chemicals.  Such efforts would probably not




be undertaken until there is a clear regulatory mandate to do so.  The




discussion here of conversion times implies that a specified number of




steps can be undertaken over some period of time and that a "conversion"




will be possible.   However, one cannot guarantee that new chemicals or




products will be found with the desired properties or that they will be




commercially successful.




     The following discussion of conversion timetables is divided into the




major industry sectors identified earlier, moving from raw materials through




to the consumer products.  These individual sector discussions are followed




by a synopsis showing total system conversion timetables  and phasing.






                                   V-3

-------
B.  SECTOR TIMETABLES




1.  Raw Materials




     If the production of chlorocarbons and fluorocarbons is banned or cer-




tain uses banned, two alternative substitution sequences can occur.  Either




a different chemical can be used in.major current uses or different pro-




ducts can be produced which.do not use a substitute chemical.  For example,




a new propellant could be produced for use in aerosols or a non-aerosol




product  such as a mechanical pump could be used in place of the aerosol.




     Under the assumption that a new chemical or new chemicals are produced,




the time required for developing adequate raw material supplies can be an




important component on the total conversion time.  Similar development




times can be necessary for producing alternative products, as is discussed




later.  While the distinction between "Basic Chemicals" and "Raw Materials"




is not sharp, these terms are used here to distinguish between the fluoro-




carbons/chlorocarbons and the chemicals and other products used to produce




them.  The raw materials may be chemicals produced by the same firms




which are  producing the fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons.




     With the exception of some interchangeability among the halocarbons




themselves, viable substitute chemicals have hot been publicly identified.




It is not possible, therefore, to identify their raw material requirements.




As a model, one can consider that all of the chlorocarbons considered by




this study consume about 46 percent of total U.S. chlorine production




(30 percent excluding vinyl chloride).  The fluorocarbons consume about




42 percent of hydrofluoric acid (HF)  production.  It is possible that a




substitute chemical would use these same raw materials.  However, if dif-




ferent raw materials are required, the new demand for the materials could




require a substantial increase in their production capacity.






                                  V-4

-------
     Bringing a high-volume source of raw materials on line can be a time-

consuming process.  Among the elements which may be required are identifying

material sources, designing and building processing facilities, and securing

adequate energy, transportation, and labor supplies.

     Chemical industry sources have estimated that three to five years would

be required to develop raw material sources and processing plants.  If high

volume production of the material is already underway, incremental changes

in production capacity would be less.  About two years would be required

for additional processing facilities at existing plants if necessary.   The

time required to increase utilization of existing production capacity is

negligible relative to the other alternatives.  Table V-l summarizes the

time requirements.

     The time requirements for raw materials supplies are particularly

critical since the major investment required to build the facility will

not be made until after there is a firm decision to produce the new

chemical.  This decision can only come after the chemical product develop-

ment and testing phases have been substantially completed.


                Table V-l.  NEW RAW MATERIAL SUPPLY TIMES
Design and construct new plant

Add capacity to existing plant
Usage of existing production capacity
  3 to 5 years

  2 years
Less than 6 months
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates based on chemical industry
         sources.
                                   V-5

-------
2.  Basic Chemicals




     The times required for bringing production facilities on line for a




new substitute chemical are similar to those described above for the raw




materials.  However, in addition to the time required to design and build




(or modify) the production facilities, sufficient time must also be




allowed for testing whether the chemical performs as projected, for testing




its compatibility with other materials and chemicals, and for testing its




safety and toxicity characteristics.  Concern for environmental impacts,




such as on the ozone layer and on  photochemical oxidant levels, can cause




additional delays.  Since most fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons are consumed




in other final products, the viability of these final products using the




new chemical must be well established" before significant commitments can




be made to the chemical production facilities.




     If a ban is placed on the production or specified uses.of fluorocar-




bons or chlorocarbons, substitute chemicals may or may not have their




process technologies well established.  After a screening of alternatives




and initial testing phase, the development of the manufacturing technology




would typically proceed a period of time before the beginning of the testing




for health and safety effects.




     During interviews with chemical manufacturers, the approximate




elapsed times listed in Table V-2 were developed.
                                   V-6

-------
         Table  V-2.   DEVELOPMENT TIMES FOR SUBSTITUTE CHEMICALS
                Product Development

 Screen alternative chemicals & test utility in
   intended use .

 Develop new  chemical manufacturing technology

 Test chemical for environmental, health, and safety
   effects

              Facilities Development Alternatives

 Build new chemical plant

 Modify existing chemical plant

 Add capacity to existing chemical plant

 Increase use of existing production capacity
   1 year


   2-3 years

   1-2 years
   3-5 years

   2 years

   2 years

Less than 6 months
 Source:  Arthur D. Little,  Inc., estimates based on chemical industry
         sources.


 3.   Chemical  Intermediate Applications

     As with Raw Materials,  the distinction between "Chemical Intermediate

Applications" and the Basic Chemicals is not sharp in the usual usage of

the terms.   Chemical Intermediate Applications are defined in this report
                         :     • ••       '   i   '  ' .    ' •     ' '  •
to include those uses of the fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons in which they

are intermediates or raw materials in a process to produce a final product

chemical or plastic.  The principal products for which the fluorocarbons

and chlorocarbons are intermediates are fluorocarbon resins (i.e., Teflon

made from fluorocarbon 22) and tetraethyl lead, tetramethyl lead, silicones,
   » -    .   •               '                                  •
vinylidene chloride, and vinyl chloride made from the chlorocarbons.
                                   V-7

-------
     The effect of a ban on the production of the fluorocarbons and



chlorocarbons would be to end the availability of an important raw




material for these high volume chemicals and some smaller volume pro-




ducts.  In some cases, alternative' manufacturing technologies may be




available not using the banned chemical.  There is another process for




making vinylidene chloride monomer which does not use methyl chloro-




form.  However, such alternatives may not be available in other cases.




      As an additional complication, there is no reason to necessarily




believe that once a fluorocarbon or chlorocarbon is no longer available,




a substitute chemical for use as a propellant or refrigerant will be a




satisfactory raw material for the current or reformulated plastic products




formerly using the fluorocarbon or chlorocarbon.  With methyl chloride, for




example, no longer available, the manufacturers of silicones would have to




consider alternative products for satisfying the d»emand for silicone pro-



ducts and alternative proc.ess technology/raw materials combinations for



making the new product.



      The dimensions of these secondary effects of a ban on fluorocarbon




and chlorocarbon production have not been explicitly defined.  However,




the conversion times involved are identical to those described above for




the fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons themselves.  The economic impact may




be greater on the producers of the products using fluorocarbons and




chlorocarbons as intermediates than on the fluorocarbon and chlorocarbon




producers.  As is described in Chapter VI, some producers of tetraethyl




lead and the other products are smaller firms for whom these-products




represent a significant portion of their business.  Smaller producers




will often have a more difficult time undertaking sudden, major plant




changes.





                                  V-8

-------
      It is difficult to estimate what, if any, effect the involvement

 of smaller firms would have on industry conversion times as opposed to

 ending the participation of some firms in the markets.  Table  V-3

 shows the estimated conversion times for the final product producers

 using the fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons as intermediate chemicals.

 The times are identical to those for the conversion of the chlorocarbon

 and fluorocarbon plants to substitute chemicals because the changes

 involve building new or modifying high volume chemical manufacturing

 plants.
          Table  V-3.   DEVELOPMENT TIMES FOR PRODUCTION FACILITIES
                       FOR INTERMEDIATE CHEMICAL APPLICATIONS
             Product Development Steps

Screen alternative chemicals and test utility in
  intended uses

Develop new chemical manufacturing technology

Test chemical for environmental, health, and safety
  effects

          Facilities Development Alternatives

Build new chemical plant

Modify existing chemical plant

Add capacity to existing chemical plant

Increase use of existing production capacity
    1 year


    2-3 years

    1-2 years
    3-5 years

    2 years

    2 years

Less than 6 months
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates based on chemical industry
         sources.
                                    V-9

-------
      The economic  Impact  assessment  developed in Chapter  VII  considers


 restrictions  in  the  use of  carbon  tetrachloride  which  is  used as an


 intermediate  for making F-ll  and F-12 and  also considers  F-22 used as


 an intermediate  for  fluorocarbqn polymer.  The intermediate applications
                                 !«.

 of other fluorocarbons and  chlorocarbons are  not considered.  As a



 general  rule,  the  firms using chlorocarbons and  fluorocarbons as inter-


 mediates would have  considerable difficulty responding to a ban in the


 chemicals, :as the conversion times  show.  However, the  results of the



 economic impact  assessment  mask this somewhat because, of the chemicals


 considered, only F-22 is  used as an  intermediate for products which     ?


 would not also be  banned.





4.  Propellant Applications



      Approximately 50 percent by weight of U.S..  fluorocarbon  production


 is used  as  a  propellant in aerosol products.   The majority of propellant


 usage of fluorocarbons is in hair sprays and antiperspirants/deodorants.


 If there is a ban  on the  production  of fluorocarbons,  the producers of


 aerosol  products are faced with three options:  use a  non-aerosol pro-


 duct  in  the present  aerosol market;  use a  compressed gas  type propellant;



 or use a substitute  liquified gas  propellant  if  available.




      The first option is  the  most  readily  available.   Products  are  cur-


 rently sold which  are intended to  satisfy  the personal product   aerosol


 applications  of  the  fluorocarbons..  Due  to a  combination  of  factors,  but


 principally consumer preference,  the aerosol  products  have  taken over a
                                   V-10

-------
major market share of  the personal products.  This is in spite of the aerosol



product typically being more expensive on a unit of application basis.




While substitute products are  currently available, the consumer has per-




ceived  a difference between  the products and shown a preference in many




cases for  aerosol products.




     The marketers of  the aerosol personal products are in the business




of  supplying the personal products market.  Many of the firms now mar-




ket the non-aerosol alternatives to  the products using the fluorocarbons.




Thus, the  option does  exist  for the  marketers to sell the current sub-




stitute products into  the aerosol market.  These substitutes could




include pump sprays, roll-ons, stick applicators, etc.  The hair spray




market  has declined  slightly over  the past  several years because of



changing  hair  styles and the desire  for different hair feel.






     The time required to increase production of the current substitute




products would probably be less than one year.   A very large increase




would be required in current production.  The current  production capa-



city of the glass and plastic bottle manufacturers is  substantially




larger than the unit production of fluorocarbons/aerosols:   glass,




39.5 billion units; and plastic,  7.4 billion units.   There were about




1.5 billion fluorocarbon/aerosol units sold in 1973.' The procurement



and installation of special  tooling  and processing equipment could be




stretched  over a period  longer than  a year if a massive conversion to




non-aerosol products is  required.
                                 V-ll

-------
     Thus, while it is probably physically possible to be producing large



quantities of non-aerosol personal products at the end of one year, it is




unlikely that such a massive production shift could or would be undertaken




in such a short time frame.  In• the..-event the marketers put a complete




reliance on the existing non-aerosol products, there would be a large




risk associated with placing orders for the'product or usage equivalent




of 1.5 billion units without knowing the level of total personal product




sales in the absence of the aerosols.  Under a scenario of total reliance




on existing non-aerosol products, the actual transition time to an




approximate balance of supply and demand would be in the one to three yeaS:




range.




     The two other options open to the aerosol marketer involve using a




new aerosol propellant.  Because fluorocarbons are relatively expensive,




an interest has existed for a number of years in developing ah alternative




propellant system.  These various alternatives, such as compressed C0»,




have been discussed in Chapter IV.  The marketer can begin using




one of the compressed gas systems or a substitute liquified gas propellant.




The technology for compressed gas aerosols exists, but testing of  the




acceptance of their different performance characteristics by consumers




is only beginning.  Hydrocarbon or C02 propellants used with methylene




chloride as a vapor depressant are now used  in at least one aerosol




product as a liquified gas propellant system.  However, the propellant




has not had wide acceptance by aerosol manufacturers.  A major development




effort may be required to produce a widely accepted liquified gas




propellant.
                                   V-12

-------
     A ban of fluorocarbon production in the near future would force




the marketers first to expand the production of their non-aerosol pro-




ducts and in parallel begin developing compressed gas aerosol products.




If alternative liquified gas propellants become available, the aerosol




products can be reformulated.



     Both the compressed and  liquified  gas  aerosol  products  would  be  new




products requiring a cycle of product designs, testing, manufacturing




facility design, equipment procurement, and facilities testing before




large-scale production.  Figure V-l   was prepared by a major aerosol




producer as a generalized flow diagram of a new product Introduction




schedule.  According to the producer's estimates, 18 to 48 months are




required to move from new product conception to the beginning of pro-




duction.  This schedule assumes that the various design and testing




steps (including health and safety) are generally successful.  While




some time reductions probably could be achieved during a crash program,




the chance for having to repeat steps and stretching the schedule also




exists.




     As an example of the conversion schedule for introducing the



compressed gas products after a fluorocarbon ban, one can use the values




in Figure  V-l.  A similar schedule could not begin for products with a




new liquified gas propellant until the chemical was identified and its




availability assured.  The product introduction schedule would then
                                 V-13

-------
                                                                                                                                                     Total 1B-40 iroa.
                                                                                                                                                     (Plus Production and
                                                                                                                                                     Distribution Time)
M
**
                                                                                                                                            Establish final
                                                                                                                                            Manufacturing
                                                                                                                                            ?i-ocec!ure*
                                                                                                                                            prodcct/rroceas
                                                                                                                                            Specifications
Koteai
  1.  Failure at any step may result
     in abandonment of the program•
     cr return to an earlier step.

  2.  Times indicated lead to  the
     beginning of production.
     Added production capacity to
     satisfy ncads for national
     distribution could add a year
     or core to the time schedule.
                                      Figure  V-l.   Flow Diagram of Aerosol  Product  Introduction Schedule
                    Source:   Industry  estimates.

-------
move in parallel with the final stages of bringing the chemical manu-

facturing plant on line.

     Table V-4 summarizes propellant application conversion times

The earliest that adequate non-aerosol products would be available after

a ban is one year.  The introduction of compressed gas products could

begin in a year or somewhat later.  The introduction of aerosols using

liquified gas propellants would be dependent on the further development

of alternative chemicals whose time of availability is uncertain.
         Table V-4.   TIME REQUIRED FOR INTRODUCING PRODUCTS
                      TO PERSONAL CARE MARKET
Expand production of existing non-aerosol products

Introduce compressed gas aerosol products

Introduce liquified gas aerosol products
1-3 years

1-3 years

2-4 years after
  new propellant
  identified
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates based on aerosol product
         industry sources.
                                 V-15

-------
 5.  Refrigerant Applications



     The refrigeration and air conditioning uses of fluorocarbons present




 a particularly difficult conversion problem.  The refrigerant is a small




 part of the cost of a refrigeratortbut there are not significant near-




 term opportunities for using another refrigerant.  Since there appears




 to be a high potential for recovering a major portion of the fluorocarbons




 now lost to the atmosphere in refrigeration applications, special con-




 sideration has been given to emmission reduction as a regulatory alterna-




 tive.




     The  refrigeration industry can be characterized as a high volume




 manufacturing operation using a technology which has gradually evolved




 over a number of years.  The products must have high reliability with




 very low health and safety risk.  Any product changes come slowly and




 require a significant capital investment by the manufacturer.  Other chemical




 refrigerants exist and have been used, such as ammbnia and sulfur dioxide.




 However, they have been abandoned for almost all applications because of toxi-




 city or other safety factors. Complicating the regulatory problem if a




 substitute refrigerant were available are the millions of refrigeration




 and air conditioning units currently in service which can only operate on




 the fluorocarbon refrigerant.  These units need periodic recharging and




 would eventually cease functioning if fluorocarbon refrigerants were not




 available.




     Two basic timetables have been considered.  The first involves up-




 grading the existing designs and servicing techniques to reduce refrige-




rant losses to the atmosphere.   The second is an order of magnitude
                                  V-16

-------
estimate of the conversion time in the event of a total ban of fluoro-




carbon production.




     Table V-5 summarizes the refrigerant uses in the five principal pro-




duct categories and the current availability of non-fluorocarbon




refrigeration systems.  One possibility is that fluorocarbon 12 (F-12)




will be banned but not fluorocarbon 22 (F-22).  The refrigeration and




air conditioning equipment now using F-12 cannot use F-22.  For most air




conditioning applications, products now exist using F-22, but F-22 is not




being used for refrigeration applications, nor do successful designs for




its use exist.  The conversion of refrigeration products to F-22 would




require overcoming some major design problems which have been considered




by producers in the past but not solved.  In product categories now par-




tially using F-22, those producers whose products use F-22 would benefit




substantially from an Immediate ban on F-12.  It is not likely that their




production capacity could satisfy the total demand within a year.  Within




about three years, production of existing products using F-22 could be




expanded to meet demand.  During this time, the production capacity of




F-22 may also have to be expanded.




     If F-12 and F-22 are both banned, the refrigeration and air conditioner



manufacturers may be  forced to switch to absorption systems, whose




designs are in some cases now available.  Hydrocarbon-based systems using




pentane and butane have been used in the past but would not likely be used




again because of their explosion danger. Development of a new, safe re-



frigerant for use in current vapor compression systems would be the option




favored by most manufacturers.  However, an alternative with properties




similar to F-12 and F-22 is not now generally available.






                                  V-17

-------
                 Table V-5.  AVAILABILITY OF NON-FLUOROCARBON REFRIGERATION AND AIR CONDITIONING PRODUCTS
Product category
Appliances
Mobile air conditioners
ROOD) (home) air conditioners
Commercial refrigeration
Commercial Air Conditioning
(chillers)
Reciprocating
Centrifugal
Current
refrigerant
F-12
F-12
F-22
F-12 and F-502

F-12 & F-22
F-ll, F-12, & F-22
Non-fluorocarbon
technology
now available
Yes
No
Yes
Yes

Yes
Yes
Non-fluorocarbon
designs
now available
Yes
No
No
No

Yes
Yes
Non-fluorocarbon
products
now available
Yes (limited)
No
No
No

Yes (small)
Yes
M
oo
      The non-fluorocarbon products for which there -are now designs use an absorption technology.  Hydrocarbon

      refrigeration technologies exist but are not viable 1th most applications for safety reasons.
     Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., based on refrigeration industry sources.

-------
     Absorption systems are currently sold for use in the commercial




chillers (mostly commercial air conditioning systems).  A ban of fluorp-




carbons would require expanding production of these products.  The tran-




sition time would be approximately two to threfe years.




     For appliances and home air conditioners, products are' not now being




sold using the absorption technology.  Natural gas companies promoted




these applications of the technology for a number of years because they




were promoting natural gas as an energy source.  While the products were




not commercially successful, the specific product designs were developed.




They would have to be modified to use different heat sources, for example,




but the basic design work has been substantially completed.  The time




required to modify the designs and procure and set up new manufacturing




facilities is estimated to be three to five years.




     Designs do not apparently exist for mobile air conditioners, and




there appear to be major design problems in adapting the absorption tech-




nology to mobile units.  While it may be possible to design an absorption




system for use in a car, it would be very difficult and there is no




assurance of success.




     The schedule for bringing products to the market using a new refri-




gerant could be substantially longer than that required for conversion to




absorption systems.  In addition to the time required to develop the re-




frigerant itself, an extensive design, testing, and manufacturing




facilities development period would be required.  The performance charac-




teristics of the new refrigerant could be substantially different than




those of F-12 or F-22 and require a basic redesign of the refrigeration




and air conditioning systems.  Without knowing the specifications of the
                                  V-19

-------
refrigerant, the magnitude of this design effort cannot be known.  However,




in discussions with refrigeration industry sources, an estimate was




developed of five to seven years from the time a new design program begins




to the beginning of production.  The schedule would include a three to




five year design and test phase followed by a two year period of further




field tests and the procurement of manufacturing equipment.




     One regulatory option is the requirement or encouragement of




 significant reductions  in the  loss  of  the  fluorocarbon  refrigerant  to




 the  atmosphere.  The loss reduction opportunities  occur in both the up-




 grading  of  current  system designs and  improved  equipment servicing




 techniques.   Equipment  improvements could  include  substituting flexible




 metal hoses in mobile air conditioners and the  use of self-sealing  con-




 nectors  and precharged  components.  The servicing  improvements could




 include  the recapture of  the refrigerant instead of venting  it during




 servicing.   The  time required  for such upgrading and  service changes is




 in the two  to  three year  range.




     Table  V-6  summarizes the transition  times of the  refrigeration




 application alternatives.
                                  V-20

-------
                             Table V-6.  TRANSITION TIMES OF REFRIGERANT APPLICATIONS
Product categories
Appliances
Mobile air conditioners
Room (home) air conditioners
i
Commercial refrigeration
Commercial air conditioners
(chillers)
Rec iprocating
Centrifugal
Upgrade
current
products
2-3 years
3-4 years
2-3 years
2-3 years

2-3 years
2-3 years
Convert
from
F-12 to F-22
3-4 years
indefinite
zero time
3-4 years

2-3 years
1-3 years
Convert from
f luorocarbon
to absorption
4-6 years
indefinite
3-5 years
4-6 years

3-5 years
2-3 years
Convert to
a
new refrigerant
3-5 years
3-5 years
3-5 years
3-5 years

3-5 years
3-5 years
f
IS)
       Conversion time after new refrigerant is identified and assuming it is available in sufficient quantities.




      Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates based on refrigeration industry sources.

-------
 6.   Blowing Agent Applications




     Fluorocarbons 11 and 12 are used to produce the bubbles in foam




plastic products, such as furniture padding and insulation.  The plastic




material and the fluorocarbon are mixed in a cooled liquid state and then




heated.  The fluorocarbon vaporizes, producing the bubbles.




     Other products have been used as blowing agents prior to the use of




fluorocarbons.  However, they have generally been flammable, whereas the




fluorocarbons are not.




     The two strategies for ending or reducing the fluorocarbon emissions




from blowing agent applications involve switching to an alternative blowing




agent or installing vapor recovery systems.  If the fluorocarbons are no




longer available, alternative blowing agents or products would be available




within one to two years in the major foam markets.




     The rigid polyurethane, insulating foams heavily depend on the insu-




lating properties of the fluorocarbons and may not remain competitive with




other insulating materials without the fluorocarbon blowing agent.  While




conversion to another blowing agent may be possible in about two years,




requiring some redesign of the products using the foams, there is a like-




lihood that the product would no longer be competitive with other insulating




foams.




     In the case of the flexible foams, the fluorocarbons are primarily used




as auxiliary blowing agents.  In order to approximate the product charac-




teristics now achieved in lower density foams, producers are expected to




convert to methylene chloride for a blowing agent if the fluordcarbons are




not available and even perhaps if vapor recovery requirements are imposed.
                                   V-22

-------
Table V-7 summarizes the blowing agent conversion timetables.






      Table V-7.  CONVERSION TIMES FOR BLOWING AGENT APPLICATIONS
Develop and install vapor recovery equipment




Substitute blowing agent in rigid foam applications




Substitute blowing agent in flexible foam applications
2-3 years




3 years
6 months
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates based on industry sources.








     in the manufacture of flexible polyurethane foams, the various




vapors emitted in the production process are collected and vented to the




atmosphere because they are toxic.   To recapture the fluorocarbon por-




tion of the vapors, one would want to use a carbon adsorption system.




However, isocyanate, which is also in the vapor stream, will poison the




system.  While in principle it may be possible to get around this problem,




adequate fluorocarbon recovery equipment for use with the flexible foams




does not now exist.  A two to three year development and installation



period may be required.  For these reasons, the producers seem likely to




convert to methylene chloride as a blowing agent rather than install the




vapor recovery equipment.




     The vapors from the manufacture of rigid polystyrene foams are not




collected.  If collection systems are installed, the recapture of fluoro-




carbon emissions during production by carbon adsorption may be less tech-




nically difficult than in the case of the flexible foams because of the




absence of poisoning agents in the vapor.  One should, however, regard a
                                   V-23

-------
two to three, year development and installation period UK also being repre-




sentative of the response time for rigid foam manufacturers to requirements




for reducing f luorocarbon emissions.
7.
     Fluorocarbons and chlorocarhons are used  in a wide variety of solvent




applications.  These uses include high quality clean ing of electronic.




components, dry cleaning, and  general  decreasing in metal working.  Wlu'le




there are. selected industries: which primarily  perform a cleaning  func.t i.on ,




these activities do not adequately characterize the  solvent applicat ions




of  f Luorocarbons and chlorocarbons.  The availability of solvents is critical




 to  a variety  of sectors such  as  printed  circuit manufacturers,  textile




manufacturers, and the  Defense  Department.




     The advantages and disadvantages of using various solvents were dis-




cussed in detail earlier.   .Since there  is  a  significant opportunity  for




reducing losses to the atmosphere, this  vapor  recovery option has been




added to conversion options.




     While the products have considerable performance differences, there  is




substantial cross-over, usage among the solvents and  the different applica-




tions.  The major solvent used in dry cleaning in the U.S. for  example is




perchloroethylene.  Limited quantities of DuPont's "Valclene"  (F-113)




are also used.  European dry cleaners also  use trichloroethylene  and F-ll.




The impact on solvent applications will  depend on which chemicals are  con-




trolled.  The  regulatory  alternatives discussed  in Chapter VII include methyl




chloroform but not the other principal solvents used in the U.S.
                                   V-24

-------
     If some of the fluorocarbon and chlorocarbon solvents are banned, the




first option for the users would be alternative fluorocarbon or chloro-




carbon solvents.  If all of the fluorocarbon and chlorocarbon production




is ended, substitutes such as water-based or hydrocarbon-based solvents




would be used.  This is not to say that their performance is equivalent




to the chlorocarbon/fluorocarbon solvents.  In general, the substitute




solvents and the technology for using them are available.  The conversion




time for movement to the substitutes is in the one to two year range for




many applications.




     By suggesting the potential for substitute solvents, one must allow




for the possibility of Very specialized uses of the chlorocarbons or fluoro-




carbons which are not readily satisfied by alternative solvents.  Tech-




niques or technologies such as associated with micro-circuitry may have




developed based on the availability of the solvents.  The implications of




an end to the availability of the solvents in all their applications have




not been determined.




     Of the five chemicals considered in the economic impact assessment




of Chapter VII, only methyl chloroform has major solvent uses.  Many users




of methyl chloroform as a solvent could switch to F-113, though it also




may ultimately be included in fluorocarbon use restrictions.  Trichloro-




ethylene has only limited potential as an alternative because of its




impacts on  photochemical oxidant levels in urban areas.  Some special




applications, such as printed circuit boards, may be dependent on the




properties of methyl chloroform and could not easily substitute another




solvent.  In general, solvent users will be able to move to substitutes
                                  V-25

-------
for methyl chloroform such as F-113, perchloroethylene, water  or


hydrocarbon-based solvent, but not without difficulty and some sacrifice


in performance/cost.


     For the high-value solvents such as fluorocarbon 113, substantial


efforts are made to recover vapor emissions.  The technology for vapor


recovery in most applications is now widely available.  It is technically


possible to make improvements in vapor recpvcry by the end of one year


following the issuance of the necessary regulations or price incentives.


However, there may be important constraints on the availability of certain

                                                                         3
components of the vapor recovery equipment such as carbon adsorption units


which could stretch out the conversion by one or more years.


     Table V-8 summarizes the conversion times for the regulatory alter-


natives.




        Table V-8.  CONVERSION TIMES FOR SOLVENT APPLICATIONS
Convert to different fluorocarbon/chlorocarton
  solvent


Convert to new solvent (when available)
Upgrade vapor recovery practices
  1-2 years
1-2 years (after
becoming available)
  1-2 years
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., based on chemical industry contacts.
                                    V-26

-------
C.  PHASING  OF  CONVERSION TIMES




      For  each  of  the  industry sectors now consuming  the potentially  re-




 stricted  fluorocarbons  and  chlorocarbons,  two  conversion  timetables  are




 of  primary  interest.  The first  is  the  time  required to bring  to  the




 market  a  sufficient quantity of  a substitute product to meet the  demand




 now satisfied  by  the  product using  the  fluorocarbon  or chlorocarbon.




 As  an example,  the time required to manufacture and  distribute roll-on




 and stick antlperspirant products would be the first conversion time if




 a ban were  placed on  the use of  fluorocarbons  in aerosol  antiperspirants.




 The second  conversion time  of primary interest is  that required to bring




 on  line a substitute  chemical with  similar characteristics  to  the fluoro-




 carbons and chlorocarbons and then  reformulate the existing products to



 use the new chemicals.  For the  antiperspirant, a  new liquified gas  pro-




 pellant may have  to be  developed, followed by  the  reformulation and




 testing of  the aerosol  antiperspirant product.




      These  two conversion times  represent, first,  the response or con-




 version times  of  the  consuming sectors  to  an abrupt,  near-term ban on




 their use of the  chemicals.  The second response time is  that  required




 to  develop  a substitute chemical with properties similar  to the banned




 chemical  and to reformulate the  consuming  products.   Because the  second




 response  time  is  substantially longer than the first, the second  repre-




 sents potential (but  not certain) long-term  conversion strategy.  If




 there is  a  ban of the chemicals  in  the  next  one or two years,  the con-




 suming  sectors would  have to pursue the first  set  of conversion strategies




 and then  wait  to  see  if new chemicals became available in the  future and




 decide  then whether a reconversion  was  possible or necessary.






                                    V-27

-------
     Table  V-9  summarizes the primary response times of the chemical




consuming industries to an immediate (six months, for example) ban on




the production or use of the fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons.  In most




instances, the response would be .£0 introduce into the existing markets




products which now exist but have not been able to compete with products




using the fluorocarbons or chlorocarbons.




     The fastest response time  for the propellant applications is one




to two years, during which the production capacity of substitute products




would be expanded and market acceptance would be tested.  Major segments




of the refrigeration industry could not market substitute products until




about three years after a ban in the fluorocarbons.  This time would be




spent adopting absorption technology to the various refrigeration pro-




ducts and gearing up the necessary manufacturing facilities.  The inter-




mediate chemicals are a major exception to the general rule of available




substitute products.  While some substitute products may be available,




a ban of some of the chlorocarbons and fluorocarbons could require sub-




stantial chemical process technology development, new final product




development and testing, and new facilities development.  A two to seven




year range must be assumed as a possible "fastest" conversion time.




     When considering the time required to bring on line substitute




chemicals as opposed to substitute products, there are a number of impor-




tant uncertainties which cannot be resolved at this point.  It is not




publicly known whether viable substitute chemicals have been identified




or what their potential uses or characteristics would be.  If a substitute




is identified, one cannot now say whether it is a product already being




produced or whose production technology is well known.  The substitute
                                 V-28

-------
         Table V-9.  CONSUMING INDUSTRY RESPONSE TIME TO
                     AN IMMEDIATE CHEMICAL BAN
Consuming industry
Response time  a
Intermediate chemical applications

Propellant applications

Refrigerant applications

   Appliances

   Mobile air conditioners

 .  Home air conditioners

   Commercial refrigeration

   Commercial air conditioners

     -  reciprocating

     -  centrifugal

Blowing agent applications

   Rigid foams

   Flexible foams

Solvent applications

   (Convert to non-regulated fluorocarbons
   or chlorocarbons)	
    2-7 years

    1-2 years

to absorption

4-6 years

indefinite

3-5 years

4-6 years



3-5 years

2-3 years



    3 years

   six months

   1-2 years
to F-22

3-4 years

indefinite

zero

3-4 years



2-3 years

1-3 years
  The primary response times of the consuming industries to a ban of
  fluorocarbon and chlorocarbon usage are the elapsed times required
  for the industries to introduce substitute products to meet the demand
  now satisfied by controlled chemicals or products using the chemicals.


  In the event of a ban of F-ll and F-12, most refrigerant applications
  would be converted to F-22.  If F-22 were also banned, the products
  would be converted to absorption systems or to other suitable refrigerants.
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., based on industry sources.
                                   V-29

-------
chemical might require major efforts to develop a manufacturing tech-




nology and then to build new production plants.




     Figures V-2   and V-3   were constructed to illustrate an "Opti-




mistic" and a "Pessimistic" sequencing of the steps required to bring a




substitute chemical into production.  Under the "Optimistic" scenario,




the following assumptions were made:




     1.  The screening and testing of substitute chemicals has been




         underway for one year before the ban is imposed.




     2.  The chemical manufacturing technology for producing the sub-




         stitute chemical is already well established.




     3.  The necessary raw materials are already being produced and




         their production capacity simply needs to be expanded.




     4.  The manufacturing facilities for the new chemical would be




         conversions or expansions of existing facilities.




     Under this set of optimistic assumptions, about three and a half




years is required to begin production of the substitute chemical after




the fluorocarbon or chlorocarbon is banned.




     The "Pessimistic" scenario assumes each of the required steps for




bringing on a new chemical must be carried out in its entirety.  The




specific assumptions made were the following:




     1.  A substitute chemical had not been identified or tested at the




         time the ban was imposed.




     2.  A reliable process technology for the chemical must be developed.




     3.  Adequate raw material supplies do not exist and new- raw material




         plants must be built.




     4.  New chemical production plants must be built.






                                  V-30

-------
     Chemical testing
     Expand raw materials
     Expand or modify
       existing facilities
                                         	1	H-
                                              2      3

                                          Time, years
Figure V-2.  "Optimistic" Time Sequence for Producing Substitute Chemical*
 a  Assumes:  1)

              2)
              3)
              4)
screening and testing of substitute chemical has been underway
one year before ban.
chemical process technology for producing substitute exists.
raw materials are secured by an expansion, of existing sources.
the new chemical processing facilities would be expansions or
  conversions of existing facilities.
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates based on chemical industry sources.

-------
u>
            Screen alternative
              chemicals

            Test substitute for
              health, safety, etc.

            Develop process
              technology

            Develop and build raw
              material plant

            Build chemical plant
                                                                  Time, years

                   Figure V-3.  "Pessimistic" Time Sequence for Producing Substitute Chemical*
                Assumes:  1)  substitute chemical has not been identified at time of ban.
                          2) • reliable process technology for producing the chemical does not exist.
                          3)  adequate raw material supplies do not exist.
                          4)  new chemical production plants must be built.
            Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates based on chemical industry sources.

-------
     Under this set of pessimistic assumptions, nine years would be




required to begin production of a substitute chemical after the impo-




sition of a ban on fluorocarbon/chlorocarbon production.




     Without knowing specifically what the substitute chemical will be,




the possible range of times necessary to simply begin producing a sub-




stitute chemical must be bracketed at between 4 to 9 years.  The




conversion of one producer from trichloroethylene to methyl chloroform




for major solvent applications is an analogous situation.  In 1966,




trichloroethylene was identified as a contributor to smog in Los Angeles.




In 1973, seven years later, the production facilities for methyl chloro-




form came on line.  The same producer had identified a new pesticide in




1966, but the production plant was not operational until 1975.




     When considering potential chemical conversion times, one can regard




a three to four year conversion time as being a minimum, and a seven




to nine year conversion time as a likely maximum.




     If the substitute chemical is to be used as a final product,, such




as in solvent applications, the production of the chemical itself is the




beginning of the product availability in its final form.  When the




chemical is to be used as an input to other final products, time required




for the reformulation or redesign of the consuming products is an impor-




tant component of the total time required to bring new consuming




products to the market.  Forty-nine percent of the 1973 U.S. production




of fluorocarbons was used as an aerosol propellant.  From the standpoint




of the producer of a chemical substitute to the fluorocarbon, it is cri-




tically important to know whether the substitute can and will be used in




the propellant applications.   This information must be known before the





                                  V-33

-------
producer commits' himself to production capacity for which there is no




market.  The decisions by potential users of the chemicals, such as




refrigeration manufacturers and aerosol manufacturers, may be the deter-




mining factors  as  far as whether and- when substitute chemicals would be



produced.




     Figure  V-4   illustrates how the conversion times of the chemical




manufacturer and the aerosol producer sequence under optimistic, and pes-




simistic chemical  conversion assumptions.  The elapsed time from the




announcement of the ban to the beginning of production of the chemical




and the aerosol products would be between four and ten years.  These




times are longer than simply beginning production of the chemical




because major investments in chemical production facilities and developing




production technologies will be delayed until the viability of aerosol




products using the new propellant can be established.  The four to ten




year range of conversion times would; be applicable to F-ll and F-12,




which are predominantly used as propellanta.




     Figure  V-5   illustrates the sequence of conversion times for moving




to a new chemical refrigerant.  Again using the optimistic and pessimistic




alternatives, the  conversion time range is from four and a half to ten




and a half years.  The times are slightly longer than for the aerosol




applications because more time may be required to verify the utility of




the chemical in the new refrigeration system than would be necessary in




aerosol products.  The conversion range of four and a half to ten and a half




years would be representative; of the time required to convert; from refri-



geration systems using fluorocarbon refrigerants  to non-fluorocarbon liquid




refrigerants.




                                   V-34

-------
u>
Ul
       Chemical testing

       Aerosol product develop-
         ment & testing

       Expand or modify raw
         material & chemical
         production plants

       Set up aerosol manufac-
         turing plants
Chemical screening
  & testing

Develop process
  technology

Build raw material plant

Build chemical plant

Aerosol product develop-
  ment & testing

Set up aerosol manufac-
  turing facilities
                                                                          Optimistic Schedule
                                                                                 Pessimistic Schedule
                                               4-
                                                                 f-
•\	1	1-
                                   0123456789     10
                                                              Time, years

         Figure V-4.  "Optimistic" and "Pessimistic" Time Schedules for Converting to a New Liquified Gas Propellant
           See text for definition of optimistic and pessimistic schedules.

       Source:  Arthur D.  Little, Inc., estimates based on industry sources.

-------
Chemical testing

Refrigeration product
  development & testing

Expand or modify raw
  material & chemical
  production plants
Set up refrigeration
  manufacturing plants
Optimistic Schedule
                                                                                              a
Chemical screening
  & testing

Develop process
  technology

Build raw material plant

Build chemical plant

Refrigeration product
  development & testing

Set up refrigeration
  manufacturing facilities
Pessimistic Schedule
                             0
                                   1     2     3     45     6     7     8     9     10
                                                           Time, years

Figure V-5.  "Optimistic" and "Pessimistic" Time Schedules for Converting to New Chemical Refrigerant.
                                                                       \	h
               +
                      11
    See text for definition of optimistic and pessimistic schedules.

Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates based on industry sources.

-------
     Table V-10  summarizes the estimated times required to convert to




a new chemical in the major fluorocarbon and chlorocarbon use sectors.




These values are in contrast with those in Table V-9   which show what




now appear to be the earliest the major consuming industries will be




able to introduce products taking the place of those currently using




the fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons.  In the event of a ban, the indus-




try sectors would undertake the conversion strategies represented by




Table  V-9.   In parallel, they could waif for substitute chemicals to




be developed and then consider the reformulation or redesign of their




products with the new chemicals.  Table V-10  lists the estimated times




for this second set of conversion strategies.




     In addition to the opportunities for conversion to substitute pro-




ducts or substitute chemicals, the opportunities for reducing emissions




to the atmosphere  which were discussed earlier are summarized in




Table V-ll.   The estimated times required to upgrade equipment or




modify processing facilities are listed on the table.  These response




times are short relative to other options and in some cases can signifi-




cantly reduce losses to the atmosphere.




     As is discussed in Chapter III,  there are small atmospheric




losses due to manufacturing and transporting the chemicals.  However,




the losses during their intended uses are far greater, and it is the




reduction of these use losses that are summarized in Table V-ll.
                                  V-37

-------
               Table V-10.  CONSUMING INDUSTRY CONVERSION TIMES
                            TO USING SUBSTITUTE CHEMICALS
Consuming industry
Conversion times
Intermediate chemical applications

Propellant applications

Refrigerant applications.

Blowing agent applications

   -  flexible foams

   -  rigid foams

Solvent applications    	.,.._
   5 to 10 years

   4 to 10 years

   5 to 11 years



   six months

   4 to 9 years

   4 to 9 years
 The conversion times to substitute chemicals are those required to
 develop nett chemicals with properties similar to the banned compounds
 and to modify the products using the banned chemicals.


Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates based on industry sources.
               Table V-ll.  TIMES REQUIRED FOR EtjjUlPMENT UPGRADING
                            TO REDUCE ATMOSPHERIC LOSSES
Industry sector
Refrigerant applications
Blowing agent applications
Solvent applications
Re.sponse times
2 to 4 years
2 to 3 years
	 1 year
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates based on industry sources.
                                    V-38

-------
         VI.  DEFINITION OF PRIMARY AFFECTED INDUSTRY SECTORS




A.  INTRODUCTION


     The purpose of this chapter is to define the major industry sectors


which potentially may be significantly impacted by restrictions on the


chlorocarbons and fluorocarbbns under investigation in this report.  Since
                                                             A

the various sectors are so highly interrelated, we have shown the flow of


products from raw materials, such as chlorine, through various hydrocarbon


and chlorocarbon intermediates to final products, among which are the


fluorocarbons in question.


     Each of these interrelated sectors could be impacted by a fluoro-


carbon ban or limitation.  The level of impact, however, would be a


function of the timing and extent of specific regulatory actions.  This


chapter, therefore, examines the industry participants and their respec-


tive dependence on fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons as a base for discussing


the impact of alternative regulatory scenarios and resulting potential


economic impacts in Chapter VII.


     We have concentrated on defining industry sectors directly involved


with manufacture and use of fluorocarbon materials.  Impacts for indirectly


related Industries, such as the transportation or the retail areas , have


not been studied and should be considered in a subsequent analysis.
                                      VI-1

-------
 B.   INDUSTRY STRUCTURE




 1.   Sector  Relationships




      The  overall structure  of  the  industry associated with  fluorocarbon




 manufacture is  complex and  highly  interrelated.   Figure VI-1 illustrates




 the  progression from relatively  simple  and basic  raw materials  such  as




 chlorine  and raw hydrocarbons  through several  intermediates,  and  finally




 to fluorocarbon and  related products and  their respective major end  uses.




 This figure is  meant only  to  show generalized product relationships and




 may  differ  somewhat  from a  producer's specific manufacturing  practice.




 The  various components and  the interrelationship  of  the fluorocarbon-




 related industries are best described by  examining each product class




 separately.




 a.   Basic Raw Materials




      The  fundamental raw materials for  fluorocarbon  production  are hydro-




 carbons, hydrofluoric  acid and chlorine.   Chlorine is a basic industrial




 chemical—produced from the electrolysis  of brine!r»-with applications




 in a wide range of organic and inorganic  products, as shown in  Table VI-1.




 In terms of consumption, by far  the most  important end uses for chlorine




 are  in the  manufacture of chlorocarbons,  which accounted for  over 45 percent




 of 1973 domestic  chlorine demand.  A more detailed description  of chloro-




 carbon manufacture and end use is  found in the next  section of  this  report.




      Other  major  feedstocks for  fluorocarbon manufacture are  light




hydrocarbons — methane, ethane, propane, n-butane—obtained primarily




from natural gas or from petroleum refinery operations.   Natural gas




supplies,  however, are becoming scarcer and petrochemical manufacturers
                                  VI-2

-------
                RAW MATERIALS
                METHANE-
                CHLORINE
 I
co
                REFINERY GASES —
                ETHANE a  PROPANE-*
                N-BUTANE-
                HEAVY
                LIQUID FEEDSTOCKS -«J
PRIMARY          CHLOROCARBON
INTERMEDIATES   INTERMEDIATES
                                         END PRODUCTS
                                                                                            END  USES
                                                                              43%

                                     PROPYLENE
                                              — i
                                       ETHANE
                                             - 1
                                       ETHYL ALCOHOL
                                      -ETHYLENE—
                                      ACETYLENE
                                              -,
                                                |
                                                      •-METHYL CHLORIDE	

                                                        (ALSO CHLOROFORM)

                                                        METHYLENE CHLORIDE
                               TETRAMETHYL LEAD •
                               'SILICONES 	
                               MISCELLANEOUS (Chemicol Inrermeliore.erc.)
                                                      *• CHLOROFORM •
                                                                                                (F-22).
                                                        .ALSO -ETHYL CHLORIDE AND     '^LVENT AND OTHER
                                                         KETHYLENE CHLORIBE)       80%,
                                                        CARBON TETRACHLORIDE-
                                                                                          AND OTHER
                               rLUOROCAR80NS (F-II.F-12)
                                                     -^•PERCHLOROETHYLENE
                                                      (ALSO CARBON TETRACHLORIOEI
                                                       -METHYL CHLOROFORM „
                          (SEE INTERMEDIATES FROM
                           ETHYLENE OiCHLORIDE)
                           rSS^TETRAETHYL LEAD
      ETHYL CHLORIDE •        . ,v
                           LliASOLVENT AND OTHER
      ETHYLENE OICHLORIOE-
                           r2S*VlNYL CHLORIDE 	
                               METHYL CHLOROFORM •
                            _2Z	
                                                                                                        -wPOLYVINYL CHLORIDE—I
                           h—*2LEAD SCAVENGER
                           —ETHYLENE AMINES
                             EXPORTS  AND OTHER
                           —*?PERCHLORO£THYLENE	
                           —*£TRICHLOROETHYLENE	
c
                   PERCHLOROETHYLENE
                   TRICHLOROETHYLENE
}
                                                                            (SEE INTERMEDIATES FROM
                                                                             ETHVLENE OiCNLORIDE)
                          Figure VI-1.  Materials Flow Chart  - Chlorocarbons  -  1973
                                                      -VINYLIDENE CHLORIDE
                                                                                 50%
                                                                                                   GASOLINE ANTIKNOCK FLUID
                                                                                                   POLYMERS, SPECIALTY CHEMICALS
                                                                                                   SOLVENT. PAINT REMOVER
                                                                                                   AEROSOL VAPOR DEPRESSANT
                                                                                               -^•PLASTICS PROCESSING dolvtnt)
                                                                                                          AND OTHER
                                                                                              "~~~^ I   SEE FLUOROCAR80N
                                                                                                   f    FLOW CHART
                                                                                              "TTT-1  (Figure  VI-2.)
                                                                                                 -° BUILDING AND CONSTRUCTION
                                                                                                        FURNISHINGS
                                                                                                   ELECTRICAL INSULATION
                                                                                                   PACKAGING
                                                                                                   OTHER
                                                                                                   POLYVINYklDENE -CHLORIDE
                                                                                                   CLEANING SOLVENT
                                                                                               705i     ^
                                                                                               —* VEHICLE SOLVENT
                                                                                               227
                                                                                                   EXPORT AND OTHER
                                                                                                   DRY CLEANING
                                                                                                   TEXTILE PROCESSING & FINISHING
                                                                                                 •EXPORTS  AND OTHERS
                                                                                                   METAL CLEANING
                                                                                                   FLUOROCAR80NS. (F-113. F-114)
                                   CLEANING
                             EXPORTS E. OTHER
                             EXTRACTION SOLVENT
Source:   Arthur  D. Little, Inc.,  estimates.

-------
     Table VI-1. U.S. CHLORINE PRODUCTION AND MAJOR END USES - 1973
                       (thousands of tons)
Organic compounds
One-carbon (C )
Two-carbon (C )
Three-carbon (C.)
Cyclic
Oxygen containing
Total organic
Non-organic
Inorganic chemicals
Pulp and paper
Water treatment
Total non-organic
Unspecified
Total
Demand
1,550
3,000
620
517
1,035
6,722

1,240
1,345
520
3,105
533
10,360
Percent of
total
15
29
6
5
10
65

12
13
5
30
5.
100
Source;   U.S. International Trade Commission and Arthur D. Little, Inc.,
         estimates.
                              VI-4

-------
are looking increasingly toward heavy liquid feedstocks such as


naphtha and gas oil as the source of light hydrocarbons.  Technologies


for heavy liquid cracking and reforming are being developed currently


and over the next 5-10 years should play an increasingly important role


as sources for hydrocarbons suitable for conversion to chlorocarbons


and fluorpcarbons.


b.  Primary Intermediates


     The hydrocarbon raw materials described in the previous section are


processed to yield an extremely, important group Of industrial intermediates—


ethylene, propylene, acetylene, methanol, ethanol, and others.  Ethylene


is the largest volume olefin produced in the United States, with 1973


production in excess of 22 billion pounds, and is produced either via


ethane, reforming or heavy liquid cracking.  Virtually all ethylene


produced is used as a precursor for derived products—polyethylene, ethy-


lene glycol, and ethylene dichloride, which in turn are either processed


further or, in the case of polyethylene, consumed directly.


     Another important primary intermediate related to fluorocarbon pro-


duction is propylene, which is produced either via propane reforming or
                                               •

heavy liquid cracking, much like ethylene.  Propylene finds use as a


precursor for polypropylene,.an increasingly important plastic, as well


as for propylene glycol and the chlorocarbon, perchloroethylene.


Propylene production in 1973 was nearly 10 billion pounds,  placing it second in


overall olefin. production.   Another noteworthy intermediate is


acetylene, which has experienced declining production recently, as


alternate intermediates (most directly ethylene and propylene) have


proven more economical in the manufacture of downstream products.



                                 VI-5

-------
Acetylene, however, Is produced from a variety of hydrocarbon feedstocks




and is used in the manufacture of a limited amount of perchloroethylene




and trichloroethylene.  Ethanol and tnethanol are also used as precursors




for chlorocarbons such as methyl chloride, methylene chloride, and ethyl




chloride, as well as directly as solvents and in other uses.  Table VI-2




summarizes the 1973 production and major end uses for each of these




primary intermediates.



    -Although chlorine, itself, is used directly in the production of most




chlorocarbons,, a small amount of hydrogen chloride (HC1) is used to produce




methyl chloride and methylene chloride.  In addition, substantial amounts




of HC1, which is produced as a byproduct of chlorocarbon manufacture, are




recycled and oxidized to produce makeup chlorine via oxychlorination or the




relativetly new Kel-Chlor process.  Approximately 5 to 10 percent of the




total amount of chlorine required for chlorocarbon manufacture is supplied




from HC1 recycle.




c.  Chlorocarbon Intermediates




     As indicated in Figure VI-1  the chlorocarbons represent a second




class of intermediate which result from the processing via chlorination




or hydrochlorination of primary intermediates such as ethylene or




propylene.  In turn, these chlorocarbon intermediates are generally pro-




cessed further into fluorocarbons and other chlorinated materials such




as polyvinyl chloride.  However, some chlorocarbons, such as perchloro-




ethylene, trichloroethylene,  and methyl chloroform have direct application




as solvents, degreasing agents, cleaning agents, and in other uses which




use about 25 percent of the total production of the 10 chlorocarbons




studied.






                                  Jl-6

-------
Table VI-2.  U.S. PRODUCTION AND END USES OF HALOCARBON PRIMARY INTERMEDIATES - 1973
Chemical Production Major end uses Percent
Ethylene





Propylene


Acetylene





Methanol






Ethanol







22,329 million Ib





9,880 million Ib


380 million Ib





960 million gal






285 million gal







Polyethylene
Ethylene dichloride
Ethylene glycol
Ethylbenzene
Ethyl alcohol
Other
Acrylonitrile
Polypropylene
Other a
Acrylates
Vinyl chloride monomer
Acetylenic chemicals
Vinyl acetate
Chlorinated solvents
Other
Formaldehyde
General process solvents
DMT
Methyl halides
Methyl amines
Exports
Miscellaneous
Chemical intermediates
Toiletries & cosmetics
Acetaldehyde
Industrial solvent &
thinner
Detergents, flavors &
disinfectants
Miscellaneous
40
13
12
8
6
21
21
29
50
26
23
20
17
4
10
45
10
7
4
4
5
21
26
20
9
12

10

23
     Includes allyl chloride, butyraldehydes,  cumene, dodecene,  heptene,
     isopropyl alcohol, nonene, propylene oxide.

   Sources:  Chemical Marketing Reporter, U.S. International Trade Commission,
             and Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                                     VI-7

-------
    The Cj chlorocarbons include methyl chloride, methylene chloride,




chloroform, and carbon tetrachloride.  The majority  (60 percent) of methyl




chloride is produced via hydrochlorination of the primary intermediate,




methanol, with the remainder being produced via direct chlorination of




methane.  Methylene chloride on the other hand is predominantly produced




via direct chlorination of methane, which produces methyl- and methylene




chloride as coproducts.  Carbon tetrachloride and chloroform are also




produced via direct chlorination as coproducts.  In addition, about 25




percent of carbon tetrachloride production capacity is based on carbon



disulfide and a small amount of carbon tetrachloride is obtained as a by-




product of perc'hloroethylene manufacture.




    The C2 chlorocarbons include perchloroethylene, trichloroethylene,




ethyl chloride, and ethylene dichloride (EDC), and, together with C,




chlorocarbons, constitute the chlorocarbon intermediates for the fluoro-




carbons examined in this study.  With over 9 billion pounds produced in




1973, ethylene dichloride is the largest-volume chlorocarbon intermediate.




Derivative's include vinyl chloride, perchloroethylene, and trichloroethylene.




Table VI-3 details the end-use pattern for EDC in 1973 and shows that its




dominant use was as the precursor for vinyl chloride manufacture.  EDC




in addition served as the precursor for 85 percent of the estimated 450




million pounds of the trichloroethylene, and 50 percent of the 700 million




pounds of perchloroethylene produced, respectively,  in 1973.   Chlorination of




acetylene accounts for the remaining 15 percent of trichloroethylene,




and 5 percent of perchloroethylene production.   The remaining 45 percent of




perchloroethylene production is via propylene chlorination.




d.  End Products and Uses




    The end products for which chlorocarbon intermediates serve as




precursors are extremely large in number and widespread in use.  In





                                VI-8

-------
              Table VI-3   U.S. ETHYLENE BICHLORIDE END USE - 1973

                           (millions of p'ouhds)
Total EDC reported production
End use
Vinyl chloride
Trichloroethylene
Perchloroethylene
Ethylene amines
Vinylidene chloride
Miscellaneous
Lead scavenger
Exports
Total
9,293 million Ib.
Percent of
Amount reported production
8,197
339
212
132
109
10
250
368
9,617a
87.9
3.6
2.3
1.4
1.2
0.1
2.7
4.0
103.2
 Includes estimate of EDC production not reported
Source:  U.S. International Trade Commission and Arthur D. Little, Inc,
         estimates.
                                   VI-9

-------
addition to fluorocarbons, C^ chlorocarbon derivatives include tetramethyl



lead, sllicones, solvents, and others which find end uses in polymers,




paints, aerosols, gasoline anti-knock agents, and numerous other end uses.




Table VI-4 summarizes C-^ chlorocarbon derivative end-use applications and




their respective amounts of chlorocarbon intermediates consumed in 1973.




     G£ chlorocarbon derivatives likewise find widespread and important




end uses.  Most notable is polyvinyl chloride, a versatile and cost-




effective plastic, which accounted for over 4.5 billion pounds or nearly




86 percent of vinyl chloride production in 1973.  PVC production alone accounted




for nearly 15 percent of total U.S. chlorine demand in 1973.  Other important




C2 chlorpcarbpn derivatives include tetraethyl lead, ethylene amines,




polyvinylidene chloride and others which find end uses in textiles,



gasoline anti-knock compounds, solvents, and in export markets.  In




addition,, substantial amounts of two €2 chlorocarbpns, perchloroethylene




and trichloroethylene, are used directly as dry cleaning and metal




decreasing agents.  Table VI-5 summarizes 1973 €2 •chlorocarbon derivative




end uses and volumes.




2.  Chlorocarbon and Fluorocarbon Product and Material Flows




a.  Chlorocarbon Intermediates




     Figure VI-2 summarizes in greater detail the product and material




flows of the fluorocarbons under consideration and their intermediate




chlorocarbon precursors, carbon tetrachloride, chloroform, and perchloro-




ethylene.  As pointed out in the previous section, these three materials




are only several of the many C^ and €2 chlorocarbon intermediates  which are




highly interrelated by virtue of either common primary intermediate




precursors or similar derivative end products.  Chloroform and carbon






                                  VI-10

-------
 Table VI-4.  U.S. PRODUCTION/RAW MATERIALS FOR C., CHLORINATED HYDROCARBONS - 1973
                                (millions of pounds)
        Chlorocarbon production
   Chlbrocarbon Consumption
Methyl chloride (544/247)
Tetramethyl lead (235/130)

Silicone (205/110)
Miscellaneous - chemical
   intermediates and solvents
   (104/57)
Methylene chloride (520/820)
Paint remover, solvent  (260/410)
Aerosols (40/65)

Rubber processing (30/45)

Exports and other (190/300)
Chloroform (253/454)
Fluorocarbon 22 (205/368)
Solvents and other chemical
   intermediates (48/86)
Carbon tetrachloride (1047/1610)
F-ll (415/640)
F-12 (632/970)
Other (small)
 (methyl chloride production/chlorine consumption)


 '(methyl chloride use/chlorine equivalent)
Source:  U.S. International Trade Commission and Arthur D. Little, Inc.
         estimates.
                                  VI-11

-------
Table VI-5. U.S. PRODUCTION/RAW MATERIALS FOR C. CHLORINATED HYDROCARBONS- 1973
                              (millions of pounds)
        Chlorocarbon production
    Chlorocarbon consumption
Ethylene dichloride (9617/3890)
                               a
Vinyl chloride (8197/3315)
Trichloroethylene  (339/135)
Perchloroethylene  (212/85)
Ethylene amines (132/50)
Vinylidene chloride  (109/45)
Lead scavenger (250/100)
Exports and miscellaneous  (378/160)
Methyl chloroform (548/724)
Metal cleaning and degreasing  (384/507)
Vinylidene chloride  (44/58)
Exports and other (120/159)
Perchloroethylene  (706/1062)
Dry cleaning solvent  (424/637)
Textile processing  (35/53)
Fluorocarbons (58/88)
Metal cleaning  (83/127)
Exports and other  (106/157)
Trichloroethylene (452/624)
Metal cleaning  (389/537)
Exports  (50/69)
Solvents and chemical intermediates
    (13/18)
Ethyl chloride (660/100)
Tetraethyl lead (560/85)
Solvents and chemical intermediates
                      (100/15)
a(ethylene dichloride production/chlorine consumption)
 (vinyl chloride use/chlorine equivalent)
Source:  U.S. International Trade Commission and Arthur D. Little,  Inc. estimates.
                                     VI-12

-------
 CHLOROCARBON
 INTERMEDIATES
                28Z
CARBON TETHACHLORIDE—•
                52%
                           FtUOROCARBONS
                        •TRICHLOROauOROMETHANE •
                                IF-11)
                        •DlCHLOROOIFLUOROMETHANE •
                                 (F-12)
CHLOROFORM
                        • CHLOROOlFLUOROMETHANE
                                 (F-32)
PERCHLOROETHTLENE
                        • TRICKLOROTRIFLUOROETHANE •
                                 (F-113)
                        • OtCHLOROTETRAFLUOROETHANE •
                                  (F-114)
END  PROPUCTS
                                                        49Z
                                                        28Z
                                                         7%
                                                               • PROPELLANTS  •
                                                               • REFRIGERANTS
                                                               • SOLVENTS
                                                               • PLASTICS AND RESINS
•








*


                                                               • FOAM BLOWING AGENTS
                                                                EXPORTS AND OTHER
                                                      END USES
                                                   •PERSONAL PRODUCTS
                                                   •HOUSEHOLD PRODUCTS



                                                   • COATINGS AND FINISHES



                                                   •INSECT SPRAYS



                                                   •FOOD PRODUCTS



                                                    OTHER



                                                  ••REFRIGERATION



                                                 -••AIR CONDITIONING



                                              r—— ELECTRONICS

                                         Figure VI-2.   Materials  Flow  Chart  -; Fluorocarbons  - 1973
                                                                                                                  OTHER
                                                                                                                        ®
                                                                                                                  TEFLON  PRODUCTS
                                                                                                               -*-RIGID FOAM
                                                                                                                •-FLEXIBLE FOAM
                                                    FIRE EXTINGUISHING AGENT. -


                                                    DIELECTRIC FLUID AND OTHER
Source:  Arthur  D. Little,  Inc.,  estimates.

-------
tetrachloride are principally produced via thermal chlorination of methane, while




perchloroethylene is primarily produced from ethylene dichloride which,




as pointed out previously, has other Important derivatives such as poly-




vinyl chloride.  Table VI-6 summarizes 1973 production and end-use data for




these three chlorocarbon intermediates.




b.  Fluorocarbon End Products




     Table VI*-7 summarizes the raw materials requirements for the three




fluorpcarbons F-ll, F-12, and F-22 in 1973 and the indirectly related raw




material requirements for major fluorocarbon end uses.  The major fluoro-




carbons F-ll and F-12 are manufactured from carbon tetrachloride, and they




accounted for 40 and 60 percent respectively of carbon tetrachloride domestic use




in 1973.  Since industry sources indicate that 10-20 percent of production of




carbon tetrachloride is for other uses including exports, it is believed




that reported production is understated.  It is estimated that approximately




415 million pounds of carbon tetrachloride was utilized in 1973 in the




production of F-ll. • The related raw material requirements are 55 million




pounds of hydrofluoric acid and indirectly 370 million pounds of chlorine




required for the production of carbon tetrachloride utilized in the produc-




tion of F-ll.  In the related end^use markets, an estimated 615 million



pounds of carbon tetrachloride or 59 percent of 1973 production was required for




the production of F-ll and F-12 for use as aerosol propellants.




     Fluorocarbon 22 represents a major portion of the total demand for



chloroform or 81 percent of chloroform production in 1973.  A similar analysis




is provided in Table VI-7 on the related requirements for chloroform in its




related end-use markets.




     In addition to the importance of the demand for basic chemicals such




as chloroform and carbon tetrachloride in fluorocarbon production, the




                                  VI-14

-------
               Table VI-6. U.S.  PRODUCTION/RAW MATERIALS FOR
        CARBON TETRACHLORIDE, CHLOROFORM, PERCHLOROETHYLENE - 1973
                            (millions of  pounds)
     Chlorocarbon production
                 Chlorocarbon consumption
Carbon tetrachloride
1047
Fll
F12
Other
 415
 632
Small
Chloroform
 253
F22
Solvents, other
 205
  48
Perchloroethylene
 706
Fluorocarbons
Dry cleaning solvent
Textile processing
Metal cleaning
Exports and others
  58
 424
  35
  83
 106
Source:  U.S. International Trade Commission and Arthur D.  Little,  Inc.,
         estimates.
                                    VI-15

-------
                           Table VI-7. U.S.  FLUOROCARBON CONSUMPTION OF RAW MATERIALS - 1973

                                                     (millions of pounds)
<
H

Chloroform production total
Fluor ocarbon 22
Plastics (PTFE)
Refrigerants
Propellant and other
Export
Other
Carbon tetrachloride
Production total
Fluorocarbon 11
Blowing agent
Propellant
Refrigerant
Export and other
Fluorocarbon 12
Refrigerants
Propellants
Blowing agent
Export and other
Other
t
End-Use
253

50
150
5
11
37
1047
415
65
295
25
30
632
205
320
22
85
Small
Percent

81

4
15
100

39.7

60.3

100
Chlorine demand
454
320



1610
640

970


Percent of total domestic
chlorine demand
2.2
(1.8)



7.7
(3.1)

(4.6)

,
           Source:   U.S.  International  Trade Commission,  and Arthur D. Little,  Inc. estimates.

-------
related chlorine and hydrofluoric acid demand is significant.  As indicated




previously, 9.5 percent of domestic chlorine demand is related to fluorocarbon




production.  Also, based on the estimated end-use patterns for the




fluorocarbons, it is estimated that fluorocarbon propellant applications




account for 4.6  .percent of total domestic chlorine demand.  Approximately




305 million pounds of hydrofluoric acid were utilized in the production




of F-ll, F-12, and F-13 in 1973.  This represents greater than 40  percent of the




total U.S. production of hydrofluoric acid in 1973;



     The estimated end-use patterns and levels of consumption of the



principal fluorocarbons are summarized in Table VI-8.




3.  Related Business Activities




     A summary of the related business activities for fluorocarbons is




summarized in Table VI-9.  The basic chemical producers of fluorocarbons




as well as raw material producers of chlorocarbons, i.e., chlorine and




hydrocarbon intermediate manufacturers, and hydrofluoric acid would be




significantly impacted if fluorocarbon use were restricted.  In addition




there are a number of related industries which consume fluorocarbons which




would be Impacted including aerosol manufacturers, refrigeration equipment



manufacturers, plastics processing, resin producers and fluorocarbon solvent




consuming industries.  Aerosol manufacturing is done by both custom fillers,




which provide the filling capability for aerosol marketers, and by filler/




marketers which have integrated backward from their marketing operations.
                                  VI-17

-------
           Table VI-8.  PRODUCTION/RAW MATERIAL FOR FLUOROCARBONS - 1973

Raw materials
(million pounds)
Carbon tetrachloride
(415)

HF
(55)
Carbon tetrachloride
(632)
HF
(180)
Chloroform
(205)
HF
(70)
Fluorocarbons
(million pounds)

Fluorocarbon 11 (334)

Fluorocarbon 12 (489)

Fluorocarbon 22 (136)

End uses
(million pounds)
( 53) Foam blowing agent
( 18) Refrigerant
(.23) Export and others
(240) Propellant
(168) Refrigerants |
( 10) Foam
( 61) Export arid other
(25p) Propellant
( 35) Resins
( ll) Propellant and other
( 90) Refrigerants
Fluorocarbons
Percent of total chlorine demand                   -    9.5
Percent of total chlorine demand for propellants   -    4.6
Percent of total HF production                         41.6
Percent of total carbon tetrachloride production   -   96.5
Percent of total chloroform production                 81.0
Source:  U.S. International Trade Commission, and Arthur D.  Little,  Inc.
         estimates.
                                  VI-18

-------
                     Table VI-9.  RELATED BUSINESS ACTIVITIES - FLUOROCARBONS

    CHEMICAL MANUFACTURE           SUPPLY SECTORS                   END-USE INDUSTRIES

Raw Materials                  Equipment and Materials  —:	^-   Aerosol Manufacturing
  •  chlorocarbons producer      •  can manufacturers               •  custom filler     	^ •   aerosol
  •  hydrofluoric acid           &  cap & valve manufacturers       ®  filler/marketer                  marketer
       producer                  •  filling equipment manu-
                                      facturers
                                 •  ingredient suppliers
                                 •  other
         JiUUclJ.1
         u
      Basic  Chemicals                Equipment and Materials       ^.    Refrigeration
          fluorocarbons producers     •  condensor,  compressor, heat     e  refrigeration equipment     ©  contractors
                                            exchange  manufacturer              manufacturers          ^ ®  service
                                       e  other                           «  household freezer/refrig-   »  sales
                     (to all end-use                                            erator manufacturer
|3                    industries)                                         ;    ,
i-     •   polyether and  poly-                                             Plastics Processing
          ester polyols                                           ^      •  foam manufacturers
                                                                          •  foam product manufacturer

                                                                        Resins and Solvents



      Source:  Arthur D.  Little,  Inc.

-------
Also, there are a number of related suppliers of equipment and materials




which may be impacted if fluorocarbon propellent use in aerosols is




restricted.  The principally affected sectors would be can manufacturers,




cap and valve manufacturers, ingredient suppliers, and filling equipment




manufacturers.  There are obviously a number of other supplier sectors




from packaging to transportation, however, in the context of the proportion




of a total industry sector impacted, these sectors would experience a



much smaller impact.




     The refrigeration industry is an important sector which utilizes




fluorocarbons.   Potential impact sectors are refrigeration equipment manu-




facturers and household freezer and refrigerator manufacturers.   Related




industries are the equipment and materials suppliers including manufacturers




of condensors,  compressors,  heat exchangers and other refrigeration equipment




parts.   In addition, in the end-use sectors there are refrigeration equipment




contractors and service and sales related personnel.




     Other fluorocarbon related industries include plastics processing,




resin producers, and solvent users.  The principal industry sectors in




plastics processing which may be impacted include the foam manufacturers




and the foam product manufacturers which utilize foam in the manufacture




of products such as pillows, cushions, and furniture, and raw material




suppliers of polyether and polyester polyols.  Resin manufacture includes




such products as Du Font's Teflon which is used in a variety of consumer




products.  Fluorocarbon solvents are principally used in the aerospace




and electronics industries.
                               VI-20

-------
C.  PRIMARY INDUSTRY SECTOR DEFINITION




     This section further defines the primary industry sectors which




would be affected by restrictions on the production or use of fluoro-




carbons and chlorocarbons.  Identification efforts have been focused on




those industries which would be directly affected through a loss of




employment, production, and/or sales in relation to the levels which may




have occured without regulation.  Therefore, sectors'which may be indi-




rectly affected, such as transportation or carton manufacture, have been




excludedj while industry sectors such as .chemical raw material producers,




aerosol fillers, and refrigeration equipment manufacturers have been




included.




     In defining the primary sectors, the levels of sales, production




and employment have been presented where this information is available.




The levels of industry activity directly related to the chemicals under




investigation and their fraction of total sector activity have been




defined (i.e., the proportion of hydrofluoric acid production used in




the manufacture of fluorocarbons).  Finally, the major companies involved




in each industry sector have been identified and the estimated importance




of business activities relating to the chemicals under investigation —




relative to overall company activity — has been determined when relevant




data were available.  Although individual company effects are identified




in this section and although these effects are small for most companies,




it should be noted that the total economic impact, in terms of inflation




and employment effects at the national level,will be at least as large




as dictated by the sum of these individual parts.
                                 VI-21

-------
 1.   Raw Materials - Major  raw materials  for  the  key compounds of  Interest




 are discussed  below.




 a.   Chlorine - Chlorine is an important  raw  material for  the production




 of  the fluorocarbons  and chlorocarbons under consideration.  Table VI-10




 summarizes chlorine demand in pertinent  end-use  markets.  As indicated,




 depending upon the restrictions  placed on  fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons,




 the potential  impact  on the chlorine  industry can vary significantly.




 Also,  the potential impact on individual companies  will vary extensively




.based  on the dependence of a company's chlorine  production on production




 of  certain chlorocarbons and/or  fluorocarbons — either through captive




 utilization or sales  in the merchant  market.  Other uses  of chlorine




 include use as a  raw  material for  the production of other organic chemi-




 cals and inorganic'chemicals, use  in  the pulp and paper industry, water




 treatment,  and miscellaneous applications.   There is a high level of




 captive use of chlorine production, with an  estimated 47  percent of pro-




 duction in 1973 being consumed captively by  related industries.




     The major U.S. producers of chlorine  are listed in Table VI-11.




 The table shows each  producer's  production capacity and their relative




 share  of total U.S. chlorine capacity.   Because  of  a high proportion of




 captive utilization,  it is difficult  to  measure  individual company sales




 of  chlorine.   For purposes of this report, a manufacturer's value of




 production has been determined based  on  each company's percent of total




 Industry capacity and an average production,  or  "plant gate" sales  value




 for chlorine based on merchant sales  in  1973.  The  value  of chlorine




 production as  a percent of total company chemical sales is used as a
                                 VI-22

-------
    Table  VI-10. SELECTED CHLORINE DEMAND CATEGORIES - 1973
End-use category
a
Chlorocarbons (total)
Chlorocarbons (excluding vinyl
chloride)
Methyl chloroform, carbon tetra-
chloride & chloroform**
Chloroform for F-22 and carbon
tetrachloride only
Carbon tetrachloride (indirect
chlorine demand for fluoro-
carbons F-ll & F-12)
Percent
of total
demand
45.6
29.6
13.0
9.5
7.7
Comments
Indicates total chloro-
carbon demand level
Demand level net of the
single largest component
Demand level directly r<
lated to 5 key chemical:
Demand level directly r<
lated to F-ll, F-12, & F-<
Demand level directly r<
lated to F-ll & F-12
    Includes methyl chloride,  methylene chloride,  chloroform,  carbon
    tetrachloride,  perchloroethylene,  trichloroethylene,  methyl chloro-
    form,  and vinyl chloride.

    Includes chlorine demand for chloroform utilized in production of
    F-22 and carbon tetrachloride used in production of F-ll and F-12.
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc. estimates.
                                 VI-23

-------
                  Table VI-11. U.S. CHLORINE PRODUCERS - 1973






Company


Dow Chemical
PPG Industries
Diamond Shamrock
Occidental Petroleum
Allied Chemical
01 in
BASF Wyandotte
Stauffer Chemical
Pennwalt
FMC
Ethyl Corporation
Kaiser
Shell 0 il
Vulcan Materials
DuPont
B. F. Goodrich
Monsanto
Paper companies
Other
Total
Production (1973)






Capacity a
(million
Ib/yr.)
7,920
2,400
2,304
1,930
1,188
1,170
1,116
706
684
568
460
386
270
270
244
216
180
496
1,888
24,396
20,804




Percent of
total
capacity


31.9%
9.7
9.3
7.8
4.8
4.7
4.5
2.8
2.7
2.3
1.9
1.6
1.1
1.1
1.0
0.8
0.7
2.0
7.6
100.0%





K
Value of
Production
($million)

157.9
47.8
45.9
38.5
23.7
23.3
22.2
14.1
13.6
11.3
9.2
7.7
5.4
5,4
4.9
4.3
3.6
9.9
37.8
486.5




Total
company
chemical
sales
($million)

2,250
440
454
1,080
1,114
370
356
621
246
745
499
N/A
748
62
4,250
452
. 2,355




Value of
production
as a percent
of total
company
chemical
sales


7.0
10.8
10.1
3.6
2.2
2.3
6.2
2.3
5.5
1.5
1.8

0.7
8.7
0.1
1.0
0.2




aCapacity as of January 1, 1975




 Based on average value of commercial shipments of $46.77/ton in 1973




Sources; Chemical Marketing  Reporter. U.S.  Dept.  of  Commerce, Current  Industrial




         Reports Series M28A;  and company annual  reports.
                                      VI-24

-------
measure of the Importance of chlorine production to the company's total




chemical sales.  Although the total chlorine requirement for the pro-




duction of fluorocarbons F-ll, F-12 and F-22, carbon tetrachloride and




methyl chloroform represents approximately 13 percent of total domestic




chlorine demand, the value of chlorine production related to these com-




pounds is less than one to two percent of total company chemical sales




for most of the chlorine producers.  There are instances where a company's




chlorine production is more dependent on these chemicals than the typical




level of several percent.  In particular, Vulcan Materials utilizes a




high portion (ca. 15 percent) of its chlorine production for the produc-




tion of chloroform, carbon tetrachloride, and methyl chloroform.  There-




fore, Vulcan's chlorine production level may be more severely affected




than others' if limitations are placed on these chemicals or the fluoro-




carbons derived from them.  The details of Vulcan's position (and those




of other manufacturers) are discussed later in this chapter.




     The chlorine industry is dominated by Dow Chemical which has. 32




percent of total U.S. capacity.  The second largest producer, PPG Indus-



tries, has only 10 percent of U.S. capacity.  The industry is relatively




concentrated, with the top seven producers having over 70 percent of




total capacity.  Capacity utilization for chlorine production was rela-




tively high in 1974 and chlorine was generally in tight supply.  However,




the economic downturn in late 1974 and early 1975, coupled with recent




capacity additions, has reduced industry capacity utilization and has




made the supply of chlorine more plentiful.




     Because of the uncertainties surrounding a number of environmental




or health considerations relating to chemicals derived from chlorine






                                  VI-25

-------
 (i.e., vinyl chloride and fluorocarbons) and the lead time in constructing




 new chlorine production capacity, it is possible that there will be




 limited capacity expansions over the next several years.  If the economy




 turns around as expected in late 1975 and early 1976, chlorine could




 again be in tight supply by 1977/78.  This could mitigate the impact of




 reduced demand resulting from restrictions on the production or use of




 certain fluorocarbons or chlorocarbons.




     Estimated employment in the production of chlorine is 10,300 employees




 based on reported employment in "Chlorine and Alkalis," Census of Manu-




 factures, 1972.  Related employment for chlorine used in the production



 of methyl chloroform, carbon tetrachloride, and chloroform (for fluoro-




 carbons only) is an estimated 1,350 employees — pro-rated based on 13.0




 percent of total chlorine demand utilized in the production of these three




 chlorocarbons.




 b.  Hydrofluoric Acid - Hydrofluoric acid (HF) is a major raw material in




 the production of fluorocarbons.  The use of hydrofluoric acid in fluoro-




 carbons represents a major portion of the total end-use of hydrofluoric



 acid:   about 42  percent of  the  total domestic  hydrofluoric acid demand




 in 1973.  The other major uses of hydrofluoric acid are in the production




of aluminum, in petroleum refining, the production of fluoride salts,




 stainless steel pickling,  uranium processing,  and miscellaneous applica-




 tions.  Total production of hydrofluoric acid was 731 million pounds in




1973.   A large portion of hydrofluoric acid is used captively (50.8 percent




in 1973).   The total value of production in 1973 was $135.6 million,




assuming that production is valued at the average price for merchant
                                   VI-26

-------
manufacturer's sales of $18.55 per 100 pounds.  The value of production




related to fluorocarbon production was $56.3 million in 1973 (42 percent




of total value).




     Table VI-12 presents the major U.S. producers of hydrofluoric acid




and their production capacities.  In addition, the table shows estimated




value of HF production (based on each producer's proportional share of




total production) and the value of production as a percent of each com-




pany's total chemical sales in 1973.  One fact stands out:  the value of




production of hydrofluoric acid for Essex Chemical was 19.5 percent of




total chemical sales, a substantial portion of the total company chemical




sales in 1973.  A large portion of Essex's hydrofluoric acid production




is utilized in the production of fluorocarbons via a partially owned




subsidiary, Racon.




     Production of hydrofluoric acid in the U.S. is highly concentrated.




Allied Chemical and DuPont share over 50 percent of U.S. production




capacity.  As indicated above, a large portion of hydrofluoric acid pro-




duction is utilized in the manufacture of fluorocarbons.  Furthermore,




some companies are more dependent on the production of fluorocarbons than




others.  Essex Chemical is an example of one of these companies.  On the




other hand, producers of hydrofluoric acid such as Alcoa and Kaiser would




be less severely affected because their production of hydrofluoric acid




is predominantly used in the production of aluminum.




     Total estimated employment in the production of hydrofluoric acid




is 800.  Employment related to the production of fluorocarbons (F-ll,




F-12, F-22) is estimated to be 330 based on the percent of total HF pro-




duction used in the production of fluorocarbons (41.6 percent)..  A






                                  VI-27

-------
        Table VI-12. U.S. HYDROFLUORIC ACID PRODUCERS - 1973






Producer


Allied Chemical
DuPont
Alcoa
Kaiser
Pennwalt
Harshaw Chemical
(Division of Kewanee Oil)
Stauffer Chemical
01 in
Essex Chemical
Total
Production






Capacity
( million
Ih/vr.l
216
200
110
100
50

36
36
26
32
796
731. O1





Value of a
production
($millipn)

36.8
34.1
18.7
17.0
8.5

6.1
6.1
4.4
3.7

135.4



Total
company
chemical
sales
($million)

1,114
4,250
N/A
N/A
246

140
621
370
19


Value of
production
as a percent
of total
company
chemical
Sales


3.3%
0.8


3.4

4.4
1.0
1.2
19.5


 91.8% capacity utilization
Fluorocarbon

F-ll
F-12
F-2?
Production
(million Ib)
333.8
489
136.5
HF Consumption
(million Ib)
55
180
70
305
Percent of
total HF

7.5%
24.6
9.5
41.6%
 aBased on $18.55/100 Ib in 1973

Sources:  Chemical Marketing Reporter. U.S. International Trade Commission,
          U.S.  Dept. of Commerce, Current Industrial Reports Series M28A;
          company annual reports; and Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                                     VI-28

-------
summary of estimated employment in the production of hydrofluoric acid




is presented in Table VI-13.




     The hydrofluoric acid producers operated under a high level of




capacity utilization in 1973:  91.8 percent of total domestic capacity.




In 1974 capacity utilization dropped to approximately 80 percent of




total capacity because of reduced demand for fluorocarbons and aluminum.




Historic growth over the 1963-1973 time period for hydrofluoric acid was




approximately 7.5 percent per year.  Future growth of hydrofluoric acid




is expected to be lower than historical levels.  One reason is that in




the aluminum industry hydrofluoric acid is being replaced by fluosilicic




acid.  Also, the recycling of fluorides in waste water treatment programs




is reducing demand for hydrofluoric acid.  Finally, increased imports




from Mexico and Canada are expected to replace future domestic production




growth of hydrofluoric acid.
                                 VI-29

-------
        Table VI-13. EMPLOYMENT IN HYDROFLUORIC ACID PRODUCTION

Production workers
Sales, technical and
Other overhead staff
Total employment in
HF production
Total HF
Related to
Fluorocarbon
Production
Million Pounds of
production per employee

1.3
3.0


HF production
(million Ib)
731
731

305
Employment
560
240
800'
330
Sources:  U.S. Dept. of Commerce, Current Industrial Reports Series M28A;
          and Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates based on discussions with
          industry.
                              VI-30

-------
2.  Basic Chemicals




a.   Fluorocarbons - There are six companies in the United States presently




manufacturing fluorocarbons, of which three companies account for 85 percent




of total domestic capacity.  DuPont, Allied Chemical, and Union Carbide are




the principal producers with 41.8 percent, 25.9 percent and 16.7 percent




respectively of domestic capacity in 1973.




     The total manufacturer's value of fluorocarbons was $242.1 million in 1973




as shown in Table VI-14. This value of fluorocarbon production is an estimate,




since each producer manufacturers a different proportion of the various fluoro-




carbons.   It  is  assumed that  the average  value of  fluorocarbons  production




at the manufacturer's  level was 25.2$ per pound in 1973.  The historical




growth rate of fluorocarbon production from 1962-1972 has been 8 percent



annually.  Future  growth had  been estimated at 5 percent per year, assuming



unrestricted  use.




   Table VI-15 summarizes the chemicals sales of the major producers of




fluorocarbons and their related value of production of fluorocarbons.




Fluorocarbon production value  ranges from  30.8 percent of total chemical sales




for Racon in 1973 to 9.5 percent and 5.6 percent of total chemical sales in




1973 for Pennwalt and Allied Chemical.  For the remaining companies the




value of production of fluorocarbons represents less than 3 percent of total




company chemical sales.




     Estimated employment in the production of fluorocarbons is 2200-2700




employees.   This estimate is based on industry contacts and on an estimate




determined through related employment figures in the Census of Manufactures,




1972.  The production of fluorocarbons represents 2.7 percent of the total
                                   VI-31

-------
                                      Table VI-14.  U.S.  FLUOROCARBON MANUFACTURERS -1973
<
M


K>

acity (million Ib/yr)
cent of U.S. capacity
duction (million Ib/yr)

ufacturer's value
$million)
Allied
Chemical
310
25.9%
248

$62.7
DuPont
500
41.8%
401

$101.5
Kaiser
50
4.2%
40

$10.1
Pennwalt
115
9.6%
92

$23.3
Racon
20
1.7%
16

$4.0
Union
Carbide
200
16.7%
160

$40.5
TOTAL
1,195
100%
957
b
$242.1
               aincludes F-ll, F-12, F-22

                manufacturer's value based on 1975 price is estimated at $450-500 million
           	Sources:   Chemical Marketing Reporter., U.S. International Trade Commission, and Arthur D. Little,

                         Inc.,  estimates.

-------
                              Table VI-15.  DEPENDENCE OF MANUFACTURERS ON FLUOROCARBON SALES
OJ
u>
Company
Allied Chemical
DuPont
Kaiser
Pennwalt
Racon a
Union Carbide
Total chemical sales
(1973, $ million)
$1,114
4,250
375
246
13
2,400
Value of fluoro carbon
production
($ million)
$62.7
101.5
10.1
23.3
4.0
40.5
Percent of total
chemical sales
5.6%
2.4
2.7
9.5
30.8
1.7
               aRacon's sales are 100% dependent on fluorocarbons;  manufacturer's value of production

                understates actual retail sales level.
               Sources: Corporate  annual reports, and Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.

-------
value of shipments of Industrial Organic Chemicals, N.E.C.   Based on this




proportion, employment In fluorocarbon production Is an estimated 2700




employees, Including production workers and related employment.
                              VI-34

-------
b.   Chlorocarbons - An analysis of the chlorocarbon industry in the United

States shows that nearly the entire volume of the nine& chlorocarbons dis-

cussed below were produced by fourteen companies in 1973.  Of these four-

teen companies, eight manufacture five or more of the chlorocarbons.  However,

for individual chemicals, the industry is often dominated by a few large

chemical companies.  Over 70 percent of these chlorocarbons are used as a

chemical intermediate in the production of other chemicals, although if

ethylene dichloride use for the production of vinyl chloride is excluded,

approximately 30 percent of these chlorocarbons are used as chemical inter-

mediates.  Therefore, there is often a high level of captive use of the

chlorocarbons and the value of production is included in the final product

produced.  Since it is difficult to determine a company's captive use vs.

merchant sales (this information is generally proprietary), the manufac-

turer's value of production has been determined for each company's pro-

duction of chlorocarbons as a measure of their importance in relation to

each producer's total chemical sales.

    TableVI-16 summarizes estimated production and manufacturer's value of

carbon tetrachloride for the principal producers.  These estimates are pro-

rated based on each producer's share of production capacity and an estimated

average production value for carbon tetrachloride in 1973.   The estimated
Q
 Carbon tetrachloride, chloroform, ethyl chloride, ethylene dichloride,
 methyl chloride, methyl chloroform, methylene chloride, perchloroethylene,
 and trichloroethylene.  Vinyl chloride is treated separately at the end of
 this section.
                                   VI-.35

-------
                             Table VI-16.   U.S.  CARBON TETRACHLORIDE MANUFACTURERS - 1973

Capacity (million Ib/yr)
Percent of total U.S. capacity
Production (million Ib/yr)
f*
Production value ($ million)
Allied
Chemical
8
0.5
5
0.3
Dow
275
17.4
182
10.9
DuPont
500
31.7
332
19.9
FMC
300
19.0
199
11.9
Stauffer
420
26.6
279
16.7
Vulcan
Jteterials
75
4.8
50
3.0
Total
1578
100
1047
62.7
M

U)
         a
          1975 capacity estimates.

           Based on proportional share of total domestic capacity.
           Based on average price of merchant sales in 1973.
          Sources:   Directory of Chemical Producers,  U.S.  International Trade Commission, and
                    Arthur D. Little,  Inc.,  estimates.

-------
total manufacturer's value of carbon tetrachloride produced in the United

States was $62.7 million in 1973.   The estimate for DuPont is overstated

because, DuPont's carbon tetrachloride production capacity was operating

well below reported capacity estimates in 1973.

     U.S. production of carbon tetrachloride has grown at an average annual

rate of 7.3 percent from 1963-1973 and 6.8 percent from 1968-1973 with even

lower growth in recent years.  Future growth has been anticipated to con-

tinue at about 5 percent per year through 1977, however, carbon tetrachlo-

ride growth is dependent on fluorocarbon growth which is currently unpre-

dictable.

     The principal United States producers of chloroform and their

related production capacities are summarized in Table VI-17.  There are six

domestic producers while two producers, Dow and Sfcauffer, have 42.2 percent

and 24.4 percent respectively or 66.6 percent of total domestic capacity.

The estimated production value of chloroform was $17.7 million for 1973 and
                          j                                   {            .
the producers operated at an estimated 82 percent of production capacity.

Since the production capacities are flexible, the capacity utilization esti-

mate is based on reported capacities and does not'reflect the producers

ability to shift production to other coproducts in the thermochlorination

process.

     U.S. production of chloroform increased at an average annual rate of

9.2 percent between 1963 and 1973.  Growth over the last five years has been

only 6.8 percent per year,and at an even lower rate recently.  Ultimately

the demand for chloroform depends on the demand for fluorocarbon refrigerants
                                  VI-37

-------
                           Table VI-17. u-s- CHLOROFORM MANUFACTURERS - 1973
Capacity (million
pounds per year)
Percent of total
U.S. capacity
Production (million
pounds per year)
Production value
($ million)
Allied
Chemical
30
9.7
25
1.7
Diamond
Shamrock
18
5.8
.15
1.0
Dow
130
42.2
107
7.5
DuPont
15
4.9
12
0.9
Stauffer
75
24.4
62
4.3
Vulcan
Materials
40
13.0
33
2.3
Total
308
100
254
17.7
OJ
oo
     Sources:  Directory  of  Chemical Producers, U.S.  International  Trade Commision,  and

              Arthur D.  Little,  Inc.,  estimates.

-------
and for fluorocarboo plastics.   Demand is expected to grow at  an  average

rate of 5 percent per year over the next five years with the largest pro-

portional increase from the increased production of fluorocarbon polymers.

This forecast assumes no limitations are placed on fluorocarbons for use

in refrigeration or plastics.

     Ethyl chloride is produced by six companies in the United States with

Ethyl Corporation,the major producer,having over 40 percent of total pro-

duction capacity.  The major producers and related capacities are summa-

rized in Table VI-18.   The estimated production value of ethyl chloride in

1973 was $46.3 million and producers were operating at 77 percent of capa-

city.  Since ethyl chloride is principally used as a chemical intermediate

in the production of tetraethyl lead, there is a high level of captive con-

sumption (59 percent in 1973).

     Growth in production of ethyl chloride has been static over the past

five years because of environmental pressures against tetraethyl lead.

Future growth is uncertain, and is dependent on environmental restric-

tions on leaded gasoline as well as reduced growth in demand for gasoline

as a result of energy conservation efforts.

     Ethylene dichloride is the most important chlorocarbon in terms of
                           .  \
production volume and market value.  The reported sales value is low be-

cause of the large amount of captive use of the product (which was 85 percent

in 1973) but estimated production value was $279.3 million (see TableVI-19).
                               VI-39.

-------
                           TableVI-18. U.S. ETHYL CHLORIDE MANUFACTURERS - 1973
Capacity (million pounds per
year)
Percent of total U.S. capacity
Production (million pounds
per year)
Production value ($ million)
American
Chemical3
110
12.8
85
5.9
Dow
75
8.7
57
4.0
DuPont
110
12.8
85
5.9
Ethyl
Corp.
360
41.9
277
19.4
PPG
120
14.0
92
6.5
'
Shell
85
9.9
65
4.6
Total
860
100
661
46.3
<
l-l
I

o
       a American Chemical has been consolidated into Stauffer Chemical Corporation



       Sources:  Directory  of  Chemical Producers, U.S.  International Trade Commission, and

                 Arthur D.  Little,  Inc.,  estimates.

-------
                      Table VI-19.  U.S. ETHYLENE BICHLORIDE MANUFACTURERS - 1973

Capacity
(million :"
pounds per
year)
Percent of '•
total U.S..
capacity
Production
(million
pounds per
year)
Production
Value
($ million)
Allied
Chemical
650



5.3


:493



14.8


American
Chera.
Corp.3
235


<••
1.9


177



5.3


Conoco
1000



8.2


762



"22.9


Diamond
Shamrock
-260



2.1


195



5.9


Dow
3560



29.0


2695



80.9


Ethyl
Corp.
810


*•
6.6


613



18.4


B.F.
Goodrich
900



7.3
-

678



20.4


Jefferson
Chem. Co.
70



0.6


56


-
1.7 .


PPG
1835



15.0


1394



41.8


Shell
2400


-'
19.6


1821



54.6


Union
Carbide
300



2.5


232



7.0


Vulcan
Materials
240



2.0


186



• 5.6

-.
Total
12,260



100


9,302



279.3

..
  American Chemical has been consolidated  into Stauffer Chemical Corporation.
 joint venture with Texaco and American Cyanatnid: no longer a producer.
Sources:  Directory of Chemical Producers,  U.S. International Trade Commission,  and Arthur D. Little,  Inc., estimates.

-------
     There are twelve producers of ethylene dichloride, although the three


largest manufacturers have 64 percent of domestic production capacity.   Dow,


Shell, and PPG Industries had 29 percent, 20 percent and 15 percent of


domestic production capacity respectively in 1973.  Based on reported pro-
                                     t-

duction, the industry was operating at approximately 75 percent of capacity


in 1973.


     U.S. production of ethylene dichloride had an annual average growth


rate of 16 percent between 1960 and 1973.  Future growth by the industry


is estimated to be 8-9 percent per year.  The demand for ethylene dichloride


depends heavily on demand for vinyl chloride which consumes greater than


85 percent of the ethylene dichloride production.  Environmental pressures


may reduce demand for ethylene dichloride for vinyl chloride and trichloro-


ethylene production.   In addition, the demand for ethylene dichloride as


a lead scavenger may be reduced if the trend toward unleaded gasoline con-


tinues.


     Methyl chloride and methylene chloride producers and related capacities


are summarized in Table VI-20. There are eleven producers of methyl chloride,


although four producers have 73.5 percent of total production capacity.  Dow,


Conoco, DuPont and Ethyl Corporation have 34.0 percent, 15.5 percent,


12.4 percent and 11.6 percent of domestic capacity respectively.  The pro-


duction value of methyl chloride for these eleven companies was $32.8 million


in 1973, and capacity utilization was 84 percent of total domestic capacity.


Since methyl chloride is principally used as a chemical intermediate, there


was a high level of captive use (greater than 50 percent) in 1973.
                                 VI-42

-------
                    Table VI-20.   U.S. METHYL CHLORIDE AND METHYLENE CHLORIDE MANUFACTURERS - 1973
Methyl Chloride
Capacity (million
pounds per year)
Percent of total
U.S. capacity
Production (million
pounds per year)
Production Value
($ million)
Methylene Chloride
Capacity (million
pounds per year)
Percent of total
U.S. capacity
Production (million
pounds per year)
Production Value
($ million)
Allied
Chemical

25
3.9
21
1.3
50
9.4
49
3.9
Conoco

100
15.5
84
5.1
-
-
-
—
Diamond
Shamrock

25
3.9
21
1.3
60
11.3
59
4.7
Dow

220
34.0
185
11.1
240
45.3
236
18.8
Dow
Corning

35
5.4
29
1.7
10
1.9
10
0.8
DuPont

80
12.4
68
4.1
40
7.6
40
3.2
Ethyl
Corp.

75
11.6
63
3.8
-
-
-
—
General
Electric

20
3.1
17
1.0
-
-
-
^
Stauffer

15
2.3
13
0.8 -
60
11.3
59
4.7
Union
Carbide

50
7.7
42
2.5
-
-
-
—
Vulcan
Materials

2
0.3
1
0.1
70
13.2
.69
5.5
Total

647
100
544
32.8
530
100
522
41.6
<
M

*«
          Sources:  Directory of Chemical Producers. U.S.  International Trade Commission, and Arthur  D. Little, Inc., estimates.

-------
     U.S. production of methyl chloride increased at an average annual




rate of 15 percent between 1962 and 1972, however, since 1969 it has av-




eraged only 4 percent growth per year.  The slow rate of growth in recent




years is due to uncertain demand from the tetramethyl lead end-use sector.




However, a surplus of methyl chloride does not exist in the market and




supplies are currently snug due to limited availability of methanol.  The




future of the tetramethyl lead market plus the availability of methanol




will affect future growth of methyl chloride most significantly and probably




will limit it to moderate to static growth.




     Methylene chloride had an estimated production value of $41.6 million:




in 1973 with a small captive usage of approximatley 10 percent.  There




are seven producers with four companies having greater than 80 percent of




total capacity.   Capacity utilization was an estimated 98 percent in 1973.




     U.S. production of methylene chloride has grown at an average annual




rate of 13 percent between 1963 and 1973.  This average rate has slowed




during the last five years when growth of methylene chloride production




declined to 12 percent per year.  However, exports seem to have accounted




for a large measure of this growth.  Anticipated future growth for methylene




chloride consumption is forecast at an average of 8 percent per year.




     The producers of methyl chloroform and their related production capa-




cities are summarized in Table VI-21.  The production of methyl chloroform




is high concentrated with only four domestic producers.  Two companies,




Dow Chemical and PPG Industries, account for 81.8 percent of U.S. production




capacity with 54.8 percent and 27.8 percent of total capacity respectively.
                                VI-44

-------
          Table VI-21. U.S. METHYL CHLOROFORM MANUFACTURERS -1973

Capacity (million Ib/yr)
Percent of total U.S.
capacity
Production (million Ib/yr)
Production value ($million)
Dow
340

54.0
244
22.0
Ethyl
Corp.
50

7.9
36
3.2
PPG
175

27.8
126
11.3
Vulcan
Materials
65

10.3
47
4.2
Total
630

100%
453
40.7
Sources:   Directory of Chemical Producers.   U.S.  International Trade
          Commission,  and Arthur D.  Little,  Inc.  estimates.
                                   VI-45

-------
Methyl chloroform producers were operating at an estimated   71.7 percent of




total capacity In 1973»with a total production value of $40.7 million.




     In the past decade methyl chloroform has experienced a 15 percent




average annual growth rate.  Industry estimates place future growth rates




at 8 percent annually, although the outlook depends upon environmental  con-




siderations.  Methyl chloroform is a substitute product, in some aspects




of metal cleaning, for trichloroethylene which has come under increasingly




restricted use because of air pollution control regulations.  If further




restrictions are placed upon trichloroethylene, the demand for methyl




chloroform could increase at greater than 8 percent per year assuming there




are no environmental restrictions placed on methyl chloroform  as well.




     The domestic producers of perchloroethylene and trichloroethylene and




their related capacities are shown in Table VI-22. The production of tri-




chloroethylene is concentrated with five principal producers in the United




States.  PPG Industries and Dow Chemical also dominate the production of




trichloroethylene with 45 percent and 24 percent of domestic production




capacity respectively.  The total production value for trichloroethylene




was $31.8 million in 1973, and capacity utilization was approximately




73 percent.




     Trichloroethylene has grown at an average annual rate of approximately




2 percent from 1963-1973.  Industry estimates range from no growth to a




6 percent decline through 1977.  In 1966 trichloroethylene was restricted




under Los Angeles' Rule 66 as a measure to control air pollution.  Since




1966, other states have passed similar legislation and producers' have put




off planned capacity expansions.
                                  VI-46

-------
              Table VI-22.   U-S. TRICHLOROETHYLENE AND PERCHLOROETHYLENE MANUFACTURERS - 1973
Trichloroethylene
Capacity (million pounds
per year)
Percent of total U.S.
capacity
Production (million pounds
per year)
Production value ($million
Perchloroethylene
Capacity (million pounds
per year)
Percent of total U.S.
capacity
Production (million
pounds per year)
Production value ($million
Diamond
Shamrock

100
16.1
73
5.1

160
15.7
111
6.6
Dow
Chemical

150
24.2 c
109
7.7

290
28.4
201
12.0
Ethyl
Corp.

50
8. 17
37
2.6

50
4.9
35
2,1
Occidental/
Hooker Chemical

40
6.5 ..
29
2.1

50
4.9
35
2.1
PPG

280
45.2
204
14.3

200
19.6
138
8.3
Stauffer
-
—
-
-
-

70
6.9
49
2.9
Vulcan
Materials

— •
•



200
19.6
138
8.3
Total

620
100
452
31.8

1020
100
707
42.3
M
I
       Sources:  Chemical Marketing Reporter, U.S. International Trade Commission, and Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.

-------
     Production of perchloroethylene is less concentrated than that of


trichloroethylene, with seven domestic producers.  Three producers account


for 67.6 percent of total capacity and Dow, PPG Industries and Vulcan


Materials have 28.4 percent, 19.6 percent and 19,6 percent of capacity


respectively.  The 1973 production value of perchloroethylene was $42.3


million and estimated capacity utilization wa.s 69 pt>rc<:ut in 1973.


     For the past decade perchloroethylene production has grown at an


average annual growth rate of 8 percent.  The future outlook depends upon


the dry cleaning market which is expected to grow .it 4-5 percent annually.


If increased environmental restrictions are placed on trichloroethylene,


perchloroethylene could potentially benefit as a partial replacement for


trichloroethylene.


     Employment in the production of the nine chlorocarbons discussed above


is an estimated 6,600 employees including both direct and related production

          n    •    •   '
personnel.    The employement estimate is based on industry contacts as well


as data from the Census of Manufacturers, 1972.  The production value of the


nine chlorocarbons represents 6.6 percent of the total value of shipment in


SIC 2869, "Industrial Organic Chemicals, N.E.I':."


   Table VI-23 summarizes the principal producers of chlorocarbons, their


total chemical sales in 1973 and related value of domestic production of


chlorocarbons.  Included is a summary of the value o.f various chlorocarbons


as a percent of these companies' total chemical sales.  For example, the-


combined value of production of chloroform, carbon tetrachloride, and methyl
 Based on 100,400 employees engaged in the production of industrial
 organic chemicals.
                                   VI-43

-------
                                    Table VI-23 U.S. CHLOROCARBON INDUSTRY - 1973
Company
Allied Chemical
American Chemical**
Conoco
Diamond Shamrock
Dow Chemical
Dow Corning
DuPont
FMC
Ethyl Corp.
General Elec.
B.F. Goodrich
Jefferson Chemical
Occidental
PPG
Shell Oil
Stauffer
Union Carbide
Vulcan Materials
Total
Chemical
Sales
(1973)
($ million)
1,114
621
221
454
2,250
NA
4,250
745
499
NA
452
NA
1,080
440
748
621
2,400
62
Value of3
Chlorocarbon
Production
($ million)
22.0
11.2
28.0
24.6
174.9
2.5
34.0
11.9
49.5
1.0
20.4
1.7
4.2
82.2
59.2
29.4
9.5
29.0
% of Total
Chemical
Sales
2.0
1.8
12.7
5.4
7.8
NA
0.8
1.6
9.9
NA
4.5
-
0.4
18.7
7.9
4.7
0.4
46.8
Value of Chloro-
carbon Production
Excluding Ethylene
Dichloride
($ million)
7.2
5.9
5.1
18.7
94.0
2.5
34.0
11.9
31.1
1.0
-
-
4.2
40.4
4.6
29.4
2.5
23.4
% of
Total
Chemical
Sales
0.6
.1.0
2.3
4.1
4.2
NA
0.8
1.6
6.2
NA
-
-
0.4
9.2
0.6
4.7
0.1
37.7
Value of
chloroform,
carbon tetra-
chloride .methyl
chloroform
($ million)
2.0
0
-
1.0
40.4
-
20.8
11.9
3.2
-
-
-
-
11.3
-
21.0
-
9.5
% of
Total
Chemical
Sales
0.2
0
-
0.2
1.8
-
0.5
1.6
0.6
-
-
-
-
2.6
-
3.4
-
15.3
^includes methyl chloride, methylene chloride, chloroform, carbon tetrachloride, methyl chloroform,
<
V
VO
             perchloroethylene, trichloroethylene, ethylene dichloride, ethyl chloride
            ^American Chemical lias "been  consolidated into Stauffer  Chemical Corporation.
             Sources:  Corporate annual  reports and  Arthur D. Little,  Inc.  estimates.

-------
chloroform range from 0.2 percent of chemical sales for Allied Chemical to




15.3 percent of chemical sales for Vulcan Materials.



     Vinyl chloride monomer (VCM) is produced by a total of ten companies



with capacity, as of June 1974,  of  6-8 billion pounds per year.  There




is considerable concentration in the industry as the three largest firms




control about 56 percent of the capacity while the five largest control




nearly 80 percent.




     All but two of the VCM manufacturers produce the product by dehydro-




chlorinating (removing hydrogen chloride from) dry ethylene dichloride




(EDC).  This process accounts for 92 percent of the VCM capacity.  The




remaining capacity at two other plants produces VCM by adding hydrogen




chloride to acetylene in a reactor.  This latter process is the oldest




commercial process for producing VCM but it has been gradually phased out




because economics favor ethylene as a raw hydrocarbon feedstock over




acetylene.




     Over the last 10 years the production of VCM has grown at an annual




rate of about 13 percent from a level of 1.6 billion pounds in 1964.




The most phenomenal growth occurred during the latter part of the 1960's




when production increased at a rate of over 18 percent per year.  Since




1970 the rate of growth has been less than 9 percent per year.




     In 1975, PVC homopolymer and copolymer-resins were produced by 21




companies at 38 plants (see Table VI-24). of the 21 companies, between




two and six produced only copolymers at a total of 11 plants.  As was the




case with the VCM industry, a few firms account for much of the total




capacity.  Five companies control approximately 51 percent of total industry




capacity while the nine largest account for about 71 percent.
                               VI-50

-------
Table VI-24. PRODUCING COMPANIES, PLANT LOCATION, AND CAPACITIES-PVC HOMOPOLYMER
                                        RESINS
      Producing Company
                                    Plant location
                                Capacity-May,  1975
                             (millions of pounds/year)
   Air Products, Inc.


   Borden, Inc.


   Continental Oil Co.


   Diamond Shamrock Corp.


   Ethyl Corp.

   Firestone Tire Co.


   General Tire Co.


   Georgia-Pacific Corp.

   B. F. Goodrich Co.
   Goodyear Tire Co.
   Great American Chemi-
    cal Corp.

   Keysor-Century Corp.
               b
   Monsanto Co.

   Occidental Petroleum
    Corp. (Hooker Chemical

   Pantasote Co.
Calvert City, Kentucky
Pensacola, Florida

Illiopolis, Illinois
Leominster, Massachusetts

Aberdeen, Mississippi
Oklahoma City, Oklahoma

Delaware City, Delaware
Deer Park, Texas

Baton Rouge, Louisiana

Perryville, Maryland
Pottstown, Pennsylvania

Ashtabula, Ohio
Point Pleasant, W. Va.

Plaquemine, Louisiana

Avon Lake, Ohio
Henry, Illinois
Long Beach, California
Louisville, Kentucky
Pedricktown, New Jersey

Niagara Falls, New York
Plaquemine, Louisiana

Fitchburg, Massachusetts
Saugus, California

Springfield, Massachusetts

Burlington, New Jersey
Hicksville, New York

Passaic, New Jersey
Point Pleasant, W. Va.a
135
 75

140
180

260
220

115
270

180

230
270

125
 50

220

260
220
115
145
140

100
105

 70
 35

 70

168
 15

 60
 50
   Source:  EPA, details on  following  page.

                                      VI-51

-------
  Table VI-24 (cont.)  PRODUCING COMPANIES, PLANT LOCATION, AND CAPACITIES-
                               PVC HOMOPOLYMER RESINS
  Producing Company
 Plant Location
  Capacity-May,  1975
(millions of pounds/year)
Robintech, Inc.

Shintech, Inc.
Stauffer Chemical Co.
Tenneco Chemicals, Inc.
Union Carbide Corp.
Uniroyal, Inc.
Painesville, Ohio

Freeport, Texas

Delaware City, Delaware
Long Beach, California

Burlington, New Jersey
Flemington, New Jersey
Pasadena, Texas

South Charleston, W.Va.
Texas City, Texas

Painesville, Ohio
                TOTAL
          250

          220

          175
          150

          165
           70
          240

          160
          300

          108

        5,861
        a.   100 million tons per year plant at Point Pleasant.

        b .   Monsanto has announced it will close its plant by the end of 1975.

        c.   Shintech is a joint venture of Robintech and Shin-Etsu Chemical
            Industry Company Ltd. of Tokyo.

        d.   Stauffer purchased remaining 50 percent interest of the American
            Chemical Co. from Arco in 1974.
Sources:    Chemical Marketing Reporter, May 20, 1974; Modern Plastics.
            January 1975, p. 58; Non-confidential data supplied by
            industry under Section 114 of the Clean Air Act.
                                   VI-52

-------
     There is a limited amount of vertical integration within the PVC




industry from the production of EDC through resin processing.  Two companies




produce all four products (i.e., EDC, VCM, PVC homopolymer, PVC copolymer)




while another five companies manufacture three of the four products.  In




addition, 11 companies produce two of the four products.




     Over the last 10 years PVC consumption has grown at an annual rate of




around 11 percent, from a level of 1.6 billion pounds in 1964 to roughly




4.7 billion pounds in 1974.  However, the growth has been somewhat erratic.




From 1966 to 1971 PVC consumption grew at a nine percent annual rate, but in




1972 consumption increased by more than 27 percent over the 1971 level.




Consumption in 1973 rose another 9.7 percent before leveling off in 1974.




     The lack of detailed financial information for privately held corpora-




tions and profit data by vinyl chloride and polyvinyl chloride output




for publicly held firms make an assessment of the impact of a ban on



vinyl chloride difficult.  For 25 firms, dependency on vinyl chloride




and polyvinyl chloride production can be approximated by relating estimated




vinyl chloride and polyvinyl chloride sales to total sales (Table VI-25).




It should be recognized, however, that the estimated percentage of vinyl




chloride and polyvinyl chloride sales are not necessarily the same as the




estimated percentage of profits.  Based on the information on sales, three




of the 25 firms are judged to be highly dependent upon vinyl chloride and




polyvinyl chloride production, [Pantasote (19 percent), Great American




Chemical Corporation (43 percent) and .Robintech (68 percent)].
                              VI-53

-------
                                     Table VI-25.   ESTIMATED DEPENDENCE OF MANUFACTURERS ON PVC  SALES
I
in
Finn
Air Products and Chemical
Allied Chemical Corporation
C
Borden, Inc.
Continental Oil
Diamond Shamrock
Dow Chemical d
Ethyl Corporation
Firestone Tire Company
General Tire
Georgia Pacific '
B.F. Goodrich Company
Goodyear Tire Company
W. R. Graced
Great American Chemical Corp.
Keysor-Century
Monochem, Inc.
Capacities
(Millions of Pounds
Ethylene Vinyl
Bichloride Chloride
0
650
0
1000
110
3560
810
0
0
0
1000
-
-
-
-
-
0
340
0
730
0
1220
420
0
0
0
1000
-
-
-
-
300
Per Year)
Polyvinyl
Chloride
210
0
320
480
385
150
180
500
175
220
880
205
300
70
35
-
	 a —
Revenues Dependent on PVC
(Millions of 1973 Dollars )
Ethylene Vinyl Polyvinyl
Dichloride Chloride Chloride
-
3.00
-
2.35 12.5
-
81.62 53.50
4.32 12.0
-
-
-
6.00
. _
-
-
-
15.00
31.50
17.10
64.00
72.00
55.50
22.50
27.00
75.00
25.88
33.00
132.00
30.75
45.00
6.00
5.25
-
Total
31.50
20.10
64.00
86.85
55.50
157.62
43.32
75.00
25.88
33.00
138.00
30.75
45.00
6.00
5.25
15.00
Total
1973
Sales
Revenues
398.9
1501.0
2554.0
4510.0
667.1
3067.9'
713.7
3154.9
1380.0
2228.7
1661.0
4675.3
. 2807.8
14.04
HA
NA .
Percent si. les
Dependent
on PVCfe
8
1
3
2
8
5
6
2
2
1
8
1
2
43
NA
NA
         Source:   EPA,  based on contractors'  reports and industry contacts.    See notes on following page.

-------
                                Table VI-25(corit.)•    ESTIMATED  DEPENDENCE OF MANUFACTURERS ON PVC SALES
V
Firm
Monsanto
d
Morton - Norwich
Occidental Petroleum
Fantasote
PPG Industries
Robintech
Shell Oil Company
Stauffer Chemical Company . •
Tenneco Chemical Inc.
Union Carbide •
Uniroyal Inc.
Vulcan Materials
Capacities
(Millions of Pounds
Ethylene Vinyl
Bichloride Chloride
-
-
-
-
1835

2365
. .300
-
300
-
240
-
-
-
-
800
-
1600
170
255
-
-
'-
Per Year)
Polyvinyl
Chloride
70
150
183
108
-
250
-
325
415
460
108
-
Revenues Dependent on PVC"*
(Millions of 1973 Dollars )
Ethylene Vinyl Polyvinyl
Dichloride Chloride Chloride
10.50
22.50
26.45
16.20
21.80 40.0
250
70.0
1.00 48.75
1.00 35.25
60.00
16.20
13.50
Total
10.50
22.50
26.45
16.20
61.80
37.50
70.00
49.75
36.25
69.00
16.20
13.50
Total
1973
Sales
Revenues
2648
407
1980.4
86.79
1512.6
55.51
5749.6
NA
3940.0
3938.8
2090.0
325.3
Percent, sales
Dependent
on PVcb
negligible
6
3
19
4
68
1
NA
1
2
1
4
        a.   Estimated on the following assumptions:  $.05/lb for  EDC and VC; $.15/lb for general purpose PVC; it takes  1.58  Ibs.
             of EDC to make a Ib of  VC; it  takes 1 Ib of VC to make  a Ib of PVC; operating rate  100 percent; and intra-companv
             transfer of EDC and for VC revealed in the price of end product.  Ex. Allied Chemical Corp.
             [600-(342 x 1.58)] x $.05 + 342 x $.05 - 3.00 + 17.10 = 20.10
        b.
            Total Revenues Dependent on PVC + Total 1973 Sales Revenues.
        C.  Revenues were adjusted  to reflect the price of the copolymer (vinyl acetate)  produced here.  Price of that PVC copolymer
            was $.20/lb.
        d.  Plant capacity was not  known.  For each plant a 150 million pound/year capacity was assumed.

        Source:   EPA, based on contractors'  reports and industry  contacts.

-------
     The direct employment impacts of a vinyl chloride and polyvinyl chloride




ban are not known.  However, estimates of total vinyl chloride and polyvinyl




chloride plant employment are available, and indicate that 1,000 people are




employed in vinyl chloride production.  Banning vinyl chloride production




would end the need for the services of these people.  Although many skills




used in vinyl chloride production are readily transferable to other industries,




the extent of this transfer availability is not known, and it would not be




immediate.




     In the polyvinyl chloride industry, approximately 5,000 workers are




employed.  As in the vinyl chloride industry, many workers' skills are




transferable.  But, again, the degree to which these transfers are available




or will occur is not known.




     For vinyl chloride plants, the immediate regional impacts of a pro-




duction ban would be primarily upon the areas of southeastern Texas and




southern Louisiana where 12 out of the 15 vinyl chloride plants are located.




In certain instances, vinyl chloride output goes to other regions.  In these




cases, multiplier impacts in terms of decreased output, unemployment, and




lower income could be expected.




     For polyvinyl chloride plants, the immediate impact of a production




ban would be more dispersed geographically.  Although some polyvinyl




chloride plants are located in the southeast Texas/southern Louisiana area,




most are located in the eastern part of Delaware, New Jersey, New York and




Massachusetts.  As in the vinyl chloride case, multiplier impacts would




occur.
                               VI-56

-------
     The indirect impacts of a ban on vinyl chloride and polyvinyl chloride




production would be primarily upon the raw material suppliers (ethylene




dichloride producers send about 78 percent of their output to vinyl chloride




and polyvinyl chloride markets) and product output receivers (fabricators).




     For the vinyl chloride and polyvinyl chloride fabricating business,




it is estimated that the number of fabricators is 8,000.  It is not known




how many of the 8,000 are independent or how many are affiliated with larger




firms.  The viability of the fabricator has not been analyzed.  To the




extent that those firms are solely dependent on vinyl chloride and polyvinyl




chloride input, the occurrence of a significant impact with a vinyl chloride




and polyvinyl chloride ban is likely.




     In the fabrication of PVC, total direct and indirect related employment




is estimated to be 1.7 to 2.2 million jobs.  This amounts to over 1 percent




of the 1972 labor force.  (This figure includes not only persons employed




by fabricating companies, but also persons employed in utilization of the




fabricated products.
                              VI-57

-------
 3.  Chemical  Intermediates

     The principal chemical intermediate applications for the chlorocarbons
                 i
 and fluorocarbons under  evaluation  (excluding vinyl  chloride which has  been

 treated separately)  are  for the production  of tetramethyl and tetraethyl  lead,

 silicones, vinylidene  chloride, ethylene amines, and fluorocarbon resins.

     Tetramethyl and tetraethyl lead are produced from methyl chloride  and

 ethyl chloride respectively.  The principal producers and related capaci-

 ties of tetraethyl and tetramethyl lead are summarized in Table VI-26.   DuPont

 and Ethyl Corporation are  the major producers with over  80 percent of total

 industry capacity, and PPG Industries and Nalco Chemical make up the

 balance of production capacity.  Only the production of tetraethyl lead is

 reported.  Therefore, a reliable estimate of capacity utilization is not

 available because capacity estimates include production capacities for

 both tetraiiiethyl and tetraethyl lead.

     Historical growth has been 4 percent per year from  1967-1973.  No  future

 growth is expected because of environmental pressures on leaded gasoline.

 Some industry sources have estimated that production would decline 13 percent

 per year through 1978, if  catalytic exhaust converters are used on new  auto-

 mobiles .

     The principal producers of silicones (produced from methyl chloride)

are Dow Corning, General Electric, Stauffer, and Union Carbide.   Capacity

estimates and production figures are not available; therefore, at this

time it is difficult to accurately assess the value of production of

silicones in relation to these companies'  total sales.   Silicones are
                                   VI-58

-------
                        Table VI-26.  U.S. TETRAETHYL AND TETRAMETHYL LEAD MANUFACTURERS—1973
Ol
vo

Capacity (million Ib/yr
Percent of total U.S.
capacity
Production (million Ib/yr)

DuPont
340
41.0%

139.4

Ethyl Corp.
350
42.2%

149.0

Nalcb Chemical
40
4.8%

17.0

PPG
100
12.0%

42.4

TOTAL
830
100%

353.3
(TEL only
             Sources:  Chemical Marketing Reporter, U.S. international Trade Commission, and Arthur D. Little,
                       Inc., estimates.

-------
principally used in the production of specialty fluids, elastomers, and




resins.  Production for resin and elastomer uses is reported, but produc-




tion for the principal end use, silicone fluids, is not reported.  Reported




production for resins and elastomers was 18.4 and 37.0 million pounds in




1973, with production values of $35.3 and $82.1 million, respectively.




     Vlnylidene chloride is produced from ethylene dichloride, and in




1971 Dow began production of vinylidene chloride from methyl chloroform.




The principal producers are Dow, PPG Industries, and Vulcan Materials.




Vinylidene chloride is principally used to produce polyvinylidene chloride




(PVDC) for use in coating and films (e.g., Saran Wrap), and as a minor




component in certain copolymer resins.




     Ethylene amines are produced from ethylene dichloride.  Estimated




production was 64 million pounds in 1973.  Total capacity (based on mpno-




ethylenediamines) is 90 million pounds, and the principal producers, Dow




and Union Carbide having one third and two-thirds of total capacity, re-




spectively.  Ethylene amines are used principally in fungicides and as




chelating agents.  Recent growth was 7 percent per year; however, future




growth is expected to decline to 3 percent per year.




     There are a number of fluorocarbon resins and elastomers, although it




is estimated that polytetrafluoroethylene (PTFE) is the major fluorocarbon




plastic produced.  Manufacturers include DuPont (Teflon), Allied, Pennwalt,




and ICI.  Production of PTFE was 14 million pounds in 1973.
                               VI-60

-------
4.  Propellants




a.  Aeroaol Cans - The aerosol can market should be viewed as part of the




larger metal can Industry.  The rationale for this broader industry defi-




nition is the fact that the leading producers of aerosol containers and




related products are horizontally integrated and produce metal cans for




most of the wide variety of end-use segments in the overall industry.




     The Metal Can Industry - The' metal can industry is the largest of all




packaging sectors in the United States.  The value cf metal cans shipped




in  1973 was about $4.9 billion.  (This compares to about $4.4 billion for




corrugated containers, the second largest packaging sector.)  Table VI-27




shows a breakdown of U.S. metal can shipments by end-use.  Here it can be




seen that there were about 83.4 billion units shipped in 1973, and that




the beverage market was the largest sector, accounting for about 50 per-



cent of this total.




     Metal can industry shipments have increased from 1968 to 1973 at



about 5 percent per year.   The beverage can market has been the fastest




growing sector in the industry with a 9.5 percent per year growth rate over




this period.   Factors contributing to this growth are the beverage can's




superior convenience, filling and handling characteristics, compared to




the glass bottle.  In contrast to the beverage can market, the food can




market has grown at only 1.5 percent per year from 1968 to 1973.  Although




canning is still the major food processing method, the food can market is




expanding at a lower rate of growth due in part to the impact of newer and




faster growing frozen food processing techniques.  The general packaging can




market consists  of relatively mature end-uses such as antifreeze (heavily im-




pacted by plastic can penetration)  paint and motor oil.  This market has
                                   VI-61

-------
      Table VI-27.  U.S. METAL CAN SHIPMENTS - 1973


Beverage cians
Beer
Soft drink
Total beverage cans
Food cans
Vegetables & juices
Fruits & juices
Meat & poultry
Fish & seafood
Evaporated & condensed milk
and other dairy products
Coffee
Baby food
Lard & shortening
Miscellaneous foods
Total food cans
General packaging cans
Aerosols
Motor oil
Paint
Other
Total general packaging cans
Pet food

Total metal can shipments

Billion units

24.0
17.7
41.7

10.5
5.8
1.8
1.7
1.5

0.8
0.7
0.4
7.8
31.0

3.0
0.8
0.8
2.3
6.9
- JUi

83.4
Percent of
total shipments

28.8
21.2
50.0

12.6
6.9
2.1
2.0



13.4


37.0
"
3.6
1.0
1.0
2.8
8.4
4.6

100 . 0
Sources:   Can Manufacturers Institute,  U.S.  Department  of  Commerce -
          Current Industrial Reports Series  M34D,  and Arthur D.  Little,
          Inc.,  estimates.
                                 VI-62

-------
grown at less than 1 percent per year over the five year period ending in


1973.  (One exception to the,mature growth characteristics of the general


packaging can market is the aerosol sector which is discussed in the fol-


lowing section.)


     The Aerosol Container Market - The value of aerosol cans shipped in


1973 was about $190 million which is about 3.9 percent of the total value


of shipments in the overall metal can industry.  As shown in Table VI-27


there were about 3.0 billion aerosol cans shipped in 1973, or about 3.6 per-


cent of total industry shipments.  The difference .between the aerosol in-


dustry's percentage of total value of shipments compared to its percentage


of total units shipped reflects the fact that aerosol containers have a


higher average unit value than the average value of cans in the industry


as a whole.  This is due to the fact that the aerosol container is a rela-


tively complex and expensive package, which is justified only by its great

                                /
convenience value in many diverse applications.  Table VI-28 shows a break-


down of 1973 aerosol container shipments by end-use.  The two largest


aerosol applications are deodorants/anti-perspirants and hair care products


with nearly 20 percent and 16 percent respectively of the total aerosol con-


tainer market. About 85 percent of the personal product applications


use a fluorocarbon type propellant.  Thus, this sector, which accounts for


half of the total aerosol market in terms of units shipped, has the greatest


potential for economic impact under a ban of fluorocarbon use.  About 15-20


percent of household products applications and about10 percent of the miscel-


laneous category also currently use fluorocarbon type propellants.
                                    VI-63

-------
Table VI-28.  U.S. AEROSOL CONTAINER SHIPMENTS - 1973


Personal products
Deodorants & anti-perspirants
Hair care products
Shaving lather
Colognes and perfumes
Medic inals & Pharmaceuticals
Other
Total personal products
Household products
Cleaners
Room deodorants & disinfectants
Laundry/starch products
Waxes & polishes
Other
Total household products
Miscellaneous
Coatings and finishes
Insect sprays
Industrial products
Foods
Automotive products
Other
Total miscellaneous
Total aerosol container
shipments
Million units


580
470
170
140
70
70
1,500

210
170
160
100
40
680

270
140
120
110
90
50
780
2,960

Percent of total
shipments

19.6
15.9
5.7
4.7
2.4
2.4
50.7

7.1
5.7
5.4
3.4
1.4
23.0

9.1
4.7
4.1
3.7
3.0
1.7
26.3
100

 Source:  Chemical Specialties Manufacturers Association, Modern
          Packaging  and Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                               VI-64

-------
     The aerosol container market has been the second fastest growing



market in the overall metal can industry (next to the beverage can market)



with a 6.5 percent growth rate from 1968 to 1973. , The miscellaneous products



category has grown the fastest since 1968, at about 8.5 percent per year.



Growth in this category has been led by industrial and automotive applica-



tions with more than 30 percent and 11 percent per year growth rates respec-



tively.  The large personal products, sector has grown at nearly 5 percent



per year over this time frame.  Growth in this sector has been led by deo-



dorant/anti-perspirant applications (12 percent per year) and colognes/per-



fumes  (5 percent per year).  These growth sectors have been offset to some



extent by the more mature hair care products sector which has actually



declined by nearly 1 percent per year over this time period.  Finally, the



household products category appears to be another mature sector with slightly



less than 2 percent per year growth from 1968 to 1973.
               '            ,           V        1     '    '   •


     Industry Structure - The metal can industry is made up of about 100



companies that operate approximately 350 plants.  Three-quarters of total



can shipments are supplied by merchant can suppliers and about one-quarter



by companies that produce cans for.their own use.  The can industry is one



of the most concentrated of all packaging industries.  The two leading mer-



chant can companies, American Can and Continental Can, accounted for roughly



two-thirds of all merchant can sales in 1973.  National Can and Crown Cork



and Seal, the third and fourth leading merchant can companies, accounted



for an additional 15 percent of merchant can sales.  Thus, four companies



accounted for about 80 percent of total merchant can sales in 1973.  The



leading merchant can companies are typically fully horizontally integrated
                                  VI-65

-------
 in  the metal can  industry and produce metal cans for most of  the end-use




 sectors mentioned previously, including aerosols.  Further, many of  these




 companies extend beyond the can industry itself and are involved in  other




packaging and nonrelated activities such as glass container manufacture,




converted paper and plastic products production, and the manufacture of



various consumer products.  ^an manufacture.for.fluorocarbon^related aerosols




is less than 10 percent of the sales of these leading merchant can companies.




     In addition to the major can companies, however, several smaller aerosol




can manufacturers exist in the merchant can market.  Although the sales of




these smaller companies represent only a small share of the total aerosol




can market, these companies do depend to a much greater degree on aerosol




can manufacture than do the leading can manufacturers.  Examples of  this




type of company are Peerless Tube Company and Apache Container Corporation.




Further work will be required in order to identify and assess regulatory




effects on these smaller companies whose aerosol container sales represent




a substantial portion of total company sales.




     In addition to the merchant can sector, at least forty companies manu-




facture cans for their own use.   Coors, Schlitz and Anheuser Busch in the




beer industry and Campbell Soup, Carnation, Borden and H.J. Heinz in the food




industry are examples of companies that are backward integrated to can manu-




facture.   Also, R.J. Reynolds and Kaiser Aluminum are forward integrated to




can manufacture.  Sherwin Williams is the only known aerosol can manufac-




turer that produces cans for its own use.
                                 VI-66

-------
     Related Container Industries - About 94 percent of the aerosol product




market is packaged in metal cans.  Cans are preferred primarily for their high




barrier and safety characteristics.  Glass and plastic containers account for




about 5 percent and 1 percent of the aerosol market respectively.  Total glass




container shipments in 1973 were about 39.5 billion units with a value of




$2.3 billion.  Total plastic bottle shipments were about 7.4 billion units in




1973 with a value of $514 million.  Thus, the glass and plastic aerosol market




segment makes up a very small part of these related container industries.
                              VI-67

-------
P.  Aerosol Fillers and Marketers




     In addition to the manufacture of aerosol-related hardware, i.e.




caps, valves and canisters, a major industry exists around the filling




process for aerosol products.  In 1973 the estimated sales volume of




firms engaged in aerosol filling was on the order of $2.2 billion at the manu-




facturers' level.  This estimate includes sales of the industry's two




major segments, captive fillers which are generally subsidiaries or divisions




of companies whose primary business is the marketing of aerosols and other




products, and contract fillers whose prime business is filling aerosol




products to the specifications of aerosol marketers.  Industry sources




estimate that contract fillers account for approximately 60 percent of




the total units filled.  For 1973, based on industry estimates of 2.9




billion units filled, contract fillers filled approximately 1.74 bijLlion




units while captive producers.processed very nearly 1.16 billion



units.




   Table VI-29 summarizes the estimated sales and employment in the




aerosol industry.  Our employment estimates include only those employees




directly involved in the filling of aerosol products and their directly




related support people, i.e. quality control, warehousing, distribution,




and purchasing.  We estimate directly related support personnel to approximate




10 percent of the total direct manufacturing employees.  We have not in-




cluded in our estimates, employment for those jobs which are indirectly



related to aerosol filling.  These Include sales, marketing, administra-




tive, and other corporate overhead employees and, if included in employ-




ment estimates, could approximately double the figure shown in Table VI-29




to nearly 30,000 employees.





                                 VI-68

-------
TableVI-29.  1974 AEROSOL FILLING INDUSTRY SALIENT STATISTICS
Filler type
Contract
Captive
Totals
Units filled
(millions)
1,740
1,160
2,900
a
Sales
(millions)
250
2,000
2,250
b
Employees
8,500
6,000
14,500
   Sale's at manufacturer's level

  Employment  directly related to  aerosol filling.

  Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates based on communications with
           the industry.
                               VI-69

-------
     The exact number of directly and indirectly related employees is




extremely difficult to estimate since it varies widely with the efficiency




of the filler, the nature of the business, i.e. strictly a filler or a




combination marketer/filler and the geographical scope of operations.




Contract fillers, with their operations generally limited relative to




marketer/fillers, typically have fewer support people, especially in




marketing, sales, and corporate administrative positions, since the nature




of the business does not allow or require their existence.  The marketer/




fillers, however, whose operations frequently involve widespread distribu-




tion of aerosol and other products, typically employ marketing and adminis-




trative personnel, only part of whose responsibility involves aerosol



products, but whose number equals or exceeds the number directly involved




in aerosol filling.




     An important distinction to note is the difference in the role of the




contract filler when compared to that of the marketer with a captive filling




operation.  The contract filler provides aerosol filling capabilities for




those marketers who do not have a product line which justifies investment




in captive aerosol filling capacity.  With relatively few exceptions, con-




tract fillers are small in size, large in number and rather regionally




oriented in the scale of their operations.  FigureVI-3 shows graphically




the fact that the number of firms with filling capacities less than 10




million units per year accounts for nearly 50 percent of the total number




of firms, but that their total aggregate capacity is only 6 percent of



total industry capacity.  Conversely, the firms with filling capacities in




excess of 200 million units per year account for only 3 percent of the total




number of firms, but over 30 percent of the industry filling capacity.






                                 VI-70

-------
    M
    a
    H
    8
    s
    W
        100
         80
         60   _
         40   -
         20
          ANNUAL CAPACITY

A = more than 200 million units

B = less than 10 million units
                      20
     40
60
80
100
                       CUMULATIVE PERCENT OF TOTAL

                              NUMBER OF FIRMS
Figure VI-3.   Aerosol  Filling  Industry Capacity as a Function of
               Number of  Fillers
Sources:  Aerosol Handbook and Arthur D.  Little,  Inc.,  estimates.
                                 VI-71

-------
Many of the contract fillers, especially the smaller more regionally oriented




firms, rely on one or two major accounts for the bulk of their business, and




hence, are vulnerable to the loss of an account going to captive production—




or could be vulnerable to costly process changeovers to alternate propel-




lants or delivery systems if a fluorocarbon propellant ban affected the




products of their major customer.  The larger contract filling firms such




as Aerosol Techniques, Inc., Peterson/Puritan, (subsidiary of CPC Inter-




national), and Barr-Stalfort have much more widely diversified operations




from both a geographic and product-mix standpoint, and would not be as




vulnerable to limitations on fluorocarbon use or changes in their customer




base.




      Many aerosol marketers have captive filling operations as the result




of their aerosol business growing to a point where captive filling is eco-




nomically justified.   Captive filling for the marketer represents a backward




integration step from the prime business of producing and marketing products




which utilize aerosol packaging for consumer appeal and/or effective product




use.  While it is difficult to generalize, potential economic dislocation




in terms of lost  sales and unemployment from a potential fluorocarbon ban




should affect the marketers of aerosol products with captive filling opera-




tions less than the contract fillers.  Since the marketers' prime concern




is the sale of personal care, household, or other products, a ban on fluoro-




carbon propellants would most likely mean a switch toward an acceptable




propellant or package, rather than leaving the business entirely.  Thus, one




would expect a shift to alternative products or propellants in the event




of a fluorocarbon propellant ban.  The dislocation in terms of employment
                                     VI-72

-------
and industry segment sales would be determined by the extent to which




alternate products would be accepted by the consumer.




      The scope of this study did not allow for a detailed analysis of the




aerosol filling industry.  Relatively little published information exists




regarding its operations and characteristics.  A key area for further con-




sideration is the actual operating performance and flexibility of representa-




tive fillers, as these factors would be influenced by a possible fluorocarbon




propellant ban.  Many of both the fillers and marketers contacted have begun




initial development of alternate propellant systems or products and, at this




point, do not anticipate debilitating changeover costs in adapting current




filling capacity to new propellants if a fluorocarbon ban is enacted.  How-




ever, this is an extreme generalization which should be clarified through




further effort aimed at identifying and quantifying specific impacts on a




representative sample of fillers, both contract and captive.  Also, since




certain fluorocarbon aerosol products do not presently have acceptable al-




ternatives, certain firms may be more adversely impacted depending on the




company's product mix.




c.     Valves




      The estimated value of valves used in aerosol containers produced in




the United States was approximately $60 million in 1973.  The major producer




of  valves is Precision Valve Corporation with an estimated 50 percent of the




total market.,  There are arv, additional nine valve producers that supply the




aerosol industry, .based on a recent survey of the Chemical Specialties Manu-




facturers Association.  Employment among the valve producers is an estimated




2,000, based on industry, contacts.
                                  VI-73

-------
5.   Air Conditioning and Refrigeration




     The air conditioning (A/C) and refrigeration industry is a major consumer




of fluorocarbons for use as refrigerants in air conditioning and refrigera-




tion systems.   The air'conditioning and refrigeration industry is important




both in the residential sector as well as in the industrial and commercial




sectors of the U.S. economy for atmospheric temperature controls and for




maintaining the quality of many products ranging from food to drugs.  Refri-




geration is important in such industrial sectors as food distribution, chemi-




cals and Pharmaceuticals, Computer systems, electronics, aerospace and optics.




The fluorbcarbon refrigerants play an important role in the air conditioning




and refrigeration industry.  The industry has been built around the use of




fluorocarbon refrigerants because of their desirable low toxicity and low




flammability combined with excellent heat transfer properties,  there are




alternate refrigerant materials available, however, they are used to an




extremely limited degree because they do not equal the physical properties




of fluorocarbons.  As a result, the air conditioning and refrigeration




industry is highly dependent on fluorocarbon refrigerants, and limitations




on the use of fluorocarbon refrigeraits would significantly alter the present




air conditioning and refrigeration systems.  In order to develop new equip-




ment utilizing' alternative refrigerants, the industry would require a number




of years'to redesign'equipment, build prototypes, test and retool production




facilities, and achieve a high level of production capability.  In addition,




the impact on the existing equipment would be severe.  Alternative refrigerants




cannot be used interchangeably, because existing equipment has been speci-




fically designed to utilize fluorocarbon refrigerants.
                                VI-74

-------
     The related level of business activity in the refrigeration industry

is summarized in Table VI-30. Industry employment and payroll data are


included.  The data presented include  heating equipment as well as air


conditioning and refrigeration equipment, and it is estimated that heating

equipment accounts for approximately 20. percent of the total value of shipments.


These employment estimates only consider direct employment related to the


manufacture of refrigeration equipment and components for refrigeration
    *
equipment such as heat transfer equipment, compressors, and condensers.
                                  i
Indirect employment, including refrigeration equipment contractors, sales

and service personnel and others, and direct employment, totaled an estimated

525,000 employees in 1972.  The indirect employment impact has been


determined through use of an employment multiplier analysis based on the

Input/Output Structure of the U.S. Economy, 1967, U.S. Department of


Commerce.  This analysis has been feasible because of the well-defined

nature of the refrigeration industry in the U.S. Census of Manufacturers


1972.


     The major air conditioning/refrigeration equipment manufacturers are

summarized in Table VI-31.  The majority of these companies are highly


dependent on the air conditioning/refrigeration industry, although major


companies, including the automotive companies and large appliance manufacturers,

such as General Electric and Westinghouse, are less dependent on the air

conditioning/refrigeration industry.  The table summarizes the. companies'


total sales,  their relative: profitability, and their dependence on the air


conditioning and refrigeration business as a function of their total sales.
                                     VI-75

-------
                                           TableVI-30.  U.S. REFRIGERATION INDUSTRY - 1972
<
H-
I

a
Refrigeration and heating
Equipment (SIC 3585)
Heat transfer equipment
Unitary air conditioners
Commercial refrigeration
Compressors
Condensers
Room A/C and dehumidif iers
Other refrigeration and
A/C equipment
Other
Household refrigerators and
Freezers (SIC 3632)
Household refrigerators
Home and farm freezers
Other
Value of
shipments
($million)

7033.1
1540.7
1171.2
477.0
1064.4
142.6
650.8

551.9
1434.5

1610.5
1192.0
213.1
295. 4
Total employees
Number
(thousand)

149. 9










32.1



Payroll
($million)

1433.9










287.3



Production workers
Number
(thousand)

111.9










27.0



Payroll
($million)

973.8










220.9



                a Data includes heating equipment which represents approximately 20 percent of total value cf
                  shipments in SIC 3585.
               Source:  U.S. Department of Commerce Census of Manufacturers, 1972.

-------
                Table VI-31. AIR CONDITIONlNG/REFRIQERATIpN
                      EQUIPMENT' MANUFACTURERS - 1973
• '* "
Company
Borg Warner (1fork)
Carrier Corporation
Chrysler
(FY ending 10/31/73)
Copeland
(FY ending 9/30/73)
Fedders
(FY ending 8/31/73)
Ford : '
General Electric
General Motors
McGraw-Edison
Tecumseh Products
Trane Company
Wei 1-McC lain
Westinghouse
Whirlpool
White Consolidated
Addison Products Co.
Dunham-Bush , Inc .
(Subs, of The Signal
Companies)
Lennox Industries Inc
Hussman Refrigerator
(Subs, of Pet Inc.)
Tota.l
1973 sales
($million):
1,546.8
876.7

186. 5 ;
338.4
23,015:l;
,11,573.5. .
35,798.3
821.0
524 .4 :
317.4
150.7
5,702.3
1,637.0
825.6
N/A
$75 - 100
N/A
150
Net income
percent of
sales

4.6%.
4.6
• : . .,
5.3 ;
3.1
:3.9
- -. ::5.1 ,-.
6.7
. 1 .: .
4.0
5.6
5.0
7.5
2.8
5.3
4.2
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
A/C and ••.••-
refrigeration
as percent of
total sales
',"'••
19%a
85
t .
<2
95+
69
.;••• ?b
. .; •.- N/A
N/A
'41C
70 '
95+
37d
16C
38
N/A
-100
80-90
<10
50
Major
activity

A/C
A/C
A/C
Parts
A/C, R
A/C, R
' A/C , R .
A/C, R
A/C
Parts
A/C
A/C
A/C, R
A/C
A/C, R
A/C, R
A/C, R
A/C
R
 Includes building products
 Includes tractors, other appliances and electronic items
CIncludes all U.S. consumer goods
 Includes heating equipment
 Sources:   Corporate annual reports,  and Arthur  D.  Little,  Inc.
                                  VI-77

-------
     The industry experienced rapid growth during the 1960's as the air




conditioning and refrigeration industry developed» however, the air condi-




tioning and refrigeration industry has been experiencing lower growth in




recent years.  Because of lower growth1? Increased competition, and the




economic downturn in 1974, the profitability for a number of companies in




the air conditioning and refrigeration business has deteriorated.  For




example, Borg Warner's York subsidiary experienced a loss in 1974.  In




addition, Carrier Corporation's level of profitability in the A/C and re-




frigeration business also deteriorated, and its pretax margin as a percent




of sales dropped from 8.4 percent in 1973 to 0.9 percent in 1974.  These




examples point out the profitability problems in the industry and suggest




potential limited financial capability in view of the massive effort that




would be necessary for the Industry to convert their air conditioning and




refrigeration products to alternative refrigerants.
                               VI-78

-------
6. Foam Blowing Agents



    Fluorocarbons are used extensively as blowing agents in the manu-




facture of both rigid and flexible polyurethane and polystyrene foams.



Much smaller amounts are used for polyolefin foams.




    The most commonly used fluorocarbon is F-ll which accounts for ap-




proximately 80 percent of all fluorocarbon vised for this application.




Approximately 25 percent of the F-ll produced is used as a foam blowing




agent.  A summary of fluorocarbon usage in each of the foam categories



was presented in Table IV-9.




    Principal raw materials used in the production of polyurethane




foam are polyether and polyester polyols.  In 1973, 1;16 billion pounds




of polyether and polyester polyols were used in the production of poly-




urethane foam, and sales of these raw materials totaled $190 million.  ,




The major producers of polyether polyols are BASF Wyandotte Corpora-




tion, Dow Chemical, Jefferson Chemical Company (owned by Texaco), Olin




Corporation and Union Carbide Corporation.  These five account for over




80 percent of production.  The balance is accounted for by a large




number of smaller producers.  Most producers of- polyether polyols also




produce polyester polyols which represent a small portion of total




polyol production.                    • < •  >•




    Isocyanates are the other key raw materials along with the blowing




agent used in the production of polyurethane foams.  It is estimated that




over 75 percent of the total production of isocyanate in 1973 (871 million




pounds) was used in production of foams, including that exported.  Total




isocyanate merchant sales in 1973 were $221 million or about 83 percent of




total U.S. production.  There are 10 producers of isocyanates; the two largest-
                              VI-79

-------
Mobay and Upjohn — have an estimated 50 percent of total industry capacity




for the two major commercial isocyanates.



    There were about 1.4 billion pounds of flexible and rigid polyurethane




foam produced in 1974.  Rigid foam production was approximately 400 million




pounds and flexible polyurethane foam production was over 1 billion




pounds.  The total value of urethane foam products was approximately $1




billion in 1973.




    Major producers of flexible polyurethane foam are E.R. Carpenter,




Diamond Shamrock, Firestone, General Motors, General Tire and Rubber Com-




pany, Reeves Brothers, Goodyear, Sheller-Globe, Tenneco and Textron.




These 10 companies account for 70 percent of total flexible polyurethane




capacity; the balance is accounted for by 30 to 40 smaller producers.




There are over 100 companies which are manufacturers of rigid polyurethane




foam.  The end-use pattern for rigid and flexible polyurethane foam is



given in Table VI-32.




    The number of companies producing and distributing the polyurethane




foam end products is extremely large and diverse.  Also, there is a large




amount of overlap between foam manufacturers and end product manufacturers.




Since there are many small producers of rigid and flexible polyurethane




foam and foam products, the profitability and financial capability of




smaller producers may limit their ability to convert to alternative blowing




agents.  The potential impact on this industry sector requires further analy-




sis.




    Approximately 32,000 people are employed in foam product manufacture.




This estimate is based on employment figures for the industry which are
                                 VI-80

-------
 Table VI-32. U.S.  CONSUMPTION  OF  POLYURETHANE FOAM -  1973
Category
Building Insulation
Appliances
Transportation
Furniture
Industrial insulation
Carpet underlay
Marine f lotation
Bedding
Textile laminates, packaging
Other
.Total
Flexible
(percent of
total use)
-
-
33
38
-
8
-
10
4
7
100%
Rigid
(percent of
total use)
38
20
14
15
5
-
3
-
-
5
100%
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates based on published data.
                               VI-81

-------
published in the Census of Manufacturers. 1972 and updated to 1973 assuming




a constant output per employee.  Industry sources estimate that 15,000




people are employed in foamed plastic manufacturing and another 10,000 in




raw material manufacturing for a total of 57,000 people involved in




activities related to the use of fluorocarbon blowing agents.




7.  Solvents                      '




     The chlorocarbons and the fluorocarbons have important solvent




applications.  The major categories for the use of solvents are in metal




cleaning and textile cleaning and processing.  Metal cleaning involves




a wide range of products including transportation equipment, electrical




machinery, primary metal products and jewelry.  There are two basic




methods of cleaning metal — cold cleaning and vapor degreasing.  Vapor




degreasing involves placing the part to be cleaned  in the vapors of a




boiling solvent.  Trichloroethylene is particularly suitable to this




method and is employed in the majority of vapor degreasing operations.




However,  because of air pollution considerations, methyl chloroform



is being utilized to an increasing extent in addition to perchloroethylene.




Perchloroethylene is principally used for dry cleaning, and processing and




finishing textiles.  Besides its cleaning capability perchloroethylene has




the additional properties of being nonflammable and easily recoverable.




To a limited extent F-113 and ethylene dichloride are also employed




as dry cleaning agents.




     Chloroform and trichloroethylene find small applications as extrac-




tion solvents.  Trichloroethylene is used in decaffeinating coffee, and




chloroform is an extraction solvent for vitamins, penicillin, antibiotics




and flavors.  Other chlorocarbons are widely used in laboratory-scale




solvent and extraction applications.



     According to industry estimates, total employment in plants utilizing




fluorocarbon solvents is 160,000.





                           VI-82

-------
             VII.  INITIAL ECONOMIC IMPACT ASSESSMENT



A.  INTRODUCTION

     The preceding chapters of this report have defined the current uses

of fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons, estimated their atmospheric emissions,

and described the primary U.S. producing and consuming industry sectors.

The transition schedules for each of the major production and consumption

sectors in the face of restrictions in the use of fluorocarbons and chloro-

cargons have also been developed.  This chapter identifies and describes

the economic dislocations likely to be experienced in the United States

if regulations are promulgated to reduce U.S. halocarbon emissions.

     A set of potential regulatory strategies are identified, followed by

a summary of the key information from the previous chapters.  The approxi-

mate emission reduction resulting from each regulatory option is also

shown.  The final section of this chapter describes in a qualitative way

the effects on each of the industry sectors which would result from

implementing each of the 18 regulatory alternatives.

     The purpose of this initial economic Impact assessment is to identify

where impacts are likely to occur under the various alternatives and to

estimate the relative magnitude of the impacts.  This report does not
                            ...      - *      --\     •  •      , ~  "•  .
attempt to project price increases or job losses, for example, as would

be done as part of a more extensive examination of potential economic

impacts on particular sectors.


                                 VII-1

-------
     There are, however, some general comments which can be made about




the economic effects of restricting the use of the fluorocarbons and




chlorocarbons.  Because the current uses of the chemicals exist in price-




and performance-competitive environments, one can generally say that for




a given product performance, the current use of the chemical is the least




costly product for satisfying the total need as perceived by the consumer.




Restrictions in their use would require present consumers to shift to




their next best alternatives which would either be more expensive or per-




form less satisfactorily.  The alternative may satisfy the primary needs




of the user but may not maximize total satisfaction.  In some cases, a




consumer shift to less satisfactory products may also be a shift to less




expensive products.  But generally one can say that a restriction in the




use of a high volume chemical will result in substitution by higher priced




products and some reduction in consumption.  Even without a reduction in




consumption, total consumer utility may decline.




     The price effects of restrictions on the use of fluorocarbons and




chlorocarbons are confused because the substitute products would in many




instances be less expensive, though they would not provide the same product




performance.  The non-aerosol antiperspirant and hair spray products are




generally less expensive, as are many of the alternative solvents and



blowing agents.  Lower solvent or blowing agent costs may be out-




weighed by higher equipment or operating costs.




     The price Increases resulting from restrictions on the chemical use




or production would be caused first by having to use more expensive sub-




stitute products to achieve the same results, and secondly by increased




prices of the fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons themselves as a result of




lower production levels.




                                  VII-2

-------
     There is the potential for job losses as a result of restrictions




in a chemical's use.  However, simply counting jobs may not adequately




reflect disruptions resulting from the restrictions because the additional




production of alternate products minimizes the employment impact.   A ban




in fluorocarbon production could result in an increase in the total number




of jobs associated with producing the substitute products and performing




the function now performed by the fluorocarbons.  The next best product




including chemical production, refrigeration applications, propellant




applications, etc. may be less efficient in labor utilization than the




present one and may require more labor hours to achieve the results now




achieved using the fluorocarbons.  While the total change in jobs may not




be a good measure of economic impact, identifying the jobs lost and those




gained could be a useful indicator of impact.  Since sufficient analysis




has not been conducted to quantify the jobs impact, this report has avoided




listing jobs to be "impacted."  Such impacts could range from job losses




to simply learning to work with new products or chemicals.  Until such




impacts can be better defined, their discussion does not give great in-




sight into the effects of the regulatory strategies.




     The secondary and tertiary impacts of both price increases and job




losses/gains is an important and often neglected dimension of economic




impact.  The one job lost/gained at a chemical manufacturer could result




in two jobs lost or gained through multiplier effects.  Because this




report is directed at identifying primary impact areas, no attempt has




been made to estimate these secondary impacts, though they should be




estimated as part of a more complete economic impact analysis.
                                  VII-3

-------
     This report concerns the economic impacts or costs of undertaking




various steps to reduce fluorocarbon and chlorocarbon emissions.   The




economic benefits of such reductions are not considered.   In order to




justify or mandate the economic disruptions which would result from




restrictions in fluorocarbon or chlorocarbon use, the societal benefits




flowing from these restrictions should be well understood.  Conducting




this preliminary economic impact assessment does not imply that substan-




tial benefits would result from restrictions in the chemical usage.  The




question of whether the ozone layer is threatened has not been examined




nor has the question of what would be the economic penalties (costs) of




different reductions in the ozone layer.




     While considering the economic impacts of the different regulatory




strategies, one should bear in mind that a statement that a current use




of fluorocarbons or chlorocarbons can be switched to a substitute product




is not a statement that it should be switched without strong justification.




Even though refrigeration systems, for example, would continue to be made




and jobs may not be lost under a conversion to another refrigeration




system, the society pays real and significant penalties for an imposed




conversion.  Simply because of higher refrigeration and air conditioning




prices, fewer refrigeration and air conditioning products will be bought




and less money will probably be available for purchasing other products.




Thus, it is imperative that potential economic impacts be broadly con-




ceived to include productivity effects, inflation effects, balance of




payment effects, environmental effects, and not simply job losses or plant




closings.  And, in addition, the corresponding benefits of the proposed
                                  VII-4

-------
regulations which have not been considered in this report must be well




understood before regulations are promulgated which would result in sub-




stantial economic disruption.




     This economic impact assessment considers only the effects on the




U.S. economy of restrictions on U.S. fluorocarbon and chlorocarbon emis-




sions.  If the ozone layer is threatened by these emissions, it is a




worldwide problem and one which restrictions on U.S. emissions alone



cannot solve.  United States fluorocarbon and chlorocarbon atmospheric




emissions now account for one-half of world emissions and the U.S.




share will diminish in the future.  If substantial reductions in world-




wide emissions are necessary, other fluorocarbon- and chlorocarbon-using




countries must also act to reduce atmospheric emissions of these compounds.




B.  REGULATORY OPTIONS





1.  Introduction




     Through discussions with the EPA,  nine regulatory options have been




defined which are designed to reduce fluorocarbon and chlorocarbon emis-




sions to the atmosphere by four different amounts on three different time




schedules.  These potential  regulatory strategies have no official standing.




They are only intended to identify a range of alternatives and to enable




a more specific discussion of potential disruptions in the U.S. economy




resulting from the options.  Other regulatory actions are possible and




will certainly be considered if a decision is made to reduce emissions.




2.  Chemicals Considered




     The following regulatory options assume that a limited  number of




 critical uses  exist  which result in relatively small losses to the atmosphere




 and which would  not  be banned  even if all other fluorocarbon and chlorocarbon






                                  VII-5

-------
uses were banned. Such critical uses, for which there are no adequate



substitutes, could include products used in inhalation therapy or




products used for fire control in aircraft.  Since current theory indicates




that a low level of atmospheric emissions may be acceptable, it is



unreasonable to assume that the banning of such critical uses is a viable




regulatory option.  People would be exposed to high immediate health




risks without any compensating reduction in damage to the ozone layer.




     In describing the regulatory options and the resulting economic dis-




locations, it is specifically assumed that the critical uses will not be




affected (except by higher product prices) by any of the options.




     The timing of the various alternatives assumes that at some point in




the next one to two years a decision will be made to execute a strategy for





reducing emissions.  The options discussed here and the resulting




scenarios begin at the point the decision is made.  If there are exten-




sive delays before a decision is made, the affected industry sectors




will have more time to prepare their response and the resulting economic




disruptions could be lessened to  some extent.




     The current usage of  15 fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons




has been discussed in this report.   In order to make a general



discussion of economic impacts manageable, the chemicals considered have




been limited to two groups with relatively long atmospheric life times and




relatively high production levels:
                                 VII-6

-------
          Chemical Group 1 (atmosphericlifetime greater than ten years)




             Fluorocarbon 11




             Fluorocarbon 12




             Carbon tetrachloride




          Chemical Group 2 (atmospheric lifetime of one to ten years)




             Fluorocarbon 22




             Methyl chloroform




     These two chemical groups are considered in two combinations:




          Chemical Use or Production Restriction Alternatives





             Restricted Chemical Set A




                Restrictions  on Chemical Group 1




                No Restrictions on Chemical Group 2





             Restricted Chemical Set B




                Restrictions  on Chemical Group 1




                Restrictions  on Chemical Group 2










3.  Definition of Regulatory Options




     Nine regulatory approaches have been defined ranging from a ban of




all uses of the chemicals after six months to a ban of propellant uses




after six years.  Each of the nine approaches is applied to Restricted




Chemical Sets A and B for a total of 18 regulatory options.
                                 VII-7

-------
The following nine regulatory approaches have been considered:








1.  Ban All But Replacement Uses of Controlled Chemicals After




Six Months                   ...       .           .   .



All direct uses of the controlled chemical and all uses in new




products  (Restriction Set A or Restriction Set B) would be banned




six months after the issuance of the order (except limited critical




uses).  No new aerosols or air conditioners could be made with the




chemicals, but the recharging of existing air conditioners and




refrigeration equipment would be allowed.






2.  Regulate Non-Propellant Uses and Ban Propellent Uses




After Six Months




Design specifications would be promulgated requiring the upgrading




of refrigeration/air conditioning, and solvent and blowing agent




equipment and refrigeration/air conditioning service techniques in




order to  increase recovery of emissions now lost to the atmosphere.




Use in propellant applications would be banned at the end of  six




months.                                            •






3.  Do Not Regulate Non-Propellant Uses and Ban Prop.ellant Uses




After Six Months




No new controls would be placed on non-propellant uses of the




chemicals, but the use of them as propellents would be banned at




the end of six months.
                             VII-8

-------
4.  Institute Government Control of Total Chemical Production
After Six Months
The Federal Government would take some action to limit total chemi-
cal production by the end of six months and let the market mechanisms
allocate its uses.  The first such alternatives would be to specify
a total U.S. production and tax away the excess profits made when
the product prices are bid up.  Another alternative would be to
impose a tax, such as $1.00 a pound, on the chemicals in order to
discourage their use as propellants and introduce an economic incen-
tive for increased recovery of emissions in other applications.  An
auction system for buying the right to produce a specified amount of the
chemical is another mechanism which more precisely controls how much will
actually be produced and allows the market itself to establish a "tax"
in the form of the payments for production rights. A 50 percent re-
duction in production has been assumed for each of the five chemicals.
5.  Ban All But Replacement Uses of Controlled Chemicals After
Three Years
This is the same as Option 1 except that the ban goes into effect at
the end of three years.

6.  Regulate Non-Propellant Uses and Ban Propellant Uses
After Three Years
The regulatory action is the same as Option 2 except that the
restrictions go into effect at the end of three years.
7.  Do Not Regulate Non-Propellant Uses and Ban Propellant
Uses After Three Years
The only restrictions would be a ban of propellant applications three
years after the regulation is issued.

                               VII-9

-------
8.  Institute Government Control of Total Chemical Production
After Three Years
One of the mechanisms for controlling total U.S. chemical production
would be put into effect at the end of three years.

9.  Do Not Regulate Non-Propellant Applications and Ban Propellant
Uses After Six Years
The only controls under this option would be a ban on propellent
applications six years after promulgation of the order.   ""
          ' '*                                     •
                     Summary of Regulatory Options
                         Immediate Restrictions

1.  Ban All But Replacement Uses of  Controlled Chemicals After Six Months

               Restricted Chemical Set A
               Restricted Chemical Set B
2.   Regulate Non-Propellant Uses and Ban Propellant Uses
    After  Six  Months
               Restricted Chemical Set A
               Restricted Chemical Set B
3.   Do Not Regulate Non-Propellant Uses and Ban Propellant Uses
    After  Six  Months
               Restricted Chemical Set A
               Restricted Chemical Set B              /•'       •
4.  Institute  Government Control of Total  Chemical  Production After
    Six Months
               Restricted Chemical Set A
               Restricted Chemical Set B
                             VII-10

-------
                Restrictions After Three Years  '•

5.  Ban All But Replacement Uses of Controlled Chemicals After
    Three Years
            Restricted Chemical Set A
            Restricted Chemical Set B
6.  Regulate Non-Propellant Uses and Ban Propellant Uses
    After Three Years
            Restricted Chemical Set A
            Restricted Chemical Set B
7.  Do Not Regulate Non-Propellant Uses and Ban Propellant
    Uses After Three Years
            Restricted Chemical Set A
            Restricted Chemical Set B
8.  Institute Government Control of,Total Chemical Production
    After Three Years
            Restricted Chemical Set A
            Restricted Chemical Set B
               Restriction After Six Yearg
9.  Do Not Regulate Non-Propellant Uses and Ban Propellant Uses
    After Six Years
            Restricted Chemical Set A
            Restricted Chemical Set B
                             VII-11

-------
C.  REVIEW OF PRODUCTION AND EMISSION STATISTICS




     The assessment of potential economic impact resulting from various




regulatory options is based upon the information reported earlier in the




report on the uses of the chemicals, potential substitutes, conversion




timetables, and current emission rates.  Information Concerning the five




chemicals considered in the impact analysis have been summarized in




Tables VII-1 through VII-6.




     Table VII-1 lists the 1973 U.S. production and major use categories




for the five potentially controlled chemicals.  Table VII-2 lists the




estimated losses to the atmosphere of each of the chemicals from its major




use categories.  Table VII-3 disaggregates the use categories more finely




than  does Table VII-1.




     Group I chemicals are principally used as intermediate chemicals,




propellants, and refrigerants.  Their intermediate chemical use is prin-




cipally for the production of F-ll and F-12 from carbon tetrachloride.




Any limitations on F-ll and F-12 would directly impact carbon tetrachloride




production and vice-versa.




     F-ll and F-12 are used equally as propellants.  For refrigerant




applications, F-12 is the predominant Group I chemical, while for use as a




blowing agent, F-ll is the predominant Group I chemical.



     Group II chemicals are used as solvents  (principally methyl chloro-




form) and refrigerants.  F-22 is primarily used as a refrigerant with




additional markets as a chemical intermediate (fluorocarbon resins).




Methyl chloroform also has applications as a chemical intermediate (i.e.,



vinylidene chloride), and  as  a vapor  pressure depressant  in  aerosols.
                                  VII-12

-------
                   Table VII-1.  ESTIMATED ANNUAL U.S. USES OF POTENTIALLY CONTROLLED CHEMICALS - 1973
                                                      (millions of pounds)
H
U»
Chemical
Chemical group 1
F-ll
F-12
Carbon tetra-
chloride
Subtotal
Chemical Group 2
F-22
Methyl
chloroform
Subtotal
TOTAL
Produc-
tion

334
489
1.047
1,870

136
548

684
2,554 .
Propel-
lant

237
249
— - —
486

small
_

small
486
Refrigerant

18
168
_I_ -
186

90
_

90
276
Solvent

small
•
small
-

-
384

384
384
Blowing
agent

53
10
—
63
•
-
_

-
. 63
Intermediate
chemical

-
- '
995
995

35
44

79
1074
Other a

3
79
I2.
134

11
120

131
265
       a. Includes exports.

     Sources:  U.S. International Trade Commission; Chemical Marketing Reporter; Arthur D. Little,  Inc.,  estimates
               based on industry contacts.

-------
             Table VII-2.  ESTIMATED U.S.  ATMOSPHERIC EMISSIONS FROM POTENTIALLY CONTROLLED CHEMICALS - 1973
                                                         (millions of pounds)

Chemical
Chemical Group I
F-ll
F-12
Carbon tetrachloride
Subtotal
Chemical Group II
F-22
Methyl chloroform
Subtotal
Total

Production
334
489
1,047
1,870
136
548
684
2,554
Production,
transport
& storage
losses
3.3
4.9
15.7
23.9
1.4
5.5
6.9
30.8
^ Estimate
Propellant
237
249
486
small
small
486
d annual ends
Refrigerant
11
131
142
59.5
59.5
202
sions fr
Solvent
small
21
21
427
427
448
om use and
Blowing
agent
29
7.5
36
-
36
disposal
Use as
in termed.
.chemical
9.9
9.9
small
small
small
9.9

Total
280
392
46
718
62
433
495
1,213
Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.

-------
              Table VII-3.    DEFINITION OF USES OF POTENTIALLY CONTROLLED CHEMICALS - 1973

                                                (millions of pounds)
 I
M
in


Chemical consuming
sectors
Propellants
Hairspray
Antl-perspirant
Other
Refrigeration
Appliances
Mobile air-conditioning
Room and unitary air-
conditioners
Commercial chillers
Other
Solvent
Metal cleaning and degreasing
Electronics, aerospace etc.
Other
Bloving Agent
(breakout not available)
Flexible polyurethane
Rigid polyurethane
Other
Intermediate
F-ll
F-12
Vinylidene chloride
• Fluor ocarbon resins (i.e.PTFF]
Other (including exports)
Total
Chemical Group I

F-ll


103
86
48

-
-
-

18
-

-
-
Small

)
r


_
_
-
-
26
334

F-12


72
114
63

9
72
-•

79
8

-
-
—

}•
10


_
_ -
-
-
62
489
Carbon
tetrachloride


-
-
-

-
-
-

-


-
-
Small -


_
—

628
367
•
-
52
1047
Chemical Group II

F-22


-
-
Small

-
Small
37

52
-

i-
-
-


_
••

-
-
-
35
12
136
Methyl
chloroform


-
-
-

-
-
- •

-
-

384
-
.-


• ^
—

-
-
44
—
120
548
              Source:  U.S. International Trade Commission; Chemical Marketing Reporter; Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates

                       based on industry contacts.

-------
     Table VII-4 summarizes the dependence of various end use categories




on the potentially controlled chemicals.  The table shows those end use




sectors which are most dependent on the Group 1 and II chemicals and, by




inference, those sectors which would, be more.severely impacted by limita-




tions on Group I and II chemicals.  For example, under blowing agents,




81 percent of rigid polyurethane foam produced is dependent on Group I




chemicals, while flexible polyurethane is only 49 percent dependent on




Group I chemicals.  This suggests that rigid polyurethane would be more




severely impacted by limitations on Group I chemicals.  Although alter-




natives appear to exist for use in the rigid foams, because of the high




degree of dependence of the sector on Group I chemicals, further analysis




of these alternatives is required.  Another example is commercial




refrigeration  (Table VII-4) under the refrigeration end use sector.  This



sector is 90 percent dependent on Group I and II chemicals, and therefore




may be severely impacted by limitations on Group I and II chemicals.




However, the level of dependence suggests alternatives exist other than



Group I and II chemicals.  In addition, reciprocating air conditioning is




only 10 percent dependent on Group I chemicals.   If limitations were placed




on only Group I chemicals,  the potential impact on the sector would be




reduced.                                     .            .




     Table VII-5 summarizes the consuming industry response times developed




in Chapter V.  The three primary types of responses to chemical use re-




strictions are emission reductions, substitute products, or substitute




chemicals.                           .                         .




     With the exception of aerosol applications, for which emission reduc-




tions are not an alternative, most current uses of the chemicals could
                                 VII-16

-------
                         Table VII-4.   DEPENDENCE OF USE CATEGORIES ON POTENTIALLY CONTROLLED CHEMICALS - 1973
<
H
M
Chemical consuming
sectors
b
Propellants
Aerosol hairsprays
Anti-perspirants
Other
Solvents
Metal cleaning
Dry cleaning
Electronics aerospace
Other
Chemical Intermediates
Fluorocarbon resins
F-ll
F-12
Vinylidene chloride
Blowing agents
Rigid polyur ethane

Flexible polyurethane

Refrigeration
Appliances
Mobile air-conditioning
Room and unitary
air-conditioning
Commercial refrig.
Commercial A/C
-reciprocating
—centrifugal
Group I
Percent
using
F-ll


95
95
20

0
0
0
Small

0
0
0
0

81 (includes
F12)
49 (includes
F12)

0
0
0

0

0
10
Percent
using
F-12


NA
NA
NA

0
0
0
0

0
0
0
0

MA

NA


100
98
0

87

10
80
Percent using
carbon
tetrachloride


0
0
0

0
0
0
Small

0
100
100
0

0

0


0
0
0

0

0
0
Group II
Percent
using
F-22


0
0
Small

0
0
0
0

90-95
0
0
0

0

0


0
2
100

3

90
10
Percent using
methyl
chloroform


0
0
0

45
0
0
Small

0
0
0
-30-35

0

0


0
0
0

0

0
0

Percent using all
other fluorocarbons/
chlorocarbons


5
5
10

55
95+
95+
95+

5-10
0
0
65-70

4

6


0
0
0

10



            a. Rows do not always total to 100 because all chemicals used in each use category are not included.

            b. F-ll and F-12 are treated together in the column under F-ll.  Strictly speaking, F-ll is used as

               a vapor pressure depressant, in combination with F-12 as a propellant.

            Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates based on industry contacts.

-------
                     Table VII-5.   CONSUMING INDUSTRY RESPONSE TIMES TO CHEMICAL USE RESTRICTIONS
Consuming industry
Intermediate chemical applications
Propellant applications
Refrigerant applications c
Appliances
Mobile air conditioners
Home air conditioners
Commercial refrigeration
Commercial air conditioners
- reciprocating
- centrifugal
Blowing agent applications
Flexible foams
Rigid foams '
Solvent applications
Emission reduction by
equipment upgrading
(years)
Not an option
Not an option
2-3
3-4
2-3
2-3

2-3
2-3
2-3
2-3
1
Primary response
to ban of chemical use
(years)
2-7
1-2
to absorption to F-22
4-6 3-4
Indefinite Indefinite
3-5 zero
4-6 3-4

3-5 2-3
2-3 1-3
six .months
3
1-2
Conversion
substitute chemicals
(years)
5-10
4-10
5-11
5-11
5-11
5-11
-
5-11
5-11
six months
4-9
4-9
M
V
(-•
oo
         a. The primary response times are the elapsed times required for the consuming industries to
           introduce substitute products to meet the demand now satisfied by the controlled chemicals
           or products using the chemicals.
         b.The conversion to substitute chemicals times are those required to develop new chemicals
           with properties similar to the banned compounds and to modify the products using the banned
           chemicals.                              .
         c.In the event of a ban of F-ll and F-12, most refrigerant applications would be converted
           to F-22.  If F-22 is.also banned, other refrigerants could be used or some products
           could be converted to  absorption systems.
          Source:   Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates  based on industry contacts.

-------
achieve significant emission reductions in two ,to,,three .years.  If the
           , ' ' \.'4 ' *•_'(          •                    . i .11 '   '   •


chemicals cannot be used, the consuming industries would have to switch


to existing products not using the chemicals or redesign products to use


substitute chemicals.  For the refrigerant application in particular,


comparable substitute chemicals do not exist and a five to eleven year

         >y "-•
period may' be required to develop the substitutes and design new equip-


ment to use them.


     A comparable period may be required to develop comparable liquified gas


propellants,  but such a requirement is not as clear since some alterna-


tive propellants currently exist, though with somewhat different performance


characteristics.


     Table VII-6 was constructed tp show the importance of the chemicals


in determining final product prices.  The table lists the percent of a


final product selling price accounted for by the input chemical cost.


Solvent uses are shown as not applicable since the solvents are "consumed"


in the manufacture of a number of final products and represent a very small


(and indeterminate) percent of the final product prices in many cases .


An example is the use of these solvents to clean electronic computer


components at one extreme, and use to dryclean clothes at the other


extreme.  The 20 percent of aerosol product cost represented by


propellant indicates that a large increase in the cost of the propellant


will have a significant impact on the aerosol price and thus potentially


on the sales of the aerosol products.  In contrast, the refrigerant


represents 0.1 percent to 0.2 percent of the price of appliances.  A


major increase in refrigerant prices would have a very small impact on


the appliance price.




                                  VII-19

-------
        Table VI1-6.  VALUE OF CHLOROCARBONS AND FLUOROCARBONS
                      RELATED TO PRICES OF END USE PRODUCTS - 1973
Chemical
     Consuming product
Cost of chemical/
price of product
F-ll, F-12
Carbon tetrachloride
F-ll, F-12, F-22
Carbon tetrachloride,
Methyl chloroform,
F-113
F-ll, F-12
 Propellant applications"

     hair spray
     antiperspirant

 Intermediate applications

     F-ll, F-12

 Refrigerant applications

     appliances
 mobile air conditioner
room & house air conditioner

commercial refrigeration

commercial air conditioning
(chillers)
   reciprocating
   centrifugal

Solvent applications
                         Blowing agent applications
                                                          15-20%
                                                          20-25%
   35-40%
  0.1% - 0.2%
    1-2%
    0.2%
  0.1% - 1%
                                                         0.1% - 1%
                                                            3%

                                                            N.A.
                                    5%
a
 Based on manufacturer's price.

Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc., estimates.
                                 VII-20

-------
D.  ASSESSMENT OF ECONOMIC IMPACTS




1.  Introduction




     The objective of this section is to identify those industry sectors




likely to be impacted by the regulatory options outlined in Section B of




this chapter and to assess the relative magnitude of the impact.




     Table VII-7 was constructed to summarize the results of the economic




impact assessment.  As described in Section B, nine possible control




strategies have been considered for two groups of chemicals.  An estimate




has been made of the impact resulting from the 18 alternatives on 10 pri-




mary impact industry sectors.  Estimates have not been made of changes in




consumer prices, production levels, or job levels.




     As a tool for categorizing the magnitude of economic impact, five




levels of impact were defined:




     Levels of Economic Impact




     1.  Severe Impact




     A Severe Impact implies that most companies in the.sector will be




     affected, at least to a moderate degree (some seriously), and more




     than 40 percent of the directly related business activity  of which




     the chemical production or chemical .consuming production is a part




     will be ended or significantly disrupted.




     2.  Substantial Impact




     A Substantial Impact implies that some firms in the sector will




     experience at least a moderate arid in some cases a serious impact,




     and a significant portion (greater than 10 percent but less than




     40 percent) of the directly related business activity  of which
                                 VII-21

-------
                                              Table VII-7.   SUMMARY OF ECONOMIC IMPACT FROM REGULATORY OPTIONS
. Regulatory
options
, A



6 BOS.



" B
2 A
2> B

a A
3' B
A
«• B
c A



3 yrs.<



J' B
, A
6' B

, A
7' B
_ A
«• B
6 yrs.

« A
'• B

Producers
of basic
chemicals
2-3
2
3
3

3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3

3
3
3
3
5
5
•^ 	 Propellent appl
Aerosol Indus
Fillers
1
1
1
1

1
1
1
1
2-3
2-3
2-3
2-3

2-3
2-3
2-3
2-3
3-5
3-5
Can manu-
facturers
3
3
3
3

3
3
3
3
5
5
5
5

5
5
5
5
5
5

npact sect
ry
Valve manu-
facturers
1
1
1
1

1
1
1
1
2-3
2-3
2-3
2-3

2-3
2-3
2-3
2-3
3-5
3-5
Marketers
2
2
2
2

2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3

3
3
3
3
5
5
*»~

Refrigeration &
air conditioning
manufacturers
1
1
4
4

5
5
4
4
1-2
1
4
4

5
5
5
5
5
5
fon-propellant ap
Users of
blowing agents
• (rigid foams)
2
2
3
3

4
. 4
3-4
3-4
3
3
3
3

4
4
4
4
4
4
,^ VJ 	 ^~~
Users of
solvents
5
3
5
5

5
S
5
5
5
5
5
5

5
5
5
5
5
5
Users of
chemical
intermed.
5
3
5
4

5
5
5
4
5
3
5
4

5
5
5
4
5
5
to
to
           IMPACT CODE

           1 - severe
           2 - substantial
           3 - moderate
           4 - limited
           5 - essentially none
REGULATORY OPTIONS
        REGULATORY SUB-OPTIONS

        Chemicals controlled:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
          Sub-option A:   F-ll,  F-12,  carbon tetrachloride
          Sub-option B:   F-ll,  F-12,  carbon tetrachloride,
                         F-22,  methyl chloroform
Ban all but replacement uses of controlled chemicals after six months.
Regulation of non-prppellant uses and ban of propellant uses after six months.
No regulation of non-propellant uses and ban of propellant uses after six months.
Governraeit control of total chemical production after six months.
Ban all but replacement uses of controlled chemicals after three years.
Regulation of non-propellant uses and ban of propellant uses after three years.
No regulation of - non-propellant uses and a ban of propellant uses after three years.
Government control of total chemical'production after three years.
No regulation of non-propellant applications and ban of propellant uses after six years.

aSee text of report for definition of these terms.
        Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc.

-------
 the  chemical  production  or  chemical consuming production  is a part




 will be  ended or  significantly disrupted.





 3.   Moderate  Impact




 A Moderate  Impact occurs when a few firms in a sector will



 experience  a  moderate  impact on sales or profits, and no more than




 a small  portion (less  than  10 percent) of the directly related busi-




 ness activity of  which the  chemical production or chemical consuming




 production  is a part will be ended or significantly disrupted.





 4.   Limited Impact




 The  Limited Impact category includes those situations in which the




 regulations would Impact firms in a sector or the production in the




 sector related to the  controlled chemicals only through increases in




 product  prices.   If a  reduction in a chemical's production or the




 imposition  of a tax results in a large increase in the chemical's




 price, the  resulting product price increase in sectors continuing to




use  the  chemical may result in some unit sales fall-off.  Equipment




upgrading to reduce emissions to the atmosphere would also raise




product  prices and fall  in  this category if the regulation imposed




no other limitations on continued production.   While the magnitudes




of these price and sales changes have -not been defined, the instances




when they may occur have been identified as Limited Impacts.
                            VII-23

-------
     5.   No Impact




     The No Impact category covers instances when the proposed regulations




     would have essentially no impact on the firms or production of a




     particular sector related to the controlled chemicals.   Very small




     price increases are possible under this category.





     The economic sectors which could potentially be affected by the nine




regulatory approaches can be divided into the production sectors (basic




chemicals) and the consuming sectors.  The producing sectors will be




affected because a portion of their production Will be ended or restricted.




The consuming sectors can be further divided into the propellant applica-




tions (subdivided into fillers, cans, valves, and marketers) and the non-




propellant applications.  This division of the consuming sectors corresponds




to the division among alternatives for reducing emissions to the atmosphere.





      About 50 percent of the atmospheric losses are attributed to the




 aerosols, and there are no opportunities for continuing to use the




 fluorocarbons in aerosols but not allowing them to escape to the atmos-



 phere.   Thus, one regulatory option is to ban the use of fluorocarbons in




 aerosols or not to ban them.  In the other consuming sectors, there are




 some opportunities for reducing emissions without banning the use of




 the chemicals.  These emission reduction possibilities add a third regu-




 latory opportunity for the non-propellant consuming sectors.




      The restrictions are assumed to go into effect either at the end of




 six months or after three years.  The ninth regulatory approach considers




 just a ban on propellent uses after six years.
                                 VII-24

-------
     Under each of,the nine regulatory approaches are sub-options A and




B.  The A options consider restrictions on the production of only F-ll,




F-12, and carbon tetrachloride.  Almost all propellant uses of fluoro-




carbons use F-ll or F-12, and the opportunities do not appear to be great




for moving to other fluorocarbons as substitute propellants. About 95 per-




cent of carbon tetrachloride is used to make F-ll and F-12 and thus the




three chemicals must be considered together.




     Under regulatory sub-option B, F-22 and methyl chloroform are re-




stricted in addition to the other three chemicals.  As far as propellant




applications are concerned, there are no differences between the two




options.  If sub-option A is imposed, refrigeration and air conditioning




producers can use F-22 (R-22 in refrigeration terminology) in many appli-




cations, though some design and equipment changes would be required.




Under sub-option B, this opportunity will not be available and a conver-




sion to another refrigerant or another cooling technology, such as  ,




absorption systems, may be required.




     Methyl chloroform is a major solvent, while the other chemicals have




only limited solvent uses.  Therefore, only sub-option B has implications




for the solvent applications of chlorocarbons, though important chloro-




carbon solvents are not considered in the analysis.  Under the regulation




as proposed, most users of methyl chloroform would probably.switch to a




halocarbon solvent not being controlled, such as F-113.  This opportunity




substantially mitigates the potential impact of the regulations on the




users in comparison with a broader ban on all chlorocarbon and halocarbon




solvent uses.
                                 VII-25

-------
     Of the chemicals considered, only F-ll and F-12 are used as blowing




agents.  The economic impacts of sub-option B are therefore identical to




A for the blowing agent uses.  The producers of flexible foam appear to




be able to convert to methylene chloride as a substitute blowing agent if




restrictions are placed on the fluorocarbon blowing agents.  Since the




conversion could be effected in six months, the economic impact would only.




be seen in possible price changes.  The producers of rigid foams have a




much more difficult conversion problem, and for this reason only the




rigid foam producers have been considered in the impact analysis.




     The uses of the fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons as intermediate




chemicals (raw material inputs) for the production of other final product



chemicals were discussed extensively in Chapter VI.  Carbon




tetrachloride is an intermediate for the production of F-ll and F-12.




When a fluorocarbon or chlorocarbon is used as an intermediate, the pro-




cessing takes place in a closed system and the final product does not




usually retain the same characteristics which potentially could affect




the ozone.  The emissions of fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons from uses



as intermediates are about 1 percent of the tonnage usedi  However,  ending




the availability of the chemicals could have profound effects on the pro-




ducts using them.  This potential for a large economic impact is obscured




somewhat because, of the five chemicals considered in this economic impact




assessment, only methyl chloroform and F-22 have significant uses as




intermediates  (excluding carbon tetrachloride uses in making F-ll and




F-12).




     Under the regulatory options as defined, sub-option A has virtually




no impact on the users of fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons as intermediates






                                  VII-26

-------
because the three chemicals considered are not used extensively as inter-
mediates.  Under sub-option B, some economic impact would be experienced
because methyl chloroform has some limited intermediate applications and
F-22 is used for making fluorocarbon polymer..  However, the economic impact
of restrictions in the availability of these two chemicals would be much
less than that of a broader ban on fluorocarbon and chlorocarbon products.
Such a broad ban would have significant economic Implications for complex,
capital-intensive plants dedicated to products using the fluorocarbon and
chlorocarbon, intermediates.
2.  Discussion of Regulatory Options
    Option 1.   Ban All But Replacement Uses of Controlled Chemicals After
               Six Months
     A.  Under this option, .all new uses of F-H, F-12, and carbon tetra-
chlpride, except a limited number of specifically identified critical
uses, would be banned six months after the issuance of the regulation.
Recharging existing refrigeration and air conditioning equipment would be
allowed as would chemical production to,meet this demand.

     No aerosol, products using F-ll and F-12 would be produced after the
ban.  Within six months, adequate supplies of substitute products will
not be available, and the impact on aerosol marketers will be substan-

tial.  Until two to three years after the ban there will not be a re-
storation of the supply/demand balance with non-aerosol products replacing
the F-ll and F-12 aerosol products. .Even after  three  years, the current

sales of aerosol products measured by units sold or dollar sales may hot

be restored.  Some consumers who.now buy the fluorocarbon aerosol products
may not find the substitute products satisfactory.for their purposes and
thus may not switch.  This could; result in a permanent loss of market in
                                 VII-27

-------
some product categories.  For example, some hair spray users may turn to




other methods of maintaining their hair style such as pump sprays while




others may find no product satisfactory and change hair styles.




     The contract fillers of aerosol products and the valve manufacturers




are highly dependent on aerosol sales.  The fluorocarbons are used in about




50 percent of U.S.-produced aerosol products.  Under this regulatory




option, their activities would be even more significantly affected than




the marketers.  The sales of the fillers and valve manufacturers could




decline by 50 percent when the ban took place.  The introduction of sub-




stitute products over the following year will not be of much benefit since




most of these products will not be in aerosol form.  The potential for




using compressed gas aerosols, such as compressed CO., and new valve




designs was described in earlier parts of the report.  In the event of




a ban after six months, these potential substitutes, even if technically




available, could not be brought on line as quickly as the existing non-




aerosol products when production capacity simply needs to be expanded.




Thus, under the most optimistic assumptions, a ban on using F-ll and




F-12 in aerosols after six months would dramatically reduce the sales




of fillers and valve manufacturers, and the reduction would continue for




at least two years.




     The can manufacturers would experience a moderate impact as a result




of an end of fluorocarbon aerosol production.  While all aerosol cans




are 43 percent of general packaging cans, they were only 3.6 percent of




total U.S. can production in 1973.  About half of the aerosol cans would




be affected by the ban.  The introduction of the substitute products




would not reduce the impact on can manufacturers since most of the sub-




stitutes would use glass or plastic containers.





                                   VII-28

-------
     For the manufacturers of refrigeration and air conditioning equip-



ment, a ban on F-12 would have a severe economic impact.   Only certain




kinds of products are now made using Fr22, and a total conversion to




F-22 could not be,achieved within six months.  A majority of current




production by the 'industry would probably end at the six months date and




gradually come back over a three to five year period as the production




of products using F-22 is expanded and producers convert their products




to F-22, other refrigerants, or absorption technologies.




     The F-ll and F-12 fluorocarbons are major blowing agents for both




rigid and flexible foams.  Methylene chloride can be substituted for the




fluorocarbons in  the flexible foams within six months.  However, such a




simple option does not exist for the rigid foams.  The existing equipment




for producing the rigid foam can be converted to use CO 'and water, but




the foam then loses much of its insulating properties.  Without the




fluorocarbon blowing agent, the foam will lose its competitive advantage




over Less expensive insulating materials such as fiberglass.  If a .ban on




the use of fluorocarbons is imposed after six months, a substantial portion




of the rigid foam production would end.  There is no guarantee that the




competitive problem of lower insulation can be overcome even after three




years.      .




     None of the  three chemicals controlled under sub-option A have sig-




nificant uses as  solvents, and these consuming sectors would be unaffected




by this regulatory option.




     With the exception of carbon tetrachloride being an intermediate for




the production of F-ll and F-12, the three chemicals do not have important




intermediate uses, and there is no impact in this sector.






                                 VII-29

-------
     The Impact of regulatory option 1A on the basic chemicals producers




(F-ll, F-12, carbon tetrachloride) has been categorized as moderate.   In




the first year of the ban, production of the three chemicals would be




about 25 percent of the level of the previous year (5 percent for critical




uses and 20 percent for recharging existing equipment).  From the perspec-




tive of the total business activity of the producers and their chemical




sales, the ban would not represent a major sales reduction.  For all of




the fluorocarbon producers, with, the exception of the Racon Corp., the




sales of all fluorocarbons account for less than 10 percent of chemical




sales.  Thirty-one percent of Racon's chemical sales are attributed to




fluorocarbons and the ban would be important to that producer.




     The end of F-ll and F-12 production would reduce current U.S. fluoro-




carbon production by 80 percent and clearly implies a very significant




impact on that particular segment of the chemical industry.  Since the




producers are mostly major chemical producers for whom the fluorocarbons




are a significant though small activity, the economic impact has been




classed as less than if the viability of the firms were threatened by the




ban.




     Option IB




     Under this option, F-22 and methyl chloroform use would be banned




at the end of six months in addition to F-ll, F-12, and carbon tetra-




chloride.




     The impact of this option on the propellant applications would be




the same as under option 1A, since F-22 has only very small prppellant




uses.
                                 VII-30

-------
     The Impact of this option oh the refrigeration and air conditioning




industry .would be .extremely'severe. A large and important percentage



of the current refrigeration and air conditioning equipment now uses F-22




and it .is, a potential substitute in many applications if F-ll and F-12 are




banned.  If all three are banned in six months, most refrigeration and air




conditioning equipment production would end for a period of two to three




years while products using other refrigerants or an absorption technology




are developed.    <     •               . '




     Methyl chloroform is a major solvent.  However, the impact has been




assessed as moderate because opportunities exist for using solvents not




included in the ban, such as F-113.  There will be some disruption for a




period of six months to a year after the ban takes effect while processing




equipment is modified and material compatibility problems are worked out.




     Methyl chloroform is also used by Dow as ah intermediate for the




production of vinylidene chloride, a plastic wrapping material.  About




9 percent of methyl chloroform production is used as an intermediate.




While substitute wrapping materials are available, the vinylidene chloride




production facilities will not be able to be easily converted to other




products.




     The impact of this option on the basic chemicals producers can be




viewed as similar to option 1A.  For the three methyl chloroform producers,




the reduced sales would be a fairly small change in total chemical sales.




     Option 2.  Regulate Non-Propellant Uses' and Ban Propellant Uses




     After Six Months                     :       ,




     A.  Under this regulatory option, F-ll, F-12, and carbon tetrachloride




could be produced without limitation.  However, their'use as 'prbpellants






                                 Vil-31

-------
would be banned (except in certain critical uses) and requirements would

be issued for equipment upgrading to reduce atmospheric emissions from

other uses.

     The impact of this option on the aerosol industry would be identical

to that of option 1A.  There would be a major impact on the fillers, valve

manufacturers, and marketers with opportunities for recovery by the mar-

keters as substitute products are introduced.

     For the refrigeration and air conditioning industry, the regulation

could result in a small change in prices but probably no significant change

in sales volume.  It is not assumed that only reduced emission equipment

could be sold after six months.  A redesign period of about a year would

follow issuance of the regulation, with routine production of the new

refrigeration and air conditioning units commencing in about 2-3 years.

The manufacturers would have to improve valves and fittings, and F-ll and

F-12 could cost somewhat more.  But the total change in product prices is

expected to be less than 5 percent.

     The economic impact of this option on the firms using the chemicals

as blowing agents has been categorized as moderate.  The technology for

reducing emissions does not exist and could not be installed for two to

four years.  As mentioned above, there is some opportunity to use substitute

products.  As a caution, it is noted that in addition to the few large com-

panies accounting for 70 percent to 80 percent of foam production, there

are a large number of smaller firms who may have relatively more difficulty

making the necessary investments.

     Since the products are not used as solvents or inturmediater;, there  .

would be no impact from  this regulation within the  solvent or chemical

intermediate  sectors.
                                   VII-32

-------
     The impact of option 2A on the basic chemicals producers is similar

to that of 1A because the half of the annual production used in aerosols

would be ended, and a major part of the makeup sales for refrigeration

and blowing agent uses would be ended if their losses are reduced by

equipment upgrading.  The economic impact on the basic chemicals sector

has been categorized as moderate.


      Option 2B

      Regulatory option 2B adds F-22 and methyl chloroform to the list of

 controlled chemicals.   The economic impact of the regulation on the

 aerosol industry would be identical to that of option 1A and IB, since

 the propellant uses of F-22 are very small.

      The impact of the regulation on refrigeration and air conditioning

 manufacturers would probably be the same as under option 2A - small pro-

 duct price increases.   The costs of upgrading equipment for using the

 fluorocarbons is not likely to justify shifting from F-ll and F-12 to

 F-22 under option 2A,  nor are they likely to induce a shift away from all

 three fluorocarbons under option 2B.

      For blowing agent applications,  the economic impact of 2B is iden-
                 i
 tical to 2A since the added chemicals are not used as blowing agents.

 The solvent uses will be affected because there will be additional costs

 of vapor recovery equipment when using methyl chloroform.  There may in

 addition be some increases in the price of methyl chloroform if the vapor

 recovery efforts result in lower yearly sales, as they should.   It is

 possible that imposing the vapor recovery requirements on methyl chloroform

 and not other solvents will result in current users substituting uncon-

 trolled solvents for current methyl chloroform uses.  The magnitude of



                                   VII-33

-------
this potential shift has not been evaluated, but it would result more from




a perception by the solvent users of the cost of using the chemical rather




than a significant impact on final product prices.   The cost of the sol-




vent is usually a very small part of- the cost of producing products such




as circuit boards and high quality metal products.





      The use of  F-22  and methyl  chloroform  as chemical  intermediates




will  not be changed by  the  regulation except that  the price of  the




chemical may increase as a  result of lower  production levels.




      For basic chemical producers,  the  regulation  will  have a  slightly




heavier  impact than 2A  as a result  of additional reduction in  F-22 and




methyl chloroform production.  The  overall  impact  can still be  charac-




terized as moderate.




     Option 3.  Do Not Regulate Non-Propellant Uses and Ban Propellant




     Uses After Six Months




     A.  Under this option, the use of F-ll and F-12 as propellants would




be banned after six months, but no other restrictions would be placed on




the use of the chemicals.   Option 3A is equivalent to options 1A and 2A




as far as reducing emissions from aerosol products and the economic impacts




on the aerosol industry.  The alternatives provide descending control of




losses to the atmosphere from non-propellant uses of the chemicals and




correspondingly lower economic impact.




     The economic impact of the 3A option on aerosol fillers and valve




manufacturers is again classified as severe.  The marketers would experience




a substantial impact and the can manufacturers would see a moderate impact.




The reasons for this level of impact are identical to those discussed




earlier.




                                 VII-34

-------
     The effect of the regulation on refrigeration and air conditioning




products would be1 'essentially zero.   The cost of the refrigerants may




increase some as a result of reduced production for aerosol uses.  How-




ever, the refrigerant accounts for about one percent of the price of




refrigeration products, arid moderate increases in the fluorocarbon prices




are not expected to significantly reduce refrigeration sales.




     The impact of the regulation on blowing agent applications would be




somewhat greater than the refrigeration case.  F-ll and F-12 costs rep-




resent about 5 percent of foam product prices.  While there would be no




specific requirements on the industry in order to use the chemicals, higher




product prices resulting from higher chemical prices could produce a small




fall-off in foam product sales.  This effect is not expected to be great




since there are no close substitutes for the flexible foams and the rigid




foams already have a price premium because of their unique insulating




properties.




     There are no significant solvent uses of the chemicals and there are




expected to be no effects from the regulation among the solvent users.




The same is true in the chemical intermediate use category.




     Because the current atmospheric losses of the chemicals in non-




propellant uses will not be abated as in option 2A, the production levels




of the basic chemicals will be close to current levels minus the production




now going to aerosols.  The impact has been categorized as moderate for the




sector.
                                 VII-35

-------
     Option 3B                                 ,                  ;  .




     Option 3B adds F-22 and methyl chloroform to the list of chemicals




whose use as propellants would be banned.  While F-22 has some very limited




uses as a propellant, the use of the two additional chemicals can be re-




garded as not changing as a result of the regulation.  The overall economic




impact of option 3B would be identical to that of 3A.




     Option 4.  Institute Government Control of Total Chemical Production




     After Six Months




     A.  Options 4A and 4B are intended to represent the potential regula-




tion by which the cost of using the designated chemicals would be greatly




increased by direct or indirect taxes or by direct restrictions on the




total production of the chemicals.  The market would then be allowed to




redistribute the use of the chemicals among the highest value uses and




encourage the abatement of chemical emissions to the atmosphere.




     Table VII-6 (earlier) listed the percentage of final product price




represented by the cost of the chemical used in the products.  The solvent



applications are shown as N.A. (small). However, a sharp increase in the price




of fluorocarbon and chlorocarbon solvents would encourage the recovery of




vapors lost in use.  Substantial efforts are now made to recover emissions




of F-113, which is more expensive than methyl chloroform. . The other cate-




gory of uses to be most affected by higher chemical prices is the propellant



application.  About 25 percent of the product costs are now propellant




costs.  In order to achieve a 50 percent reduction in the production of




F-ll and F-12, the cost of the products would have to be sufficiently high




to discourage most of the current aerosol uses of F-ll and F-12.  While the




level of such a price is unknown, it is assumed for the purposes of this






                                  VII-36

-------
analysis that approximately a 50 percent reduction in the production of




the controlled chemicals will be achieved and most of the aerosol uses




will be ended or substantially reduced.  Due to the nature of aerosols as




convenience products, it will be very difficult to predict what demand




response will be to particular price increases.  A period of testing




demand response at several higher tax levels may be required before sales




decline sufficiently or producers stop making the products in the face




of the government actions.




     The .attractiveness of using a high tax or a system of auctioning




production rights is that it is easier to administer and no government




body is forced to make decisions, about more and less important uses of the




chemicals.   In addition,  there do not need to be any enforcement agencies




for assuring that equipment  specifications are met or emissions are kept




below  some specified level.




     Under option 4A, the aerosol industry would ultimately experience




an impact similar to that of an outright ban of fluorocarbon uses in




aerosols.  There would be something of a transition period while the




market adjusted, but eventually the production of aerosol products




using  F-ll and F-12 would be substantially reduced and  the marketers,




fillers, and valve manufacturers would have had their activity substan-




tially impacted.  The same sequence of industry responses would then




ensue  as under a formal ban  of the propellants.




     The refrigeration manufacturers would be least affected by the regu-




lation because the cost of the refrigerant is such a small portion of  the




total  product price.  The cost of maintaining the equipment and replacing






                                 VII-37

-------
the refrigerant falls on the equipment purchaser, not the manufacturer.




There is thus no strong incentive on the manufacturer to upgrade the




equipment to reduce emission losses, even though the losses will be more




expensive to make up.  There is probably not sufficient incentive to




switch from F-ll or F-12 to F-22  which is not controlled under 4A.




     Users of the chemicals as blowing agents will be given a strong




incentive to recover the emissions or switch to different blowing agents.




There are opportunities for doing both and there is the additional possi-




bility that the sales of the foam products will be reduced by price




increases resulting from increases in the blowing agent costs.  While




none  of  the uses of  the blowing agents will be directly restricted by




the regulation, the  potential  for at least limited  disruptions of  the




firms using the chemicals  is sufficiently large  to  warrant a  three to




four  impact classification.  Price  changes will  clearly be seen  and  the




loss  of  sales by the industry  as a  whole and  smaller  firms in particular




is a  possibility.



      The chemicals covered by  option 4A  are not  used  as  solvents and,  thus,




this  category of firms will not be  affected.   The same is true  of  the




intermediate chemicals category.



      The total  level of chemical  production would be very similar




 to that  under  option 2A.   The  production of  F-ll, F-12,  and




carbon tetrachloride would be  reduced  by about 50 percent,  and the




impact on the producing firms  can be described as moderate.
                                 VII-38

-------
     Option 4B                        . ;




     Option 4B adds F-22 and methyl chloroform to the list of chemicals




having their total production controlled by government imposed taxes or




production restrictions.



     Among the consuming sectors, only chemical intermediate uses are




expected to.be influenced differently.  The impacts of option 4B on




the aerosol industry would be essentially the same as option 4A, since




the added chemicals do not have large uses as propellants.  The refrige-




ration manufacturers would not be additionally affected  (though F-22  is



an important refrigerant) for the same reasons as described above.




     Because a large percentage of methyl chloroform production is used




as a solvent, a  large increase in its price is directly  seen by consumers




with some options for converting to alternative  solvents.  The  result




could be a major shift to chlorocarbon or fluorocarbon solvents whose




prices are not increased.  In most cases, the regulation will not




measurably affect the users  of methyl chloroform  as a solvent,  but  their




response to a price increase could affect the producers  of the  chemicals.




     Option 5.   Ban All  But  Replacement Uses  of Controlled Chemicals




     After Three Years




     A.   Options 5, 6, 7, 8, and 9 are intended to test whether a delay in




implementing a ban or restriction would lessen the economic impact while



not exposing the Earth to unacceptable risks resulting from further possible




damage to the ozone layer.  During the three years following the announce-




ment of the pending restrictions, the consuming industries would have an




opportunity to convert to other chemicals or substitute products.  For




many of the users of the fluorocarbons and chlorocarbons, three years



                                                            "'*'*..•.,.





                                 VII-39

-------
seems to be in the middle of the estimated conversion time range.  There




is a significant difference between the economic Impact of a ban at the




end of two years and one at the end of four years.  The three year ban




may not adequately show this difference.



     Option 5A is identical to 1A except that the ban of the use of




F-ll, F-12, and carbon tetrachloride would not take effect until three




years after the announcement of the ban.  If regulatory option 5A is pro-



mulgated, the aerosol marketers will have time for an initial response




with substitute products, though they may not be aerosol products.  The




impact on the marketers is classified as moderate because while their pro-




duct line will undergo a drastic change and there probably will be revenue




losses, their continuity of participation in their primary markets will




not be interrupted.





     The  impact on the aerosol fillers  and valve manufacturers has a




range  of  uncertainty because  it cannot  be predicted with any certainty




whether aerosol products will be available as substitutes after  three




years.  The development of  the manufacturing technologies and product




testing is now underway for compressed  CO. aerosols, and these products




may  be available within  three years.  There  is also information-to



indicate  the  possible availability  of substitute liquified gas propellants




within three  years.  To indicate the  most likely range  of impacts, the




fillers and valve manufacturers have  been designated as experiencing




substantial to moderate impacts.  If  substitute aerosol products are readily




available, the impacts will be moderate.  If they are not available, the




impacts will  be substantial.  The substantial classification indicates that the
                                 VII-40

-------
 potential exists  for  very serious  curtailment  of  their activities,  but




 the three year lead>time will  allow for  some steps  to reduce  the  effects.




 The can manufacturers are estimated to experience no significant  impact




 because the three years will allow them  time to adjust the utilization




 of  their production capacity now dedicated  to  aerosols.




      The refrigerant  applications  are categorized as experiencing a sub-




 stantial impact from  a ban at  the  end of three years.  Under  option 5A,




 the manufacturers .could convert  to F-22  or  other  refrigerants instead




 of  F-ll and. F-12.  They would  also have  the option  of converting  to a dif-




 ferent  refrigeration  system.   For  some refrigeration and  air  conditioning




 products, a conversion to F-22 could be  well underway within  three years,




 but production! to fully satisfy  demand might not  be seen  for  an additional



 year or so.  It is not now apparent how  some types  of equipment could be re-




Designed within three years without F-ll and F-12.




      The rigid foam blowing agent  applications of F-ll have been  classified




 as  experiencing a moderate impact.  Alternative blowing agents can be used




 to  make the rigid foams, but they  lose part of their insulation capacity




 and thus their competitive advantage. The  possibility exists that even




 with a  three year lead time, the rigid foams will not be  satisfactorily




 reformulated to maintain their current share of the insulating market.




 The participation of  many smaller  producers suggests that such an even-




 tuality would impose  a severe  impact on  these  smaller producers.




      There is no  impact in the solvent or intermediate application cate-




 gories  since there are essentially no such  uses of  these  three chemicals.



      For the basic chemical producers,  the  impact of  a ban after three



 years is less than that of an  immediate  ban.   The reduced production of
                                  VII-41

-------
the three chemicals would be offset in a relatively minor way by increased




production of substitute chemicals such as F-22. -While three :years would




allow time for the companies to work on substitute chemicals for the




current major markets, it is not likely that new chemicals can be tested




and their production facilities brought on line within three years.  The




impact of option 5A on the basic chemicals sector is classified as moderate




because the revenues from these products represent such a small percent




of the producing companies' revenues.  These impacts would be less than




in option 1A, where only six months elapsed before the imposition of the




ban.                                              '         .




     Option 5B




     Option SB adds F-22 and methyl chloroform to the chemicals whose new




uses will be banned at the end of three years.  The primary effect of their




addition is that F-22 is no longer available as an alternative refrigerant




to F-ll and F-12 and the large usage of methyl chloroform as a solvent in




metal cleaning and degreasing must be switched to another solvent.




     Methyl chloroform has no uses as a propellant and F-22 has only very




limited propellant uses.  Therefore, the economic impact of option 5B on




the aerosol-related industries is virtually identical to 5A.  Since neither




of the added chemicals is used as a blowing agent, the impact in that sec-




tor is also identical to 5A.




     For the refrigeration industry, the impact of option 5B  would




be more severe than option 5A.  With F-22 no longer available as a substi-




tute refrigerant, the manufacturers would have to switch  ti> alternative



refrigerants or systems.  The startup time for producing these new
                                 VII-42

-------
products would-be three to five years for most applications.   It is  not now




apparent what alternative technologies can be used for mobile air con-




ditioners.  It is possible that major parts of the refrigeration industry




would have to shut down for a period of,time if option 5B were promulgated.




The impact has been categorized as severe.




     Methyl chloroform is a major solvent.  However, banning its use is




expected to have at worst a small impact on product prices of those




business activities using it as a solvent.  Its use is primarily in more




routine cleaning operations for which substitutes (though perhaps less




satisfactory substitutes from a price or performance basis) can be found




within the three year period.




     Both F-22 and methyl chloroform are used as chemical intermediates.




Ending their availability will have an effect on the final product pro-




ducers.  This impact has been classified as moderate because even though




the production of the final products would be ended, the revenues from




the final products are a relatively small part of the total revenues of




the producing firms. .




     The impact on the basic chemical producers would be about equal to that



under option 5A, and it is still classed as moderate.




     Option 6.  Regulate Non-Propellant Uses and Ban Propellant Uses




     After Three Years




     A.  Option 6A would require ending the use of F-ll and F-12 as




aerosol propellants and improved recovery of current emissions to the




atmosphere from other uses of the chemicals after three years.




     The economic impact of this regulation on the aerosol-related




industries would be identical to that under option 5A.  There would be
                                  VII-43

-------
no impact in the solvent or intermediate categories since these chemicals




have very small solvent uses and no intermediate uses,  except carbon




tetrachloride use for making F-ll and F-12.




     For refrigeration applications, the manufacturers would be required




to upgrade the refrigeration equipment to reduce refrigerant losses.




The cost of these changes is expected to be small relative to the total




cost of the equipment, but the regulation could result in higher product



prices.  The impact has been classed as limited.




     The users of the chemicals as blowing agents are expected to experi-



ence a moderate impact, both becuase the price of F-ll and F-12 will increase




and because the expense of vapor recovery equipment will not be incidental.




The smaller producers may experience a relatively more substantial impact




because the vapor recovery facilities could make their operations rela-



tively more expensive than those of larger producers.




     The basic chemical producers will experience an economic impact under




option 6A slightly less severe than under 5A.  In addition to the 50 per-




cent production reduction as a result of the propellant ban, there would




be at least another 10 percent reduction resulting from the reduced leakage




in other uses.  The impact has thus been classed as moderate, as it was




for 5A.




     Option 6B




     Under this option, the impact on the propellant and blowing agent




uses would be the same as under 6A.  The chemical intermediate uses could




experience a price increase for products using methyl chloroform if there




is a major reduction in its volume of production.
                                 VII-44

-------
      The  refrigeration  industry would have to upgrade its equipment now




 using F-22  as  well as F-ll and F-12.  These changes would result in some




 increases in product prices.                                      .




      Option 7.  Do Not  Regulate Non-Propellant Uses and Ban Propellant




      Uses After Three Years




      A.   The only requirement under  this option  is a ban on propellant




 uses of F-ll and  F-12 after  three.years.  The effects of the regulation




 on other  consuming sectors would  only result from possible increased




 prices of the  chemicals as a result  of  lower production.




      The  aerosol-related industries  would experience the same heavy impact




.under option 7A, as under 5A.  There  would be no  impact on the solvent or




 intermediate use  categories.




      The  refrigeration  industry would have to pay more for F-ll and F-12,




 but the cost of a refrigerant is  usually less than one percent of  final




 product prices.   The  impact  is classed  as essentially none.




      The  impact of option 7A on the  basic chemical industry is expected




 to be moderate and  equivalent  to  option 6A.  A majority of  the pro-




 duction of  F-ll,  F-12,  and carbon tetrachloride  will be ended, but these




 revenue losses represent a  small  percent  of  producer chemical  sales.




      Option 7B




      This option  is virtually  identical to 7A since F-22 has only  very




 limited propellant uses and  methyl chloroform has no propellant uses.




      Option 8.  Institute Government Control of  Total Chemical Production




      After Three  Years




      A.   Under option 8A, the  federal  government would either  impose  a




 limit on  the total U.S. production of  F-ll,  F-12, and carbon  tetrachloride
                                  VII-45

-------
approximately equal to current use in propellants or tax the products




sufficiently to reduce production to the same level.  A limit on total




production would result in price increases to a level similar to that




with the tax.  This regulatory approach would have its largest impact on




the aerosol uses of the chemicals, since the propellant accounts for




about 20 percent of the price of the aerosol product.  If the aerosol




producers continued to use F-ll and F-12 at the higher prices, the pro-




duct sales would be limited to those willing to pay a much higher price.




Beauty shops, for example, might be willing to pay twice the current




price for hair spray.  However,' the objective of the regulation would be




to end the use of F-ll and F-12 as propellants in the mass market aerosols.





     Faced with  the government-imposed restriction on fluorpcarbon pro-




pellant availability, the marketers will undertake conversion strategies




very similar to  those under an outright ban of the products.  The cur-




rent production  of non-aerosol products will be expanded, and compressed




gas aerosols will be introduced.  The impact of option 8A must be classed




as very similar  to that of the more direct bans of  the use of the fluoro-




carbons as propellants.




     The solvent and chemical intermediate use categories will experience




no impact since  the three chemicals are not used  in  these sectors.




     The refrigeration and air conditioning manufacturers are projected




to experience essentially no impact under option  8A.  The manufacturers




may improve  the  equipment to reduce emission losses, but this is uncer-




tain since the cost of refrigerant replacement is borne by the purchasers




and not the manufacturers.
                                 VII-46

-------
     The users of the chemicals as blowing agents will experience a


strong incentive to switch to another blowing agent or install vapor


recovery equipment. .The current cost of F-ll and F-12 represents about


5 percent of the manufacturer's price of foam products.  Increased


blowing agent costs or vapor recovery costs can require small but impor-


tant increases in foam prices.  The three year delay in the regulation


should allow for a non-disruptive transition and a limited impact.


     The basic chemical and raw material producers will experience pro-


duction curtailments similar to those under option 6A.  The impacts have.


been classified as moderate.


     Option 8B


     Option 8B adds F-22 and methyl chloroform to the chemicals whose


production is controlled by government regulation.  Neither of these


chemicals has significant use as a propellant.  Under this option, there


would be essentially no impact on the refrigeration manufacturers for


the same reasons as cited above for option 8A.  The higher prices would


put a large Incentive on users of methyl chloroform as a solvent to switch


to another solvent or install vapor recovery equipment.  The effect of


either step could significantly increase the cost of using a solvent,


but this cost is a very small part of the costs of metal working and

                                                                     5
other activities using the solvents, and essentially no impact is expected.


     The impact of option 8B on the basic chemical manufacturers is


expected to be moderate.
                                  VII-47

-------
     Option 9.  Do Not Regulate Non-Propellant Uses and Ban Propellant




     Uses After Six Years




     A.  Option 9 is a test of whether a postponement of a propellant




ban to six years will reduce the economic impact of the regulation.



     It appears likely that after six years a compressed gas aerosol




could be available as could an acceptable liquified gas propellant.




The impact of option 9A on the aerosol fillers and valve manufacturers



has been categorized as moderate to none, reflecting the possibility that




the marketers may not find a satisfactory aerosol substitute at a compe-



titive price and there may be a general shift to non-aerosol personal care




products.  There is not expected to be a significant Impact on the mar-




keters if they have six years to adjust to the regulation.




     Option 9A is expected to have no significant economic impact on the




other consuming sectors except a gradual adjustment to higher prices for




controlled chemicals, particularly by the users of blowing agents, as the




aerosol use of the chemicals declines.




     Option 9B




     The impact of option 9B would be identical to that of 9A because




methyl chloroform is not used as a propellant and F-22 has only limited




propellant uses.  The addition of F-22 to the list of restricted chemicals




would prevent its being substituted for F-ll or F-*12 in current refrigera-




tion and aerosol applications.
                                 VII-48

-------
E.  POTENTIAL EMISSION REDUCTIONS     „.  ^  .,._  ,,   -




     Table VII-S summarizes estimated U.S. emission reductions for F-ll




and F-12 achieved through 1995 fo.r .regulatory-options 1A through 9A.




Table VII-9 shows the assumptions used in estimating the impact of the




control options on fluorocarbon emissions.  These emission reduction




estimates consider the expected growth in demand for fluorocarbons as well




as the timing for the regulatory options.  The emission reductions are




based on options 1-4 becoming effective in 1976,  options 5-8 effective




in 1979, and option 9 'becoming effective in 1982.




     Option 1A, which calls for a ban of new uses of F-ll and F-12, would




achieve a 92 percent reduction in potential emissions over a 20 year time




period  (1976-1995).  A 100 percent reduction would not be feasible because




of emissions from existing refrigeration systems and because "critical"




aerosol uses are not restricted under option 1A.   Emissions from blowing




agent and solvent applications are assumed to be 100 percent eliminated.




An estimate is also made of  the change in total  emissions since the start




of F-ll & F-12 production  (1945 is used as the first year of significant




production).  The  reduction  of total potential emissions of F-ll  and




F-12 from 1945 to 1995 under option 1A would be an estimated 70 percent.




Option 2A achieves an 82 percent reduction in potential emissions of F-ll




and F-12 over the 1976-1995 period.  Option 2A, which restricts "non-




critical" aerosol uses and requires controls on refrigeration and blowing




agent applications, has a lower level of emission reduction than option 1A




because of the continued use, although at a restricted emission level, of




F-ll and F-12 in refrigeration and blowing agent applications.  It is




assumed that 60 percent of emissions in refrigeration applications are
                                  VII-49

-------
    Table VII-8.  U.S.  EMISSION REDUCTION FOR F-ll AND F-12 ACHIEVED THROUGH 1995 WITH SELECTED REGULATORY SCENARIOS
Option
LA
2A
3A
4A
5A
6A
7A
8A
9A
No control
Percent reduction of F-ll and
F-12 cumulative potential
emissions over 1945
to 1995 period
70
63
53
61
63
56
48
52
38
0
Percent reduction of
F-ll and F-12 cumulative
potential emissions
from 1976 to 1995
92
82
70
80
83
74
63
69
54
0
Rank
1
3
6
4
2
5
8
7
9
10
Ui
o
          Assumptions:
1.  Options 1-4 effective 1976, options 5-8 effective 1979, and option  9  effective 1982.
2.  Five percent growth in demand for uncontrolled uses.
3.  Propellant applicants—critical uses are an estimated 5 percent of total potential demand.
4.  Refrigeration—5 year half-life assumed for controllable existing fluorocarbon emissions;
    only 60. percent of future emissions from refrigeration systems are controllable.
5.  Foam blowing—assumed 50 percent reduction of potential emissions achievable with controls.
          Source:   'Arthur D.  Little,  Inc.,  estimates.

-------
              Table VII-9.  SUMMARY OF U.S. ANNUAL FLUOROCARBON EMISSIONS WITH AND WITHOUT CONTROL
Consuming sector

Propellants
"Non-critical" use
"Critical" use
Refrigerants
Preventable and
recoverable use
Leakage not recoverable
and refrigerant not re-
coverable at disposal
Blowing agents
Preventable and
recoverable use
Uncontrollable use
Solvents
Total
Percent of total
F-ll & F-12
end use


95
5

57

43



50

50
0

i
F-ll & F-12
emissions with
no control
(million Ib)
1976 1979 1982

540 630 725
30 35 40

90 110 125

70 80 95
..


20 25 30

20 25 30
000
770 905 1045


1A
1976

0
30

80

60



0

0
0
170


2A
1976

0
30

80

70



0

20
0
200

F-ll
3A
.1976

0
30

90

70



20

20
0
230

& F-12 emissions
(million Ib)
4A
1976

70
30

90

70



20

20
0
300

5A
1979

0
35

95

70



0

0
0
200

6A
1979

0
35

95

80



0

25
0
235

with control
7A
1979

0
35

110

80



25

25
0
275

8A
1979

100
35

110

80



25

25
0
375

9A
1982

0
40

125

95



30

30
0
320

<
M
M
    Assumptions:  1.  Existing uses of F-ll and F-12 in refrigeration have a 5 year half-life (F-ll and F-12 emissions
                      from existing equipment after 5 years would be reduced by 50 percent).
                  2.  5 percent/year growth in total emissions of F-ll and F-12.
                  3.  An estimated 60 percent of F-ll and F-12 emissions from refrigeration and 50 percent of F-ll and
                      F-12 emissions as blowing agents are preventable and recoverable.
    Source:  Arthur D. Little, Inc.

-------
preventable and recoverable and 50 percent of emissions in blowing agent




applications are preventable.




     Option 3 only restricts "non-critical" aerosol uses of F-ll and F-12,




and as a result, only a 70 percent reduction in potential emissions is




achieved between 1976 and 1995.  The continued, uncontrolled use of F-ll




and F-12 in refrigeration and blowing agent applications reduces the




potential level of emission reduction achievable.  Option 4A, which re-




stricts production of F-ll and F-12, achieves a level of emissions similar




to option 2A at an estimated 80 percent.  In the first year of control




(1976), option 4A will not achieve the same level of emission reduction




as option 2A, assuming only a 50 percent reduction in production.  However,




in future years the assumption is made that a level restriction on produc-



tion will eventually eliminate "non-critical" aerosol uses of F-ll and F-12,




and will result in emission reductions in refrigeration and blowing agent




applications.  Refrigeration equipment would be upgraded to reduce vapor




losses, and vapor recovery equipment would be installed at foam producing




facilities.  As a result, option 4A is expected to have a similar impact



on emissions as option 2A. in later years, although the level of emission




reduction over the 1976-1995 period is slightly less because of the expected




smaller impact on emissions in the earlier years of production control.




     Options 5A-9A are identical to options 1A-4A, except the regulations




become effective at a later date.  The level of emission reduction in




options 5A-8A is reduced in comparison to the equivalent option where




controls are required in 1976 since no emission control is achieved during




the 1976-1978 period.  However, the overall impact on emissions of a three




year delay in implementation of controls (over the 20 year period) is
                                  VII-52

-------
limited.  For example, options 2A and 6A achieve 82 percent and 74 per-



cent reductions in emissions respectively over the 1976-1995 period.   This




represents only a 10 percent increase in total emissions over the 20 year




period.




     Figures VII-1 and VII-2 show the estimated cumulative emissions of




F-ll and F-12 over the 1945-1995 period under the regulatory options 1A-




9A, in comparison with the estimated cumulative potential emissions,




assuming there is no control during the same time period.  The figures




depict graphically the relative levels of emission reduction achievable




with each of the nine regulatory options.
                                 VII-53

-------
CO
tfl

O
37,000

     y>
33,000



29;000



25,000



21,000



17,000



13,000



 9,000



 5,000



 1,000
                          IVA
                          IIIA
                          IIA
                          IA
REGULATORY OPTIONS
                      UNRESTRICTED GROWTH
            1960
                     1970
       1980
1990
    Figure VII-1.  Cumulative U.S. Atmospheric Emissions of F-ll and F-12
                   Fluorocarbons Without Restriction and Under Regulatory
                   Options IA-IVA
                                    VII-54

-------
co
.0
CO
C
o
37,000


33,000


29,000


25,000



21,000



17,000



13,000



 9,000



 5,000



 1,000
                            IXA
                            VIIIA
                            VIIA
                            VIA
                            VA
REGULATORY OPTIONS
                     UNRESTRICTED GROWTH
              I960
                      1970
     1980
1990
   Figure VII-2.
             Cumulative U.S. Atmospheric Emissions of F-ll and F-12
             Fluorocarbons Without Restriction and-Under Regulatory
             Options VA-IXA
                                     VII-55

-------
                             VIII.  ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS


     Preparation of this document was facilitated through the special con-

tributions of the following individuals, companies and associations.
     Mr. Ken Lloyd, EPA Project Officer, not only provided valuable guid-
ance, but also collected much of the information pertaining to ethylene

dichloride and vinyl chloride in this study.  Messieurs John O'Connor,

Justice Manning and Allen Basala of EPA1s Strategies and Air Standards
Division and John Butler of EPA1s Office of Planning and Evaluation also

made invaluable contributions to the preparation of this report.

     Individual industry and association contributors are too numerous to
list here, however, sincere appreciation is extended to the representatives

of the following companies and trade associations who made a special effort

to provide information used in the preparation of this report.
     Aeropres                           E.I. DuPont deNemours & Company
     Aeroquip Corporation               General Motors, Delco & Frigidare
     Aerosol Techniques                   Divisions
     AFA/Thiokol                        The Gillette Company
     Air-Conditioning and               S.C. Johnson Company
       Refrigeration Institute          Liquid Carbonics
     Allied Chemical                    Peterson/Puritan
     Association of Home Appliance      Phillips Petroleum
       Manufacturers                    Plant Industries
     Bristol-Myers                      Risdon Company
     Chemetron Corporation              Seaquist Valve Company
     Chemical Specialties Manufact-     Technical Petroleum Company
       urers Association                TRW Inc.
     Detrex Chemical                    York, A Division of Borg-Warner
     Diamond International, Calmar      Union Carbide
       Division                         Westinghouse
     Dow Chemical
                                   VIII-1

-------